Sqlite: new main option sqlite_dbfile
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.93"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552019
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "website"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367.cindex affix "router precondition"
1368The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373of any other conditions.
1374.next
1375Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378address.
1379Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384.next
1385If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390.next
1391Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394.next
1395Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397.next
1398If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399of domains that it defines.
1400.next
1401.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1403.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1404.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1405.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1406.cindex affix "router precondition"
1407If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1408the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1409&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1410part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1411that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1412.new
1413that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1414&$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1415and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1416.wen
1417.next
1418.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1419.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1420.vindex "&$home$&"
1421If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1422an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1423local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1424user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1425remaining preconditions.
1426.next
1427If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1428because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1429later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1430subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1431could lead to confusion.
1432.next
1433If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1434set of addresses that it defines.
1435.next
1436If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1437specified files is tested.
1438.next
1439.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1440If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1441uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1442Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1443.endlist
1444
1445
1446Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1447it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1448part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1449&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1450&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1451going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1452example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1453
1454
1455
1456.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1457.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1458When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1459
1460.ilist
1461If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1462filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1463message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1464fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1465files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1466filtering'&.
1467.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1468(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1469
1470Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1471&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1472filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1473if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1474be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1475condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1476filter.
1477.next
1478Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1479its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1480address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1481can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1482processed entirely independently of each other.
1483.next
1484.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1485.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1486A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1487transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1488is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1489Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1490from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1491process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1492which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1493.next
1494When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1495handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1496doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1497local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1498collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1499addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1500address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1501addresses to the same domain.
1502.next
1503Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1504non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1505deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1506to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1507run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1508one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1509The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1510deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1511.next
1512.cindex "queue runner"
1513When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1514database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1515address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1516Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1517reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1518queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1519follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1520better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1521causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1522.next
1523.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1524Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1525deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1526retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1527reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1528not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1529.next
1530If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1531appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1532for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1533messages to other addresses.
1534.next
1535.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1536If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1537the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1538&'deferred'&.
1539.next
1540When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1541handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1542deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1543.endlist
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1549.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1550.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1551.cindex "queue runner"
1552Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1553attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1554uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1555intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1556not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1557first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1558its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1559passed its retry time.
1560You can run several queue runners at once.
1561
1562Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1563address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1564should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1565bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1566error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1567as permanent.
1568
1569
1570
1571.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1572.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1573There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1574particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1575connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1576detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1577Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1578is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1579impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1580also apply.
1581
1582If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1583waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1584connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1585deferred,
1586.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1587Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1588SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1589for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1590connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1591one connection.
1592
1593
1594
1595.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1596.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1597.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1598When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1599bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1600errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1601delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1602many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1603attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1604message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1605See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1606
1607.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1608Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1609failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1610automatically.
1611
1612.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1613A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1614obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1615address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1616forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1617failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1618&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1619of the list.
1620
1621
1622
1623.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1624.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1625If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1626itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1627but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1628that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1629for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1630&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1637. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1638
1639.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1640.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1641
1642.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1643Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1644creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1645&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1646
1647.table2 140pt
1648.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1649.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1650 documented"
1651.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1652.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1653.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1654.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1655 instructions"
1656.endtable
1657
1658Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1659following subdirectories are created:
1660
1661.table2 140pt
1662.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1663.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1664.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1665.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1666.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1667.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1668.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1669.endtable
1670
1671The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1672with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1673that may be useful to some sites.
1674
1675
1676.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1677.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1678The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1679a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1680source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1681Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1682system.
1683.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1684Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1685the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1686architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1687overridden if necessary.
1688.cindex compiler requirements
1689.cindex compiler version
1690A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1691
1692
1693.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1694.cindex "PCRE library"
1695Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1696modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1697install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1698system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1699process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1700headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1701and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1702or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1703If your operating system has no
1704PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1705from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1706More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1707
1708.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1709.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1710.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1711Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1712DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1713databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1714different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1715
1716.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1717.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1718.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1719.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1720If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1721Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1722may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1723you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1724
1725.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1726Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1727via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1728versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1729some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1730distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1731versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1732Berkeley DB library.
1733
1734Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1735use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1736possibilities:
1737
1738.olist
1739A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1740Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1741.next
1742.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1743The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1744compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1745&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1746filename is used unmodified.
1747.next
1748.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1749The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1750operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1751programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1752.next
1753If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1754file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1755the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1756.next
1757To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1758Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17592.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1760Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1761Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1762&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1763page with far newer versions listed.
1764It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1765Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1766suited to Exim's usage model.
1767.next
1768.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1769Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1770&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1771operates on a single file.
1772.endlist
1773
1774.cindex "USE_DB"
1775.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1776Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1777to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1778USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1779&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1780.code
1781USE_DB=yes
1782.endd
1783Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1784error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1785
1786At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1787thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1788configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1789Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1790configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1791&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1792
1793As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1794necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1795in one of these lines:
1796.code
1797DBMLIB = -ldb
1798DBMLIB = -ltdb
1799.endd
1800Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1801place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1802the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1803file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1804this example:
1805.code
1806INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1807DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1808.endd
1809There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1810file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1811
1812
1813
1814.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1815.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1816.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1817.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1818.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1819Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1820independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1821&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1822&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1823therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1824building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1825&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1826
1827There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1828without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1829(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1830(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1831maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1832a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1833
1834There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1835at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1836machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1837directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1838you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1839detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1840be logged.
1841
1842.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1843Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1844access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1845facilities, you need to set
1846.code
1847WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1848.endd
1849in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1850chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1851
1852
1853.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1854.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1855If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1856required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1857your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1858happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1859&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1860
1861This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1862operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1863to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1864configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1865defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1866do this.
1867
1868
1869
1870.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1871.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1872.cindex "RFC 2047"
1873The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1874described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1875in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1876character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1877mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1878(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1879supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1880
1881However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1882very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1883&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1884systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1885&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1886.code
1887HAVE_ICONV=yes
1888.endd
1889to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1890
1891
1892
1893.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1894.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1895.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1896.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1897.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1898Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1899command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1900start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1901&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1902line option).
1903
1904If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1905OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1906implementing SSL.
1907
1908If you do not want TLS support you should set
1909.code
1910DISABLE_TLS=yes
1911.endd
1912in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1913
1914If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1915.code
1916USE_OPENSL=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1920OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922USE_OPENSSL=yes
1923TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1924TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1925.endd
1926.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1927If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1928.code
1929USE_OPENSSL=yes
1930USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1931.endd
1932.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1933If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1934.code
1935USE_GNUTLS=yes
1936TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1937.endd
1938in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1939library and include files. For example:
1940.code
1941USE_GNUTLS=yes
1942TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1943TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1944.endd
1945.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1946If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1947.code
1948USE_GNUTLS=yes
1949USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1950.endd
1951
1952You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1953specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1954given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1960
1961.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1962.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1963.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1964.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1965Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1966SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1967alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1968already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1969should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1970&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1971&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1972EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1973you might have
1974.code
1975USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1976CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1977EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1978.endd
1979in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1980files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1981.code
1982exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1983.endd
1984in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1985the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1986All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1987can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1988&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1989configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1990further details.
1991
1992
1993.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1994.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1995Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1996&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1997it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1998where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1999library files.
2000
2001Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2002defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2003currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2004as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2005over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2006Exim used to
2007have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2008withdrawn.
2009
2010
2011
2012.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2013.cindex "lookup modules"
2014.cindex "dynamic modules"
2015.cindex ".so building"
2016On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2017the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2018on demand.
2019This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2020library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2021dependencies.
2022Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2023
2024Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2025installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2026measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2027for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2028Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2029see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2030
2031Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2032&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2033For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2034on demand:
2035.code
2036LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2037LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2038LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2039.endd
2040
2041
2042.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2043.cindex "build directory"
2044Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2045created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2046operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2047For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2048&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2049.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2050Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2051
2052If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2053a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2054&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2055&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2056then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2057number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2058makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2059directory, should this ever be necessary.
2060
2061If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2062&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2063FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2064
2065
2066
2067.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2068The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2069unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2070output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2071appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2072each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2073get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2074.code
2075FULLECHO='' make -e
2076.endd
2077The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2078command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2079given in addition to the short output.
2080
2081
2082
2083.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2084.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2085The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2086consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2087values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2088more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2089convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2090order:
2091.display
2092&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2093&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2094&_Local/Makefile_&
2095&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2096&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2097&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2098&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2099.endd
2100.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2101.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2102.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2103where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2104architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2105process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2106and are often not needed.
2107
2108The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2109called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2110the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2111values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2112Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2113fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2114of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2115that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2116to find out what values are being used on your system.
2117
2118
2119&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2120therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2121needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2122file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2123default values are.
2124
2125
2126.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2127If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2128or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2129need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2130putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2131.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2132when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2133formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2134compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2135called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2136Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2137default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2138containing the lines
2139.code
2140CC=cc
2141CFLAGS=-std1
2142.endd
2143If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2144these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2145
2146Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2147files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2148the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2149
2150
2151.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2152.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2153.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2154.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2155Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2156lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2157not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2158and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2159which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2160case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2161.code
2162LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2163LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2164LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2165.endd
2166and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2167&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2168libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2169.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2170However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2171the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2172files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2173binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2174errors.
2175
2176.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2177.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2178Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2179about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2180being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2181makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2182variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2183name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2184&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2185with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2186syntax. For instance:
2187.code
2188LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2189LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2190AUTH_GSASL=yes
2191AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2192AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2193AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2194.endd
2195
2196.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2197Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2198subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2199.code
2200EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2201.endd
2202must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2203chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2204
2205.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2206The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2207operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2208with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2209monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2210The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2211.code
2212X11=/usr/X11R6
2213XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2214XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2215.endd
2216These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2217example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2218.code
2219X11=/usr/openwin
2220XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2221XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2222.endd
2223If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2224definition of all three of these variables into your
2225&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2226
2227.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2228If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2229variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2230default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2231command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2232
2233.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2234There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2235use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2236EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2237binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2238libraries.
2239
2240.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2241The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2242files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2243necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2244&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2245
2246
2247.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2248.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2249.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2250The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2251&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2252normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2253recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2254are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2255
2256
2257
2258.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2259.cindex "building Eximon"
2260A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2261where the files that are involved are
2262.display
2263&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2264&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2265&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2266&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2267&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2268&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2269.endd
2270.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2271As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2272&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2273&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2274variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2275EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2276LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2277.ecindex IIDbuex
2278
2279
2280.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2281.cindex "installing Exim"
2282.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2283The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2284arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2285whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2286.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2287The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2288going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2289&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2290install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2291some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2292it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2293chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2294
2295.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2296Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2297in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2298exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2299by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2300is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2301alternative files, no default is installed.
2302
2303.cindex "system aliases file"
2304.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2305One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2306default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2307The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2308SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2309If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2310and outputs a comment to the user.
2311
2312The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2313aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2314kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2315&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2316Exim's configuration if necessary.
2317
2318The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2319and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2320running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2321directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2322other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2323over SMTP.
2324
2325It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2326distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2327command such as
2328.code
2329make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2330.endd
2331This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2332paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2333configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2334For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2335but this usage is deprecated.
2336
2337.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2338Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2339&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2340upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2341directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2342INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2343
2344For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2345to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2346installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2347for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2348called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2349of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2350from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2351
2352.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2353If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2354real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2355command:
2356.code
2357make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2358.endd
2359The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2360script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2361the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2362directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2363command:
2364.code
2365(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2366.endd
2367.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2368There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2369
2370.ilist
2371&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2372to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2373.next
2374&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2375installed binary.
2376.endlist
2377
2378INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2379.code
2380make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2381.endd
2382The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2383to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2384without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2385.code
2386make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2387.endd
2388
2389
2390
2391.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2392.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2393Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2394reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2395distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2396&<<SECTavail>>&).
2397
2398If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2399source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2400install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2401
2402
2403
2404.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2405.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2406When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2407exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2408directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2409necessary.
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2415.cindex "testing" "installation"
2416Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2417syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2418Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2419.code
2420exim -bV
2421.endd
2422If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2423Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2424the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2425other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2426Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2427example,
2428.display
2429&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2430.endd
2431should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2432.display
2433&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2434.endd
2435a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2436This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2437user agent. For example:
2438.code
2439exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2440From: user@your.domain.example
2441To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2442Subject: Testing Exim
2443
2444This is a test message.
2445^D
2446.endd
2447The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2448In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2449arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2450
2451.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2452If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2453&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2454of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2455&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2456with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2457.display
2458&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2459.endd
2460You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2461produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2462For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2463relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2464&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2465
2466.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2467.cindex "lock files"
2468One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2469local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2470&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2471writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2472is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2473directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2474that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2475&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2476approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2477&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2478agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2479see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2480
2481One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2482the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2483&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2484port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2485&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2486incoming SMTP mail.
2487
2488Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2489be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2490within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2491that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2492production version.
2493
2494
2495.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2496.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2497Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2498general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2499is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2500operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2501binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2502normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2503or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2504.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2505a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2506privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2507and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2508
2509.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2510.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2511Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2512example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2513&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2514described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2515as follows:
2516.code
2517sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2518send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2519mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2520newaliases /usr/bin/true
2521.endd
2522Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2523your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2524favourite user agent.
2525
2526You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2527have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2528various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2529command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2530use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2531&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2532
2533
2534
2535.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2536.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2537If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2538version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2539call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2540.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2541.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2542to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2543new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2544version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2545configuration file.
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2551.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2552The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2553.code
2554/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2555.endd
2556If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2557fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2558for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2559(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2560solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2561.code
2562pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2563.endd
2564to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2565
2566Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2567still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2568(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2574. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2575
2576.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2577.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2578.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2579Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2580each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2581options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2582some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2583combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2584The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2585
2586
2587.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2588.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2589If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2590were present before any other options.
2591The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2592standard output.
2593This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2594that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2595&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2596
2597.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2598If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2599were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2600&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2601format.
2602
2603.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2604If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2605&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2606Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2607
2608.cindex "&'runq'&"
2609.cindex "queue runner"
2610If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2611were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2612option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2613
2614.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2615.cindex "alias file" "building"
2616.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2617If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2618&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2619This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2620the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2621command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2622
2623
2624.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2625Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2626available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2627user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2628EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2629&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2630
2631.ilist
2632.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2633.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2634The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2635&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2636supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2637configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2638
2639.cindex '&"From"& line'
2640.cindex "envelope from"
2641.cindex "envelope sender"
2642Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2643&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2644Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2645See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2646users to set envelope senders.
2647
2648.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2649.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2650.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2651.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2652For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2653header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2654&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2655
2656Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2657protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2658locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2659have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2660users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2661that are available to trusted users.
2662.next
2663.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2664.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2665The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2666Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2667The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2668
2669Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2670operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2671necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2672the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2673
2674By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2675Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2676However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2677option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2678
2679Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2680is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2681false.
2682.endlist
2683
2684
2685&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2686edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2687getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2688&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2694Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2695of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2696a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2697format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2698on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2699with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2700outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2701
2702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2703. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2704. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2705. creates a man page for the options.
2706. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2707
2708.literal xml
2709<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2710.literal off
2711
2712
2713.vlist
2714.vitem &%--%&
2715.oindex "--"
2716.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2717This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2718therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2719rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2720
2721.vitem &%--help%&
2722.oindex "&%--help%&"
2723This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2724The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2725no arguments.
2726
2727.vitem &%--version%&
2728.oindex "&%--version%&"
2729This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2730displayed.
2731
2732.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2733 &%-Am%&
2734.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2735.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2736These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2737ignored by Exim.
2738
2739.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2740.oindex "&%-B%&"
2741.cindex "8-bit characters"
2742.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2743This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2744clean; it ignores this option.
2745
2746.vitem &%-bd%&
2747.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2748.cindex "daemon"
2749.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2750.cindex "queue runner"
2751This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2752the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2753that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2754
2755The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2756(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2757disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2758stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2759
2760By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2761all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2762ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2763&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2764
2765When a listening daemon
2766.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2767.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2768is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2769configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2770in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2771PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2772running as root.
2773
2774When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2775process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2776used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2777
2778The SIGHUP signal
2779.cindex "SIGHUP"
2780.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2781.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2782.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2783.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2784.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2785.cindex reload configuration
2786can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2787whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2788means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2789of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2790referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2791because these are reread each time they are used.
2792
2793.vitem &%-bdf%&
2794.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2795This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2796from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2797
2798.vitem &%-be%&
2799.oindex "&%-be%&"
2800.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2801.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2802Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2803prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2804files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2805of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2806
2807If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2808to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2809used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2810function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2811test data. A line history is supported.
2812
2813Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2814continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2815continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2816string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2817configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2818message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2819is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2820
2821&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2822files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2823the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2824of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2825
2826Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2827defined and macros will be expanded.
2828Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2829available to admin users.
2830
2831.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2832.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2833.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2834.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2835This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2836of a file. For example:
2837.code
2838exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2839.endd
2840The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2841message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2842variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2843no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2844recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2845&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2846line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2847&%-be%&).
2848
2849.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2850.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2851.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2852.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2853This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2854tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2855system filters are recognized.
2856
2857.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2858.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2859.cindex "filter" "testing"
2860.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2861.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2862.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2863.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2864This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2865to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2866there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2867supplied.
2868
2869If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2870can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2871filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2872.code
2873exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2874.endd
2875This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2876variables that are used by the user filter.
2877
2878If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2879.code
2880# Exim filter
2881# Sieve filter
2882.endd
2883it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2884that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2885&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2886redirection lists.
2887
2888The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2889detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2890with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2891separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2892
2893When testing a filter file,
2894.cindex "&""From""& line"
2895.cindex "envelope from"
2896.cindex "envelope sender"
2897.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2898the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2899or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2900that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2901can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2902options).
2903
2904.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2905.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2906.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2907This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2908tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2909&$qualify_domain$&.
2910
2911.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2912.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2913This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2914tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2915process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2916suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2917actually being delivered.
2918
2919.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2920.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2921.cindex affix "filter testing"
2922This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2923file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2924prefix.
2925
2926.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2927.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2928.cindex affix "filter testing"
2929This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2930file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2931suffix.
2932
2933.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2934.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2935.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2936.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2937.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2938.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2939.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2940.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2941This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2942standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2943after a full stop. For example:
2944.code
2945exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2946exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2947.endd
2948When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2949of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2950conversion to the canonical form is
2951&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2952
2953Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2954include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2955This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2956messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2957test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2958
2959&*Warning 1*&:
2960.cindex "RFC 1413"
2961You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2962information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2963an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2964connection.
2965
2966&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2967are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2968occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2969
2970Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2971written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2972lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2973can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2974and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2975session were authenticated.
2976
2977The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2978output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2979acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2980
2981Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2982plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2983specialized SMTP test program such as
2984&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2985
2986.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2987.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2988This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2989verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2990updating the callout cache database.
2991
2992.vitem &%-bi%&
2993.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2994.cindex "alias file" "building"
2995.cindex "building alias file"
2996.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2997Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2998Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2999this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3000tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3001recognized.
3002
3003If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3004configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3005the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3006The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3007use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3008if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3009&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3010
3011. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3012.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3013.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3014.cindex "querying exim information"
3015We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3016information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3017consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3018synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3019options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3020
3021.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3022.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3023.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3024This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3025recognised DSCP names.
3026
3027.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3028.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3029.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3030This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3031Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3032useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3033&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3034compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3035way to guarantee a correct response.
3036
3037.vitem &%-bm%&
3038.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3039.cindex "local message reception"
3040This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3041locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3042command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3043argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3044default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3045if no other conflicting option is present.
3046
3047If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3048qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3049options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3050suppressing this for special cases.
3051
3052Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3053the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3054
3055.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3056The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3057action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3058
3059The format
3060.cindex "message" "format"
3061.cindex "format" "message"
3062.cindex "&""From""& line"
3063.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3064.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3065of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3066compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3067.code
3068From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3069From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3070.endd
3071(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3072is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3073authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3074matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3075option, which can be changed if necessary.
3076
3077.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3078The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3079&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3080preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3081trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3082
3083.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3084.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3085.cindex "testing", "malware"
3086.cindex "malware scan test"
3087This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3088(depending on the used scanner interface),
3089using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3090this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3091the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3092not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3093will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3094
3095Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3096using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3097user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3098This option requires admin privileges.
3099
3100The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3101there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3102administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3103
3104.vitem &%-bnq%&
3105.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3106.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3107By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3108without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3109is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3110envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3111&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3112defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3113
3114Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3115being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3116content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3117header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3118syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3119
3120The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3121messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3122addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3123unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3124
3125
3126.vitem &%-bP%&
3127.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3128.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3129.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3130If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3131main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3132of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3133arguments, for example:
3134.code
3135exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3136.endd
3137.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3138.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3139.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3140However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3141configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3142users, the output is as in this example:
3143.code
3144mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3145.endd
3146If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3147output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3148
3149If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3150configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3151backward compatibility.)
3152If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3153is the name of the file that was actually used.
3154
3155.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3156If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3157name will not be output.
3158
3159.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3160.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3161If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3162directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3163respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3164sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3165written directly into the spool directory.
3166
3167If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3168.code
3169exim -bP +local_domains
3170.endd
3171it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3172local part) and outputs what it finds.
3173
3174.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3175.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3176.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3177If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3178followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3179that driver are output. For example:
3180.code
3181exim -bP transport local_delivery
3182.endd
3183The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3184options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3185using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3186&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3187settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3188&%authenticators%&.
3189
3190.cindex "environment"
3191If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3192variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3193variables.
3194
3195.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3196If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3197are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3198for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3199The output format is one item per line.
3200For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3201the exit status will be nonzero.
3202
3203.vitem &%-bp%&
3204.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3205.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3206.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3207This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3208standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3209just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3210admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3211to allow any user to see the queue.
3212
3213Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3214.code
321525m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3216 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3217 <other addresses>
3218.endd
3219.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3220.cindex "size" "of message"
3221The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3222(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3223identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3224envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3225&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3226the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3227before the sender address.
3228
3229.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3230If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3231&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3232
3233The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3234displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3235been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3236expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3237displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3238complete.
3239
3240
3241.vitem &%-bpa%&
3242.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3243This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3244that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3245alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3246of just &"D"&.
3247
3248
3249.vitem &%-bpc%&
3250.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3251.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3252This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3253to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3254&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3255
3256
3257.vitem &%-bpr%&
3258.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3259This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3260chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3261lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3262going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3263
3264.vitem &%-bpra%&
3265.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3266This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3267
3268.vitem &%-bpru%&
3269.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3270This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3271
3272
3273.vitem &%-bpu%&
3274.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3275This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3276addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3277forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3278router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3279
3280
3281.vitem &%-brt%&
3282.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3283.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3284.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3285This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3286arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3287and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3288.code
3289exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3290Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3291.endd
3292See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3293argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3294&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3295contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3296retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3297with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3298rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3299sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3300used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3301.code
3302exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3303Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3304.endd
3305
3306.vitem &%-brw%&
3307.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3308.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3309.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3310This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3311a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3312complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3313would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3314&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3315
3316.vitem &%-bS%&
3317.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3318.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3319.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3320This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3321for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3322submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3323input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3324input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3325&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3326believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3327
3328The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3329dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3330provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3331
3332As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3333messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3334Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3335&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3336
3337Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3338as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3339QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3340
3341.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3342If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3343error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3344was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3345was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3346
3347More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3348&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3349
3350.vitem &%-bs%&
3351.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3352.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3353.cindex "local SMTP input"
3354This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3355on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3356policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3357Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3358messages to the MTA.
3359
3360In
3361.cindex "sender" "source of"
3362this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3363set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3364Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3365the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3366&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3367&%-bnq%& option is used.
3368
3369.cindex "inetd"
3370The
3371&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3372using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3373whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3374&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3375above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3376Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3377the listening daemon.
3378
3379.vitem &%-bt%&
3380.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3381.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3382.cindex "address" "testing"
3383This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3384as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3385written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3386user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3387sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3388
3389If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3390right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3391
3392Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3393&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3394security issues.
3395
3396Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3397(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3398written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3399&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3400genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3401program.
3402
3403.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3404The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3405failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3406code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3407
3408.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3409&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3410addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3411This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3412always shown.
3413
3414&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3415routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3416message,
3417.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3418you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3419&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3420default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3421whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3422those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3423doing such tests.
3424
3425.vitem &%-bV%&
3426.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3427.cindex "version number of Exim"
3428This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3429number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3430It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3431specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3432name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3433
3434As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3435configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3436values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3437detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3438alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3439realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3440dynamic testing facilities.
3441
3442.vitem &%-bv%&
3443.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3444.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3445.cindex "address" "verification"
3446This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3447taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3448not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3449happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3450(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3451including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3452
3453If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3454failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3455usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3456
3457If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3458right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3459
3460Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3461&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3462security issues.
3463
3464Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3465that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3466router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3467verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3468address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3469
3470If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3471address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3472latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3473causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3474addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3475and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3476to succeed.
3477
3478When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3479and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3480considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3481
3482The
3483.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3484return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3485failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3486code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3487
3488If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3489address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3490sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3491calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3492
3493.vitem &%-bvs%&
3494.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3495This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3496than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3497might happen.
3498
3499.vitem &%-bw%&
3500.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3501.cindex "daemon"
3502.cindex "inetd"
3503.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3504This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3505similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3506and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3507
3508In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3509listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3510inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3511each port only when the first connection is received.
3512
3513If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3514which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3515
3516.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3517.oindex "&%-C%&"
3518.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3519.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3520.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3521This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3522list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3523compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3524but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3525file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3526proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3527
3528When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3529from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3530runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3531However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3532file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3533which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3534listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3535CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3536not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3537
3538Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3539configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3540even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3541running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3542delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3543test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3544in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3545
3546If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3547prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3548must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3549However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3550CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3551usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3552unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3553
3554ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3555to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3556broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3557configuration file.
3558
3559The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3560syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3561caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3562require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3563specified by this option.
3564
3565
3566.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3567.oindex "&%-D%&"
3568.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3569This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3570(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3571unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3572If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3573completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3574
3575If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3576colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3577supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3578not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3579the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3580to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3581regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3582
3583The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3584command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3585string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3586synonymous:
3587.code
3588exim -DABC ...
3589exim -DABC= ...
3590.endd
3591To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3592quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3593example:
3594.code
3595exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3596.endd
3597&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3598Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3599
3600
3601.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3602.oindex "&%-d%&"
3603.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3604.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3605This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3606error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3607database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3608filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3609writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3610return code.
3611
3612When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3613standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3614some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3615made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3616of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3617debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3618no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3619are:
3620.display
3621&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3622&`auth `& authenticators
3623&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3624&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3625&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3626&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3627&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3628&`filter `& filter handling
3629&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3630&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3631&`ident `& ident lookup
3632&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3633&`lists `& matching things in lists
3634&`load `& system load checks
3635&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3636 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3637&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3638&`memory `& memory handling
3639&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3640&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3641&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3642&`queue_run `& queue runs
3643&`receive `& general message reception logic
3644&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3645&`retry `& retry handling
3646&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3647&`route `& address routing
3648&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3649&`tls `& TLS logic
3650&`transport `& transports
3651&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3652&`verify `& address verification logic
3653&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3654.endd
3655The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3656for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3657tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3658is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3659generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3660turn everything off.
3661
3662.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3663.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3664The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3665with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3666unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3667rather than stderr.
3668
3669The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3670&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3671However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3672daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3673automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3674run in parallel.
3675
3676The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3677of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3678in processing.
3679
3680.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3681.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3682The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3683UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3684When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3685Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3686
3687If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3688any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3689
3690.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3691.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3692This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3693starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3694subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3695behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3696
3697.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3698.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3699This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3700handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3701described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3702
3703.vitem &%-E%&
3704.oindex "&%-E%&"
3705.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3706This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3707failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3708and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3709generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3710could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3711follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3712new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3713
3714.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3715.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3716There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3717called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3718example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3719form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3720
3721.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3722.oindex "&%-F%&"
3723.cindex "sender" "name"
3724.cindex "name" "of sender"
3725This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3726message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3727entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3728their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3729between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3730
3731.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3732.oindex "&%-f%&"
3733.cindex "sender" "address"
3734.cindex "address" "sender"
3735.cindex "trusted users"
3736.cindex "envelope from"
3737.cindex "envelope sender"
3738.cindex "user" "trusted"
3739This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3740message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3741by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3742users to use it.
3743
3744Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3745trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3746options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3747of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3748domain.
3749
3750There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3751can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3752never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3753string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3754examples of shell commands:
3755.code
3756exim -f '<>' user@domain
3757exim -f "" user@domain
3758.endd
3759In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3760with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3761&%-bv%& options.
3762
3763Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3764it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3765refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3766though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3767
3768White
3769.cindex "&""From""& line"
3770space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3771given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3772locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3773&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3774if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3775
3776.vitem &%-G%&
3777.oindex "&%-G%&"
3778.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3779This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3780.code
3781control = suppress_local_fixups
3782.endd
3783for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3784bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3785in future.
3786
3787As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3788this option.
3789
3790.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3791.oindex "&%-h%&"
3792.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3793This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3794Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3795headers.)
3796
3797.vitem &%-i%&
3798.oindex "&%-i%&"
3799.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3800.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3801This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3802line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3803no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3804command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3805
3806.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3807.oindex "&%-L%&"
3808.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3809This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3810file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3811Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3812read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3813effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3814
3815The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3816
3817.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3818.oindex "&%-M%&"
3819.cindex "forcing delivery"
3820.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3821.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3822This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3823any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3824delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3825and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3826
3827Retry
3828.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3829hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3830the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3831to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3832which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3833for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3834
3835The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3836not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3837produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3838use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3839
3840.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3841.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3842.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3843.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3844This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3845message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3846id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3847active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3848can be used only by an admin user.
3849
3850.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3851 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3852.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3853.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3854.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3855.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3856This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3858an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3859given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3860must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3861
3862.vitem &%-MCA%&
3863.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3864This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3865by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3866connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3867
3868.vitem &%-MCD%&
3869.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3870This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3872remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3873
3874.new
3875.vitem &%-MCd%&
3876.oindex "&%-MCd%&"
3877This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3879to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3880.wen
3881
3882.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3883.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3884This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3886alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3887
3888.vitem &%-MCK%&
3889.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3890This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3891by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3892remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3893
3894.vitem &%-MCP%&
3895.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3896This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3897by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3898which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3899
3900.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3901.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3902This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3903by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3904started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3905together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3906signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3907messages through the same SMTP connection.
3908
3909.vitem &%-MCS%&
3910.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3911This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3914connection.
3915
3916.vitem &%-MCT%&
3917.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3918This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3919by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3920host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3921
3922.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3923.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3924This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3925by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3926connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3927The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3928
3929.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3931.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3932.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3933This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3934but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3935that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3936provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3937order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3938However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3939respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3940overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3941If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3942&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3943and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3944
3945.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3946.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3947.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3948.cindex "sender" "changing"
3949This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3950given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3951&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3952be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3953is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3954This option can be used only by an admin user.
3955
3956.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3957.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3958.cindex "freezing messages"
3959.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3960This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3961prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3962either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3963However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3964attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3965user.
3966
3967.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3968.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3969.cindex "giving up on messages"
3970.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3971.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3972This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3973including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3974their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3975is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3976Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3977user.
3978
3979.vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3980.oindex "&%-MG%&"
3981.cindex queue named
3982.cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3983.cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3984This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3985queue to the given named queue.
3986The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3987string to define the default queue.
3988If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3989a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3990
3991.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3992.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3993.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3994This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3995as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3996message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3997altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3998
3999.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4000.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
4001.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4002.cindex "recipient" "removing"
4003.cindex "removing recipients"
4004This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4005(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4006the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4007addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4008(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4009can be used only by an admin user.
4010
4011.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4012.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4013.cindex "removing messages"
4014.cindex "abandoning mail"
4015.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4016This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4017bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4018the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4019only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4020placed in the queue.
4021
4022. .new
4023. .vitem &%-MS%&
4024. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4025. .cindex REQUIRETLS
4026. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4027. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4028. a bounce message.
4029. .wen
4030
4031.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4032.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4033.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4034.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4035This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4036string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4037the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4038&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4039available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4040make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4041user. See also &%-bem%&.
4042
4043.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4044.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4045.cindex "thawing messages"
4046.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4047.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4048.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4049This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4050&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4051messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4052by an admin user.
4053
4054.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4055.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4056.cindex "listing" "message body"
4057.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4058This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4059written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4060
4061.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4062.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4063.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4064.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4065This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4066be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4067only by an admin user.
4068
4069.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4070.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4071.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4072.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4073.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4074This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4075written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4076
4077.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4078.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4079.cindex "listing" "message log"
4080.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4081This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4082the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4083
4084.vitem &%-m%&
4085.oindex "&%-m%&"
4086This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4087treats it that way too.
4088
4089.vitem &%-N%&
4090.oindex "&%-N%&"
4091.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4092.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4093This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4094level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4095it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4096had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4097database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4098than &"=>"&.
4099
4100Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4101user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4102words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4103which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4104address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4105routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4106the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4107for that message.
4108
4109.vitem &%-n%&
4110.oindex "&%-n%&"
4111This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4112For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4113When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4114option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4115
4116.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4117.oindex "&%-O%&"
4118This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4119Exim.
4120
4121.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4122.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4123.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4124This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4125alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4126description above.
4127
4128.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4129.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4130.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4131.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4132.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4133This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4134be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4135transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4136
4137.vitem &%-odb%&
4138.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4139.cindex "background delivery"
4140.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4141This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4142including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4143messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4144delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4145processes to finish.
4146
4147When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4148leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4149and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4150This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4151
4152If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4153(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4154overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4155setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4156
4157.vitem &%-odf%&
4158.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4159.cindex "foreground delivery"
4160.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4161This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4162accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4163&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4164and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4165
4166The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4167process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4168during deliveries.
4169
4170However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4171false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4172
4173If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4174message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4175process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4176restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4177
4178
4179.vitem &%-odi%&
4180.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4181This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4182Sendmail.
4183
4184.vitem &%-odq%&
4185.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4186.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4187.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4188.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4189This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4190including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4191not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4192are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4193process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4194&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4195conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4196forces queueing.
4197
4198.vitem &%-odqs%&
4199.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4200.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4201.cindex "first pass routing"
4202This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4203However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4204&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4205configuration file is in effect.
4206
4207When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4208message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4209also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4210in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4211done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4212runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4213messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4214host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4215configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4216&%-qq%& option.
4217
4218.vitem &%-oee%&
4219.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4220.cindex "error" "reporting"
4221If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4222example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4223message.
4224
4225.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4226Provided
4227this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4228exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4229is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4230This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4231
4232.vitem &%-oem%&
4233.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4234.cindex "error" "reporting"
4235.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4236This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4237return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4238This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4239
4240.vitem &%-oep%&
4241.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4242.cindex "error" "reporting"
4243If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4244error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4245.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4246The return code is 1 for all errors.
4247
4248.vitem &%-oeq%&
4249.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4250.cindex "error" "reporting"
4251This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4252effect as &%-oep%&.
4253
4254.vitem &%-oew%&
4255.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4256.cindex "error" "reporting"
4257This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4258effect as &%-oem%&.
4259
4260.vitem &%-oi%&
4261.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4262.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4263This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4264line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4265single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4266lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4267&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4268
4269.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4270.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4271This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4272
4273.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4274.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4275.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4276A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4277with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4278over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4279&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4280other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4281
4282The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4283number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4284.code
4285exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4286.endd
4287An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4288followed by a colon and the port number:
4289.code
4290exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4291.endd
4292The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4293port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4294are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4295whichever one is last.
4296
4297.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4298.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4299.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4300See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4301option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4302name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4303This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4304authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4305
4306.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4307.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4308.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4309See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4310option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4311This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4312where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4313&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4314
4315.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4316.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4317.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4318See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4319option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4320overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4321messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4322default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4323specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4324&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4325
4326.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4327.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4328.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4329See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4330option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4331using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4332&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4333
4334.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4335.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4336.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4337See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4338option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4339delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4340messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4341abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4342running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4343
4344The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4345The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4346is sending the bounce.
4347
4348.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4349.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4350.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4351.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4352See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4353option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4354&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4355or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4356SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4357&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4358one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4359be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4360
4361.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4362.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4363.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4364See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4365option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4366present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4367uses the name it is given.
4368
4369.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4370.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4371.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4372See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4373option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4374local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4375used, when there is no default.
4376
4377.vitem &%-om%&
4378.oindex "&%-om%&"
4379.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4380In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4381message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4382expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4383
4384.vitem &%-oo%&
4385.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4386.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4387This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4388whatever that means.
4389
4390.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4391.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4392.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4393.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4394This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4395value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4396written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4397without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4398because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4399
4400.new
4401.vitem &%-oPX%&
4402.oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4403.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4404.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4405This option is not intended for general use.
4406The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4407combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4408It causes the pid file to be removed.
4409.wen
4410
4411.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4412.oindex "&%-or%&"
4413.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4414This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4415set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4416by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4417described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4418
4419.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4420.oindex "&%-os%&"
4421.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4422.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4423This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4424applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4425the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4426for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4427
4428.vitem &%-ov%&
4429.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4430This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4431
4432.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4433.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4434.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4435.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4436.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4437This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4438is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4439of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4440in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4441file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4442
4443.vitem &%-pd%&
4444.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4445.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4446This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4447chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4448option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4449needed.
4450
4451.vitem &%-ps%&
4452.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4453.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4454This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4455chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4456option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4457started.
4458
4459.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4460.oindex "&%-p%&"
4461For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4462.display
4463&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4464.endd
4465It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4466host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4467Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4468to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4469or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4470Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4471
4472.vitem &%-q%&
4473.oindex "&%-q%&"
4474.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4475This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4476configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4477relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4478and &%-S%& options).
4479
4480.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4481If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4482the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4483waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4484for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4485process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4486have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4487
4488If
4489.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4490.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4491.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4492the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4493passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4494proceeding.
4495
4496When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4497process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4498mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4499this to be repeated periodically.
4500
4501Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4502random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4503If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4504MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4505
4506It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4507order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4508&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4509
4510.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4511The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4512behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4513appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4514
4515.vitem &%-qq...%&
4516.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4517.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4518.cindex "queue" "routing"
4519.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4520.cindex "first pass routing"
4521An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4522stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4523every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4524transports are run.
4525
4526.new
4527Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4528.wen
4529
4530.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4531The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4532is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4533complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4534place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4535delivered down a single SMTP
4536.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4537.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4538.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4539connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4540This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4541intermittently.
4542
4543.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4544.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4545.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4546If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4547those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4548delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4549&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4550
4551.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4552.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4553.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4554.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4555If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4556message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4557their retry times are tried.
4558
4559.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4560.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4561.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4562If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4563frozen or not.
4564
4565.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4566.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4567.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4568The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4569be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4570for later delivery.
4571
4572.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4573.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4574.cindex queue named
4575.cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4576.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4577If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4578queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4579The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4580For a periodic queue run (see below)
4581append to the name a slash and a time value.
4582
4583If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4584will specify a queue to operate on.
4585For example:
4586.code
4587exim -bp -qGquarantine
4588mailq -qGquarantine
4589exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4590.endd
4591
4592.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4593When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4594lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4595starting message id. For example:
4596.code
4597exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4598.endd
4599Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4600second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4601are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4602.code
4603exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4604.endd
4605just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4606&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4607that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4608mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4609are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4610queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4611
4612.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4613.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4614.cindex "periodic queue running"
4615When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4616starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4617(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4618&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4619single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4620combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4621.code
4622/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4623.endd
4624Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4625process every 30 minutes.
4626
4627When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4628pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4629
4630.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4631.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4632This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4633compatibility.
4634
4635.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4636.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4637This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4638
4639.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4640.oindex "&%-R%&"
4641.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4642.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4643.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4644The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4645is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4646which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4647<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4648
4649This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4650perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4651queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4652address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4653way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4654regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4655
4656If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4657you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4658.code
4659exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4660.endd
4661This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4662every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4663applied to each queue run.
4664
4665Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4666are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4667information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4668means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4669existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4670address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4671will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4672information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4673address will be skipped.
4674
4675.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4676If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4677all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4678&'ff'& is present.
4679
4680The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4681to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4682command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4683effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4684an arbitrary command instead.
4685
4686.vitem &%-r%&
4687.oindex "&%-r%&"
4688This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4689
4690.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4691.oindex "&%-S%&"
4692.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4693.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4694This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4695message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4696conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4697has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4698
4699.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4700.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4701This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4702recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4703&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4704
4705.vitem &%-t%&
4706.oindex "&%-t%&"
4707.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4708.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4709.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4710.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4711When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4712input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4713from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4714from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4715takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4716
4717.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4718If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4719is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4720the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4721and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4722Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4723Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4724argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4725Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4726instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4727&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4728
4729.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4730If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4731recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4732lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4733with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4734&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4735
4736RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4737message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4738added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4739not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4740nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4741In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4742are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4743once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4744&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4745
4746.vitem &%-ti%&
4747.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4748This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4749compatibility with Sendmail.
4750
4751.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4752.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4753.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4754.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4755This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4756incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4757&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4758&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4759
4760
4761.vitem &%-U%&
4762.oindex "&%-U%&"
4763.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4764Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4765documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4766syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4767set. Exim ignores this option.
4768
4769.vitem &%-v%&
4770.oindex "&%-v%&"
4771This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4772describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4773receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4774dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4775the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4776selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4777unconditional.
4778
4779.vitem &%-x%&
4780.oindex "&%-x%&"
4781AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4782National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4783It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4784this option.
4785
4786.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4787.oindex "&%-X%&"
4788This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4789to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4790
4791.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4792.oindex "&%-z%&"
4793This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4794Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4795Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4796under most shells.
4797.endlist
4798
4799.ecindex IIDclo1
4800.ecindex IIDclo2
4801
4802
4803. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4804. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4805. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4806. creates a man page for the options.
4807. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4808
4809.literal xml
4810<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4811.literal off
4812
4813
4814
4815
4816
4817. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4818. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4819
4820
4821.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4822 "The runtime configuration file"
4823
4824.cindex "runtime configuration"
4825.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4826.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4827.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4828.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4829.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4830Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4831binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4832because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4833control.
4834
4835If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4836writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4837The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4838errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4839not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4840actually alter the string.
4841
4842The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4843reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4844most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4845give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4846existing file in the list.
4847
4848.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4849.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4850.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4851.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4852.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4853.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4854The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4855specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4856configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4857group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4858CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4859
4860&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4861to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4862easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4863CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4864who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4865
4866Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4867be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4868since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4869compromise the Exim user account.
4870
4871A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4872is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4873defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4874configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4875CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4876&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4877configuration.
4878
4879
4880
4881.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4882.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4883A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4884option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4885&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4886unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4887CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4888is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4889is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4890installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4891specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4892
4893Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4894with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4895listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4896testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4897delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4898Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4899the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4900can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4901message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4902&%-M%&).
4903
4904If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4905prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4906start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4907There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4908filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4909
4910One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4911option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4912configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4913non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4914If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4915completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4916
4917The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4918to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4919necessarily be discarded.
4920WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4921considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4922values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4923is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4924transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4925values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4926
4927Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4928share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4929If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4930looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4931and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4932file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4933each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4934
4935In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4936different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4937help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4938
4939
4940
4941.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4942.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4943.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4944Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4945option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4946are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4947is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4948space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4949
4950.ilist
4951&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4952&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4953.next
4954.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4955&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4956are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4957.next
4958&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4959addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4960&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4961.next
4962&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4963define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4964&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4965.next
4966&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4967If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4968defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4969are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4970&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4971.next
4972&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4973when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4974chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4975.next
4976&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4977want to use this feature, you must set
4978.code
4979LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4980.endd
4981in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4982facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4983.endlist
4984
4985.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4986.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4987.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4988Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4989
4990Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4991leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4992# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4993and does not introduce a comment.
4994
4995Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4996the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4997backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4998lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4999appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5000
5001A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5002default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5003change settings as required.
5004
5005The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5006described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5007respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5008items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5009onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5010described.
5011
5012
5013
5014.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5015.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5016.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5017.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5018.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5019You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5020using this syntax:
5021.display
5022&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5023&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5024.endd
5025on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5026the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5027second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5028The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5029the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5030is required.
5031
5032Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5033configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5034If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5035because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5036
5037The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5038comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5039for example:
5040.code
5041hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5042 .include /some/file
5043.endd
5044Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5045process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5046inclusion appears.
5047
5048
5049
5050.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5051.cindex "macro" "description of"
5052.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5053If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5054&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5055definition, and must be of the form
5056.display
5057<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5058.endd
5059The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5060in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5061continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5062space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5063a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5064
5065Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5066definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5067ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5068
5069.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5070Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5071files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5072scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5073replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5074for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5075the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5076define
5077.display
5078&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5079&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5080.endd
5081but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5082error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5083before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5084consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5085line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5086comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5087
5088
5089.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5090Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5091(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5092&'='&. For example:
5093.code
5094MAC = initial value
5095...
5096MAC == updated value
5097.endd
5098Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5099subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5100the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5101Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5102.code
5103MAC = initial value
5104...
5105MAC == MAC and something added
5106.endd
5107This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5108from a number of other files.
5109
5110.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5111The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5112&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5113used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5114using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5115file to be ignored.
5116
5117
5118
5119.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5120As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5121up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5122strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5123.code
5124ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5125 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5126.endd
5127This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5128.code
5129data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5130.endd
5131In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5132address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5133section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5134
5135
5136.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5137Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5138differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5139All of these macros start with an underscore.
5140They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5141(see below).
5142
5143The following classes of macros are defined:
5144.display
5145&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5146&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5147&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5148&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5149&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5150&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5151&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5152&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5153&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5154&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5155&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5156&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5157.endd
5158
5159Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5160
5161
5162.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5163.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5164.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5165You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5166&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5167portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5168read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5169
5170The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5171be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5172that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5173line. Thus:
5174.code
5175.ifdef AAA
5176message_size_limit = 50M
5177.else
5178message_size_limit = 100M
5179.endif
5180.endd
5181sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5182(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5183otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5184is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5185obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5186
5187Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5188it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5189in this line"& will always be true.
5190
5191Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5192to clarify complicated nestings.
5193
5194
5195
5196.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5197.cindex "common option syntax"
5198.cindex "syntax of common options"
5199.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5200For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5201each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5202lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5203these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5204space) and then the value. For example:
5205.code
5206qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5207.endd
5208.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5209.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5210.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5211Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5212accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5213line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5214word &"hide"&. For example:
5215.code
5216hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5217.endd
5218For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5219.code
5220mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5221.endd
5222If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5223all instances of the same driver.
5224
5225The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5226that are found in option settings.
5227
5228
5229.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5230.cindex "format" "boolean"
5231.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5232.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5233.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5234Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5235different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5236the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5237if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5238boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5239&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5240the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5241.code
5242queue_only
5243queue_only = true
5244.endd
5245The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5246.code
5247no_queue_only
5248queue_only = false
5249.endd
5250You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5251
5252
5253
5254
5255.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5256.cindex "integer configuration values"
5257.cindex "format" "integer"
5258If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5259hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5260number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5261with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5262hexadecimal number.
5263
5264If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5265it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5266if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5267When the values
5268of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52691024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5270and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5271used.
5272
5273
5274.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5275.cindex "integer format"
5276.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5277If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5278interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5279Such options are always output in octal.
5280
5281
5282.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5283.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5284.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5285If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5286integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5287
5288
5289
5290.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5291.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5292.cindex "format" "time interval"
5293A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5294the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5295
5296.table2 30pt
5297.irow &%s%& seconds
5298.irow &%m%& minutes
5299.irow &%h%& hours
5300.irow &%d%& days
5301.irow &%w%& weeks
5302.endtable
5303
5304For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5305intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5306is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5307
5308
5309
5310.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5311.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5312.cindex "format" "string"
5313If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5314or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5315consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5316the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5317removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5318Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5319appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5320therefore equivalent:
5321.code
5322trusted_users = uucp:mail
5323trusted_users = uucp:\
5324 # This comment line is ignored
5325 mail
5326.endd
5327.cindex "string" "quoted"
5328.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5329If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5330double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5331continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5332
5333.table2 100pt
5334.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5335.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5336.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5337.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5338.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5339.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5340 character"
5341.endtable
5342
5343If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5344character, that character replaces the pair.
5345
5346Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5347insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5348trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5349current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5350in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5351and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5352
5353
5354.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5355.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5356Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5357by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5358circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5359is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5360strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5361However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5362backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5363within a quoted configuration string.
5364
5365
5366.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5367.cindex "user name" "format of"
5368.cindex "format" "user name"
5369.cindex "groups" "name format"
5370.cindex "format" "group name"
5371User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5372above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5373either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5374&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5375
5376
5377.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5378.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5379.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5380.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5381The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5382default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5383the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5384&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5385are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5386particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5387&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5388
5389In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5390input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5391&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5392in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5393on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5394start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5395example, the list
5396.code
5397local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5398.endd
5399contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5400
5401&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5402list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5403colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5404be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5405
5406.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5407.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5408.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5409Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5410introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5411with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5412character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5413above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5414.code
5415local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5416.endd
5417This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5418&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5419confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5420
5421.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5422.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5423It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5424code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5425must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5426are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5427sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5428interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5429generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5430.code
5431domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5432.endd
5433This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5434to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5435expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5436the value in quotes. For example:
5437.code
5438local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5439.endd
5440Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5441doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5442set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5443enclosing an empty list item.
5444
5445
5446
5447.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5448.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5449An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5450separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5451.code
5452senders = user@domain :
5453.endd
5454contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5455in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5456items, the second of which is empty:
5457.code
5458senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5459.endd
5460&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5461are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5462would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5463just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5464.code
5465senders = :
5466.endd
5467In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5468is at the end of the list.
5469
5470
5471
5472
5473.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5474.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5475There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5476and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5477instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5478a sequence of lines like this:
5479.display
5480<&'instance name'&>:
5481 <&'option'&>
5482 ...
5483 <&'option'&>
5484.endd
5485In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5486followed by three options settings:
5487.code
5488localuser:
5489 driver = accept
5490 check_local_user
5491 transport = local_delivery
5492.endd
5493For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5494setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5495settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5496deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5497a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5498described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5499
5500You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5501the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5502
5503The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5504passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5505transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5506authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5507them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5508server.
5509
5510.cindex "generic options"
5511.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5512Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5513and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5514same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5515&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5516.cindex "private options"
5517The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5518they all have default values.
5519
5520The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5521precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5522this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5523
5524Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5525elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5526with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5527a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5528instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5529confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5530configuration lines:
5531.code
5532remote_smtp:
5533 driver = smtp
5534.endd
5535create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5536&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5537different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5538instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5539thus:
5540.code
5541special_smtp:
5542 driver = smtp
5543 port = 1234
5544 command_timeout = 10s
5545.endd
5546The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5547these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5548lines.
5549
5550Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5551list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5552defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5553option.
5554
5555
5556
5557
5558
5559
5560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5561. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5562
5563.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5564.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5565.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5566The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5567is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5568the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5569configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5570of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5571itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5572initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5573mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5574
5575
5576
5577.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5578All macros should be defined before any options.
5579
5580One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5581.code
5582# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5583.endd
5584If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5585hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5586later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5587deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5588
5589In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5590to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5591given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5592
5593
5594.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5595The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5596in the file, after the macros.
5597The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5598.code
5599# primary_hostname =
5600.endd
5601This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5602to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5603can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5604it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5605
5606The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5607.code
5608domainlist local_domains = @
5609domainlist relay_to_domains =
5610hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5611.endd
5612These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5613domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5614domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5615configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5616
5617The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5618later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5619on the local host.
5620
5621.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5622There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5623of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5624called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5625be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5626the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5627
5628The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5629list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5630controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5631domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5632domain is permitted.
5633
5634The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5635used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5636that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5637loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5638submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5639hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5640
5641Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5642we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5643and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5644
5645The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5646.code
5647acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5648acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5649.endd
5650These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5651during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5652command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5653respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5654&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5655section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5656accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5657to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5658contents of a message to be checked.
5659
5660Two commented-out option settings are next:
5661.code
5662# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5663# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5664.endd
5665These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5666content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5667scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5668details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5669
5670Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5671.code
5672# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5673# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5674# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5675.endd
5676These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5677support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5678first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5679connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5680other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5681key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5682More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5683
5684Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5685.code
5686# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5687# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5688.endd
5689.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5690.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5691.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5692.cindex "submissions protocol"
5693.cindex "smtps protocol"
5694.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5695.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5696.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5697.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5698These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5699server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5700TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5701more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5702Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5703to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5704much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5705consequences).
5706RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5707which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5708RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5709which should be used in preference to 587.
5710You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5711these ports.
5712Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5713
5714Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5715.code
5716# qualify_domain =
5717# qualify_recipient =
5718.endd
5719The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5720complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5721receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5722the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5723you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5724addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5725
5726.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5727The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5728addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5729(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5730.code
5731# allow_domain_literals
5732.endd
5733The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5734Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5735quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5736try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5737people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5738&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5739
5740The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5741.code
5742never_users = root
5743.endd
5744It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5745convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5746setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5747The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5748list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5749FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5750contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5751FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5752
5753When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5754Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5755line,
5756.code
5757host_lookup = *
5758.endd
5759specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5760in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5761information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5762or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5763Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5764because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5765unreachable.
5766
5767The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57681413 (hence their names):
5769.code
5770rfc1413_hosts = *
5771rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5772.endd
5773These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5774Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5775terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5776of an incoming SMTP connection.
5777If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5778information, you can change this.
5779
5780This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5781and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5782.code
5783prdr_enable = true
5784.endd
5785
5786When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5787be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5788if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5789find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5790.code
5791# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5792# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5793.endd
5794show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5795and recipient addresses, respectively.
5796
5797The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5798over the default:
5799.code
5800log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5801 +tls_certificate_verified
5802.endd
5803
5804The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5805.code
5806# percent_hack_domains =
5807.endd
5808It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5809This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5810anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5811
5812The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5813concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5814message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5815occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5816address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5817bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5818are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5819always bounce messages.
5820.code
5821ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5822timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5823.endd
5824The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5825discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5826message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5827after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5828bounce message ever lasts a week.
5829
5830Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5831large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5832directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5833many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5834Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5835not often needed).
5836.code
5837# split_spool_directory = true
5838.endd
5839
5840In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5841messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5842characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5843violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5844In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5845problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5846check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5847.code
5848# check_rfc2047_length = false
5849.endd
5850
5851If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58528BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5853that are not 8-bit clean.
5854.code
5855# accept_8bitmime = false
5856.endd
5857
5858Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5859imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5860&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5861&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5862Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5863option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5864.code
5865# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5866# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5867.endd
5868
5869
5870.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5871.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5872.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5873In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5874It starts with the line
5875.code
5876begin acl
5877.endd
5878and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5879&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5880and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5881
5882.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5883The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5884RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5885are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5886rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5887result of the ACL processing.
5888.code
5889acl_check_rcpt:
5890.endd
5891This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5892ACL, and names it.
5893.code
5894accept hosts = :
5895.endd
5896This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5897But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5898names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5899list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5900host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5901important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5902
5903What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5904messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5905input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5906manner.
5907.code
5908deny message = Restricted characters in address
5909 domains = +local_domains
5910 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5911
5912deny message = Restricted characters in address
5913 domains = !+local_domains
5914 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5915.endd
5916These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5917characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5918Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5919&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5920in Internet mail addresses.
5921
5922The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5923addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5924option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5925in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5926programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5927at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5928characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5929policy of being as safe as possible.
5930
5931The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5932to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5933first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5934&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5935reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5936&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5937
5938The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5939block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5940or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5941have to modify this rule.
5942
5943Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5944allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5945common convention of local parts constructed as
5946&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5947the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5948with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5949filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5950that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5951is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5952
5953The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5954allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5955and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5956with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5957local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5958and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5959(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5960.code
5961accept local_parts = postmaster
5962 domains = +local_domains
5963.endd
5964This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5965local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5966&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5967reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5968&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5969
5970The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5971by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5972in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5973.code
5974require verify = sender
5975.endd
5976This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5977ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5978address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5979see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5980addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5981used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5982discusses the details of address verification.
5983.code
5984accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5985 control = submission
5986.endd
5987This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5988hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5989verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5990that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5991second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5992is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5993messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5994&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5995probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5996.code
5997accept authenticated = *
5998 control = submission
5999.endd
6000This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6001Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6002likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6003authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6004examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6005fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6006.code
6007require message = relay not permitted
6008 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6009.endd
6010This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6011one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6012.code
6013require verify = recipient
6014.endd
6015This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6016fails, the address is rejected.
6017.code
6018# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6019# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6020# $dnslist_text
6021# dnslists = black.list.example
6022#
6023# warn dnslists = black.list.example
6024# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6025# a black list at $dnslist_domain
6026# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6027.endd
6028These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6029sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6030from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6031line.
6032.code
6033# require verify = csa
6034.endd
6035This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6036authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6037records.
6038.code
6039accept
6040.endd
6041The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6042address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6043.code
6044acl_check_data:
6045.endd
6046This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6047of this ACL are commented out:
6048.code
6049# deny malware = *
6050# message = This message contains a virus \
6051# ($malware_name).
6052.endd
6053These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6054viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6055suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6056virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6057.code
6058# warn spam = nobody
6059# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6060# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6061# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6062# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6063.endd
6064These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6065SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6066and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6067&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6068series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6069whatever the spam score.
6070.code
6071accept
6072.endd
6073This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6074
6075
6076.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6077.cindex "default" "routers"
6078.cindex "routers" "default"
6079The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6080by the line
6081.code
6082begin routers
6083.endd
6084Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6085messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6086accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6087matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6088manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6089.code
6090# domain_literal:
6091# driver = ipliteral
6092# domains = !+local_domains
6093# transport = remote_smtp
6094.endd
6095.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6096This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6097support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6098you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6099&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6100
6101Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6102macro has been defined, per
6103.code
6104.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6105smarthost:
6106#...
6107.else
6108dnslookup:
6109#...
6110.endif
6111.endd
6112
6113If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6114command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6115perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6116skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6117
6118.code
6119smarthost:
6120 driver = manualroute
6121 domains = ! +local_domains
6122 transport = smarthost_smtp
6123 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6124 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6125 no_more
6126.endd
6127This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6128specified by the line
6129.code
6130domains = ! +local_domains
6131.endd
6132The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6133exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6134that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6135the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6136indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6137passed on to the following routers.
6138
6139The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6140specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6141While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6142be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6143
6144With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6145will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6146other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6147&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6148are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6149and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6150&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6151
6152.code
6153dnslookup:
6154 driver = dnslookup
6155 domains = ! +local_domains
6156 transport = remote_smtp
6157 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6158 no_more
6159.endd
6160The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6161
6162The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6163and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6164the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6165instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6166one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6167
6168The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6169DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6170router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6171specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6172in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6173the address fails and is bounced.
6174
6175The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6176be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6177encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6178whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6179Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6180email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6181continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6182out.
6183.code
6184system_aliases:
6185 driver = redirect
6186 allow_fail
6187 allow_defer
6188 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6189# user = exim
6190 file_transport = address_file
6191 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6192.endd
6193Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6194domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6195alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6196data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6197the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6198the next router.
6199
6200&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6201often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6202file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6203&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6204.code
6205userforward:
6206 driver = redirect
6207 check_local_user
6208# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6209# local_part_suffix_optional
6210 file = $home/.forward
6211# allow_filter
6212 no_verify
6213 no_expn
6214 check_ancestor
6215 file_transport = address_file
6216 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6217 reply_transport = address_reply
6218.endd
6219This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6220redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6221individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6222local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6223router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6224namely:
6225.code
6226# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6227# local_part_suffix_optional
6228.endd
6229.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6230show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6231is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6232by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6233variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6234presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6235the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6236
6237When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6238home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6239declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6240redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6241
6242.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6243Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6244files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6245is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6246of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6247filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6248separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6249
6250The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6251verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6252There are two reasons for doing this:
6253
6254.olist
6255Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6256checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6257unnecessary work.
6258.next
6259More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6260command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6261The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6262It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6263this time.
6264.endlist
6265
6266The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6267address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6268works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6269forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6270
6271The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6272forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6273auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6274.code
6275a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6276.endd
6277the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6278transport.
6279.code
6280localuser:
6281 driver = accept
6282 check_local_user
6283# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6284# local_part_suffix_optional
6285 transport = local_delivery
6286.endd
6287The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6288part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6289the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6290routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6291same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6292
6293
6294.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6295.cindex "default" "transports"
6296.cindex "transports" "default"
6297Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6298only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6299not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6300.code
6301begin transports
6302.endd
6303Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6304.code
6305remote_smtp:
6306 driver = smtp
6307 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6308.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6309 hosts_try_prdr = *
6310.endif
6311.endd
6312This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6313The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6314The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6315with over-long lines.
6316
6317The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6318negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6319but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6320use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6321
6322The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6323with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6324usual federated system.
6325
6326.code
6327smarthost_smtp:
6328 driver = smtp
6329 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6330 multi_domain
6331 #
6332.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6333 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6334 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6335 hosts_require_tls = *
6336 tls_verify_hosts = *
6337 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6338 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6339 # or not:
6340 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6341 #
6342 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6343 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6344 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6345 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6346 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6347 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6348 #
6349.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6350 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6351.endif
6352.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6353 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6354.endif
6355.endif
6356.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6357 hosts_try_prdr = *
6358.endif
6359.endd
6360After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6361can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6362that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6363happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6364All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6365then no other options are defined.
6366If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6367and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6368used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6369Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6370from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6371mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6372the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6373to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6374ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6375You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6376should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6377
6378For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6379
6380All other options are defaulted.
6381.code
6382local_delivery:
6383 driver = appendfile
6384 file = /var/mail/$local_part_verified
6385 delivery_date_add
6386 envelope_to_add
6387 return_path_add
6388# group = mail
6389# mode = 0660
6390.endd
6391This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6392traditional BSD mailbox format.
6393
6394.new
6395We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6396as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6397Instead we use &$local_part_verified$&,
6398the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6399(done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6400.wen
6401
6402By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6403local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6404directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6405under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6406show how this can be done.
6407
6408Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6409&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6410similarly-named options above.
6411.code
6412address_pipe:
6413 driver = pipe
6414 return_output
6415.endd
6416This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6417redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6418option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6419be returned to the sender.
6420.code
6421address_file:
6422 driver = appendfile
6423 delivery_date_add
6424 envelope_to_add
6425 return_path_add
6426.endd
6427This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6428redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6429&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6430.code
6431address_reply:
6432 driver = autoreply
6433.endd
6434This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6435filter files.
6436
6437
6438
6439.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6440.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6441.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6442The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6443Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6444introduced by the line
6445.code
6446begin retry
6447.endd
6448In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6449errors:
6450.code
6451* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6452.endd
6453This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64542 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64551.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6456is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6457measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6458
6459If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6460if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6461temporary errors into permanent errors.
6462
6463
6464.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6465The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6466.code
6467begin rewrite
6468.endd
6469contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6470rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6471
6472
6473
6474.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6475.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6476The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6477.code
6478begin authenticators
6479.endd
6480defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6481configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6482which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6483standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6484mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6485to support most MUA software.
6486
6487The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6488.code
6489#PLAIN:
6490# driver = plaintext
6491# server_set_id = $auth2
6492# server_prompts = :
6493# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6494# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6495.endd
6496And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6497.code
6498#LOGIN:
6499# driver = plaintext
6500# server_set_id = $auth1
6501# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6502# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6503# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6504.endd
6505
6506The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6507in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6508&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6509that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6510i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6511when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6512when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6513need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6514
6515The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6516password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6517To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6518expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6519
6520Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6521usercode and password are in different positions.
6522Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6523
6524.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6525
6526
6527
6528. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6529. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6530
6531.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6532
6533.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6534.cindex "PCRE"
6535Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6536uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6537matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6538regular expressions is discussed in
6539online Perl manpages, in
6540many Perl reference books, and also in
6541Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6542O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6543. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6544. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6545. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6546
6547The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6548are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6549description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6550the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6551the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6552case-insensitive.
6553
6554In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6555it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6556or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6557second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6558.code
6559domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6560.endd
6561The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6562precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6563of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6564regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6565backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6566normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6567matched.
6568
6569There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6570recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6571string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6572these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6573it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6574match anywhere in the subject string.
6575
6576In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6577you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6578.code
6579domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6580.endd
6581matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6582You need to use:
6583.code
6584domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6585.endd
6586if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6587$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6588
6589
6590
6591. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6592. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6593
6594.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6595.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6596.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6597.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6598Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6599messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6600
6601.olist
6602A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6603cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6604lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6605can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6606&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6607The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6608.next
6609Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6610way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6611returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6612succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6613chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6614The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6615.endlist
6616
6617String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6618that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6619involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6620if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6621time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6622chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6623
6624.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6625It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6626lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6627processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6628Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6629.code
6630domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6631domains = lsearch;/some/file
6632.endd
6633The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6634No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6635defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6636The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6637file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6638.code
6639192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6640192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6641.endd
6642When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6643possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6644
6645In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6646Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6647in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6648.code
6649domain1:
6650domain2:
6651.endd
6652Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6653matches the list item.
6654
6655It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6656Consider a file containing lines like this:
6657.code
6658192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6659.endd
6660If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6661first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6662causes a second lookup to occur.
6663
6664The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6665available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6666lookup is permitted.
6667
6668
6669.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6670.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6671.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6672Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6673
6674.ilist
6675The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6676and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6677lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6678.new
6679.cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6680The file string may not be tainted
6681.wen
6682.next
6683.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6684The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6685key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6686Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6687.endlist
6688
6689The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6690the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6691default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6692.code
6693LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6694LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6695.endd
6696which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6697For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6698libraries and header files before building Exim.
6699
6700
6701
6702
6703.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6704.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6705.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6706The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6707
6708.ilist
6709.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6710.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6711.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6712&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6713string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6714indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6715re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6716aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6717tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6718.display
6719&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6720&url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6721&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6722&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6723.endd
6724A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6725because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6726However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6727you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6728.next
6729.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6730.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6731.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6732&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6733DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6734zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6735&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6736
6737.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6738For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6739when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6740using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6741the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6742that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6743other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6744.next
6745.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6746.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6747.cindex "sasldb2"
6748.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6749&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6750interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6751ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6752authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6753&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6754&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6755.next
6756.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6757.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6758.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6759.cindex "Courier"
6760.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6761.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6762&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6763is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6764if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6765other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6766use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6767calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6768utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6769by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6770.next
6771.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6772.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6773&(dsearch)&: The given file must be an
6774.new
6775absolute
6776.wen
6777directory path; this is searched for an entry
6778whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6779The key may not
6780contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6781the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6782symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry.
6783.new
6784.cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6785It is regarded as untainted.
6786.wen
6787An example of how this
6788lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6789&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6790.next
6791.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6792.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6793&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6794terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6795file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6796IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6797being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6798.code
67991.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6800192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6801"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6802"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6803.endd
6804The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6805file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6806key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6807&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6808&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6809
6810&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6811&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6812lookup types support only literal keys.
6813
6814&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6815the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6816&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6817
6818&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6819IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6820notation before executing the lookup.)
6821.next
6822.cindex lookup json
6823.cindex json "lookup type"
6824.cindex JSON expansions
6825&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6826An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6827The key is a list of subelement selectors
6828(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6829which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6830of the JSON structure.
6831If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6832nunbered array element is selected.
6833Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6834The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6835or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6836is returned.
6837For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6838.next
6839.cindex "linear search"
6840.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6841.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6842.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6843&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6844line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6845end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6846letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6847in the file is used.
6848
6849White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6850line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6851continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6852space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6853junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6854colon, for example:
6855.code
6856baduser: :fail:
6857.endd
6858Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6859middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6860that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6861wildcarding of any kind.
6862
6863.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6864.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6865In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6866characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6867If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6868matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6869contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6870quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6871quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6872
6873.next
6874.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6875.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6876.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6877&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6878the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6879&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6880reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6881aliases; the full map names must be used.
6882
6883.next
6884.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6885.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6886.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6887.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6888&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6889&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6890the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6891that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6892used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6893
6894.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6895Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6896file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6897&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6898
6899. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6900. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6901
6902.olist
6903The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6904.code
6905 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6906 *fish data for anythingfish
6907.endd
6908.next
6909The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6910example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6911.code
6912 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6913.endd
6914Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6915expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6916string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6917.code
6918 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6919.endd
6920The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6921expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6922For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6923.code
6924 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6925.endd
6926
6927If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6928either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6929ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6930colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6931escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6932
6933&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6934match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6935is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6936takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6937&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6938
6939.next
6940Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6941is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6942lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6943example:
6944.code
6945 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6946.endd
6947The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6948.endlist olist
6949
6950Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6951continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6952be followed by optional colons.
6953
6954&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6955&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6956lookup types support only literal keys.
6957
6958.next
6959.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6960If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6961(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6962For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6963.endlist ilist
6964
6965
6966.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6967.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6968.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6969The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6970many of them are given in later sections.
6971
6972.ilist
6973.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6974.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6975&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6976are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6977records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6978.next
6979.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6980.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6981&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6982.next
6983.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6984.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6985&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6986returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6987that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6988called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6989any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6990.next
6991.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6992.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6993&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6994MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6995.next
6996.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6997.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6998&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6999the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7000.next
7001.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7002.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7003&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7004Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7005.next
7006.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7007.cindex "passwd lookup type"
7008.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7009&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7010lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7011success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7012lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7013password value. For example:
7014.code
7015*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7016.endd
7017.next
7018.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7019.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7020&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7021PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7022
7023.next
7024.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7025.cindex lookup Redis
7026&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7027passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7028
7029.next
7030.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7031.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7032&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is
7033new
7034an optional filename
7035.wen
7036followed by an SQL statement
7037that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7038
7039.next
7040&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7041not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7042.next
7043.cindex "whoson lookup type"
7044.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7045. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7046&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7047allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7048address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7049obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7050at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7051superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7052&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7053.code
7054require condition = \
7055 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7056.endd
7057The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7058the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7059this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7060one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7061.endlist
7062
7063
7064
7065.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7066.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7067Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7068completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7069reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7070options such as a list of local domains.
7071
7072When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7073of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7074temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7075or may give up altogether.
7076
7077
7078
7079.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7080.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7081.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7082.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7083.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7084.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7085In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7086that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7087
7088&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7089lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7090specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7091
7092If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7093and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7094provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7095
7096.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7097.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7098.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7099Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7100&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7101character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7102by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7103that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7104take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7105For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7106.code
7107data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7108.endd
7109Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7110looks up these keys, in this order:
7111.code
7112jane@eyre.example
7113*@eyre.example
7114*
7115.endd
7116The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7117&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7118complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7119Exim move on to try the next key.
7120
7121
7122
7123.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7124.cindex "partial matching"
7125.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7126.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7127.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7128.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7129The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7130match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7131being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7132information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7133domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7134a key in a DBM file is
7135.code
7136*.dates.fict.example
7137.endd
7138then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7139&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7140by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7141file.
7142
7143&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7144also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7145&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7146
7147Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7148keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7149be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7150partial matching keys
7151beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7152Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7153unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7154
7155Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7156the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7157is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7158is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7159fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7160start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7161remains.
7162
7163A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7164by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7165&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7166modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7167subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7168up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7169.code
71702250.dates.fict.example
7171*.2250.dates.fict.example
7172*.dates.fict.example
7173*.fict.example
7174.endd
7175As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7176finishes.
7177
7178.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7179.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7180The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7181changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7182formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7183parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7184.code
7185domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7186.endd
7187In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7188&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7189components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7190other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7191.code
7192domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7193.endd
7194For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7195&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7196
7197If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7198just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7199down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7200
7201.ilist
7202If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7203.next
7204If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7205example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7206.next
7207Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7208remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7209for &"*"& on its own.
7210.next
7211Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7212.endlist
7213
7214
7215If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7216&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7217this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7218specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7219prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7220lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7221&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7222
7223The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7224in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7225dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7226in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7227subject key is always followed by a dot.
7228
7229
7230
7231
7232.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7233.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7234.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7235Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7236lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7237of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7238single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7239
7240For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7241another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7242many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7243the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7244closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7245own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7246
7247The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7248strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7249complete.
7250
7251
7252
7253
7254.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7255.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7256.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7257When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7258is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7259the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7260.code
7261[name=$local_part]
7262.endd
7263will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7264For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7265.code
7266[name="$local_part"]
7267.endd
7268but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7269NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7270rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7271of the following form is provided:
7272.code
7273${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7274.endd
7275For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7276.code
7277[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7278.endd
7279See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7280operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7281lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7282
7283
7284
7285
7286.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7287.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7288.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7289.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7290The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7291of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7292an expansion string could contain:
7293.code
7294${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7295.endd
7296If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7297is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7298&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7299&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7300
7301The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7302and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7303If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7304
7305For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7306concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7307depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7308between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7309by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7310.code
7311${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7312.endd
7313It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7314white space is ignored.
7315For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7316an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7317separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7318
7319.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7320When the type is PTR,
7321the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7322&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7323.code
7324${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7325.endd
7326If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7327altered and nothing is added.
7328
7329.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7330.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7331For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7332each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7333port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7334The field separator can be modified as above.
7335
7336.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7337.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7338For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7339unless a field separator is specified.
7340To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7341For SPF records the
7342default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7343.code
7344${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7345${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7346${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7347.endd
7348It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7349white space is ignored.
7350
7351.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7352For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7353successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7354Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7355specified.
7356.code
7357${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7358.endd
7359
7360.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7361.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7362.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7363.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7364Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7365each followed by a comma,
7366that may appear before the record type.
7367
7368The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7369temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7370a defer-option modifier.
7371The possible keywords are
7372&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7373With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7374whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7375ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7376With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7377error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7378succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7379.code
7380${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7381${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7382.endd
7383Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7384yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7385
7386.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7387Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7388The possible keywords are
7389&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7390With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7391with the lookup.
7392With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7393is not labelled as authenticated data
7394is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7395The default is &"lax"&.
7396
7397See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7398
7399.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7400.cindex "DNS" timeout
7401Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7402The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7403(e.g. &"5s"&).
7404The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7405
7406Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7407The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7408The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7409
7410.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7411.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7412.cindex DNS TTL
7413Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7414The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7415value of the set of returned DNS records.
7416
7417
7418.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7419.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7420By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7421each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7422the pseudo-type MXH:
7423.code
7424${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7425.endd
7426In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7427returned.
7428
7429.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7430Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7431records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7432component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7433records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7434error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7435but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7436top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7437.code
7438${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7439${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7440.endd
7441Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7442the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7443the name servers for &%edu%&.
7444
7445You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7446top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7447sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7448given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7449for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7450such a list.
7451
7452.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7453A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7454records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7455&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7456not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7457result of a successful lookup such as:
7458.code
7459${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7460.endd
7461has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7462The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7463authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7464
7465.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7466The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7467and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7468(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7469.code
7470${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7471.endd
7472
7473
7474.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7475In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7476However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7477&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7478the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7479.code
7480${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7481${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7482${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7483.endd
7484In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7485the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7486to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7487case, it does not treat it as a list.
7488
7489The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7490in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7491different separator can be specified, as described above.
7492
7493
7494
7495
7496.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7497.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7498.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7499.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7500The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7501become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7502implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7503contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7504the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7505it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7506indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7507your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7508.code
7509LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7510LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7511LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7512LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7513LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7514.endd
7515If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7516same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7517
7518There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7519the way they handle the results of a query:
7520
7521.ilist
7522&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7523gives an error.
7524.next
7525&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7526Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7527.next
7528&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7529from all of them are returned.
7530.endlist
7531
7532
7533For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7534Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7535the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7536First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7537
7538
7539.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7540.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7541An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7542the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7543.code
7544data = ${lookup ldap \
7545 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7546 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7547.endd
7548.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7549The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7550secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7551encrypted TLS connection is used.
7552
7553With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7554LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7555See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7556
7557Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7558controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7559&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7560your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7561&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7562certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7563running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7564methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7565&_exim.conf_&.
7566
7567
7568.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7569.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7570Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7571and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7572within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7573reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7574
7575The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7576filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7577the string:
7578.code
7579* => \2A
7580( => \28
7581) => \29
7582\ => \5C
7583.endd
7584in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7585to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7586.code
7587! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7588.endd
7589are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7590.code
7591${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7592.endd
7593yields
7594.code
7595%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7596.endd
7597Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7598.code
7599a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7600.endd
7601The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7602base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7603by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7604.code
7605, + " \ < > ;
7606.endd
7607It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7608before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7609is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7610.code
7611${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7612.endd
7613yields
7614.code
7615%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7616.endd
7617Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7618.code
7619\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7620.endd
7621There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7622authentication below.
7623
7624
7625.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7626.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7627The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7628is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7629an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7630by starting it with
7631.code
7632ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7633.endd
7634If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7635used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7636taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7637colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7638handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7639returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7640are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7641Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7642failures, and timeouts.
7643
7644For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7645of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7646&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7647doubled. For example
7648.code
7649ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7650.endd
7651If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7652to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7653the local host) is used.
7654
7655If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7656a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7657&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7658to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7659not available.
7660
7661For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7662for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7663can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7664the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7665.code
7666ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7667.endd
7668When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7669&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7670.code
7671${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7672.endd
7673When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7674a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7675specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7676socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7677&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7678or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7679the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7680backup host.
7681
7682If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7683specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7684&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7685
7686.ilist
7687Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7688interface.
7689.next
7690Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7691.endlist
7692
7693
7694Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7695&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7696
7697
7698
7699.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7700.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7701The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7702information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7703be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7704spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7705when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7706them. The following names are recognized:
7707.display
7708&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7709&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7710&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7711&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7712&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7713&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7714&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7715&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7716.endd
7717The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7718&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7719must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7720library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7721
7722.cindex LDAP timeout
7723.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7724The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7725backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7726enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7727network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7728&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7729LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7730if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7731SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7732Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7733
7734The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7735set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7736
7737The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7738to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7739default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7740server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7741different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7742different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7743alternate list (colon-separated).
7744
7745Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7746values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7747.code
7748${lookup ldap
7749 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7750 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7751 {$value}fail}
7752.endd
7753The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7754any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7755which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7756non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7757
7758The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7759connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7760on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7761
7762When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7763removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7764some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7765quoting has two advantages:
7766
7767.ilist
7768It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7769DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7770.next
7771It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7772.endlist
7773
7774For example, a setting such as
7775.code
7776USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7777.endd
7778should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7779
7780Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7781expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7782field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7783does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7784.code
7785PASS=${quote:$3}
7786.endd
7787The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7788SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7789&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7790
7791
7792
7793.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7794.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7795The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7796as a sequence of values, for example
7797.code
7798cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7799.endd
7800The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7801search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7802the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7803values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7804you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7805directory.
7806
7807In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7808result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7809has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7810part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7811
7812If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7813strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7814quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7815backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7816Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7817(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7818Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7819output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7820same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7821
7822Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7823LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7824&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7825&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7826(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7827
7828.code
7829ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7830value1.1,value1,,2
7831
7832ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7833value two
7834
7835ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7836value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7837
7838ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7839attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7840
7841ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7842objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7843.endd
7844You can
7845make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7846results of LDAP lookups.
7847The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7848individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7849The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7850of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7851The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7852comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7853
7854
7855
7856
7857.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7858.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7859.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7860NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7861and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7862contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7863of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7864values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7865.code
7866[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7867.endd
7868might return the string
7869.code
7870name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7871home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7872.endd
7873(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7874.code
7875[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7876.endd
7877would just return
7878.code
7879Martin Guerre
7880.endd
7881with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7882for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7883operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7884
7885
7886
7887.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7888.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7889.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7890.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7891.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7892.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7893.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7894.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7895.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7896.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7897.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7898.cindex lookup Redis
7899Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7900and SQLite
7901databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7902might be
7903.code
7904${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7905 {$value}fail}
7906.endd
7907If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7908field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7909.code
7910${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7911 {$value}}
7912.endd
7913might be
7914.code
7915home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7916.endd
7917Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7918quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7919field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7920.code
7921Mister X
7922.endd
7923If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7924with a newline between the data for each row.
7925
7926
7927.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7928.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7929.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7930.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7931.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7932.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7933.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7934.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7935.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7936.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7937.cindex lookup Redis
7938If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7939&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7940or &%redis_servers%&
7941option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7942information.
7943.oindex &%mysql_servers%&
7944.oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
7945.oindex &%oracle_servers%&
7946.oindex &%ibase_servers%&
7947.oindex &%redis_servers%&
7948(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7949queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7950&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7951For all but Redis
7952each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7953items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7954Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7955name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7956.code
7957hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7958.endd
7959Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7960&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7961option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7962.code
7963hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7964 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7965.endd
7966For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7967because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7968query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7969a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7970found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7971servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7972
7973For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7974own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7975If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7976information.
7977Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7978host, database number, and password.
7979.olist
7980The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7981port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7982higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7983.next
7984The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7985.next
7986The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7987.endlist
7988
7989The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7990convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7991respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7992itself are escaped with backslashes.
7993
7994The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7995escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7996
7997.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7998For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7999it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8000done by starting the query with
8001.display
8002&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
8003.endd
8004Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8005.olist
8006If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8007global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8008of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8009taken from there.
8010.next
8011If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8012.endlist
8013The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8014Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8015successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8016
8017This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8018are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8019master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8020like this:
8021.code
8022mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8023 slave2/db/name/pw:\
8024 master/db/name/pw
8025.endd
8026In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8027.code
8028${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8029.endd
8030That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8031the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8032option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8033.code
8034${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
8035.endd
8036
8037
8038.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8039For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8040causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8041socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8042An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8043the default value is &"exim"&.
8044The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8045.display
8046<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8047 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8048.endd
8049Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8050the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8051
8052No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8053the queries.
8054
8055If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8056or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8057
8058&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8059anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8060is zero because no rows are affected.
8061
8062
8063.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8064PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8065This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8066However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8067database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8068looks like this:
8069.code
8070hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8071.endd
8072In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8073given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8074visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8075
8076If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8077update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8078affected.
8079
8080.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8081.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8082.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8083SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8084addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8085daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8086
8087.new
8088.oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8089The preferred way of specifying the file is by using the
8090&%sqlite_dbfile%& option, set to
8091.wen
8092an absolute path.
8093A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8094separated by white space.
8095This means that the path name cannot contain white space.
8096.cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8097It also means that the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8098the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8099the file.
8100
8101Here is a lookup expansion example:
8102.code
8103sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8104...
8105${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8106.endd
8107In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8108.code
8109domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8110 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8111.endd
8112The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8113quote, which it doubles.
8114
8115.cindex timeout SQLite
8116.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8117The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8118internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8119update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8120are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8121waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8122to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8123option.
8124
8125.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8126.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8127.cindex "redis lookup type"
8128Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8129Examples:
8130.code
8131${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8132${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8133.endd
8134
8135As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8136Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8137of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8138master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8139servers.
8140
8141When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8142immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8143to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8144reached.
8145
8146.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8147.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8148
8149
8150. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8151. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8152
8153.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8154 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8155 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8156.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8157A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8158email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8159contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8160are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8161arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8162
8163Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8164host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8165different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8166general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8167
8168Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8169support all the complexity available in
8170domain, host, address and local part lists.
8171
8172
8173
8174.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8175.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8176Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8177
8178&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8179splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8180
8181The result of
8182expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8183into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8184but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8185&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8186discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8187
8188
8189If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8190testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8191expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8192
8193If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8194other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8195misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8196the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8197expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8198.code
8199deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8200 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8201.endd
8202The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8203&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8204senders based on the receiving domain.
8205
8206
8207
8208
8209.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8210.cindex "list" "negation"
8211.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8212Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8213leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8214defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8215it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8216(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8217
8218The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8219subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8220subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8221subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8222was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8223.code
8224domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8225.endd
8226matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8227neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8228list is positive. However, if the setting were
8229.code
8230domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8231.endd
8232then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8233list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8234as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8235
8236Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8237the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8238item.
8239
8240
8241
8242.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8243.cindex "list" "filename in"
8244If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8245filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8246processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8247filenames are not allowed,
8248and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8249Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8250lines:
8251
8252.ilist
8253For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8254file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8255.next
8256Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8257address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8258white space or the start of the line. For example:
8259.code
8260not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8261.endd
8262.endlist
8263
8264Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8265file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8266is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8267so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8268
8269If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8270within the file is inverted. For example, if
8271.code
8272hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8273.endd
8274and the file contains the lines
8275.code
8276!a.b.c
8277*.b.c
8278.endd
8279then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8280any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8281
8282
8283
8284.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8285As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8286to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8287confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8288an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8289sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8290non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8291always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8292
8293If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8294list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8295in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8296&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8297
8298
8299
8300
8301.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8302.cindex "named lists"
8303.cindex "list" "named"
8304A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8305which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8306particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8307places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8308the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8309a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8310locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8311.code
8312domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8313.endd
8314Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8315for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8316configured with the line
8317.code
8318domains = +local_domains
8319.endd
8320The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8321except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8322.code
8323dnslookup:
8324 driver = dnslookup
8325 domains = ! +local_domains
8326 transport = remote_smtp
8327 no_more
8328.endd
8329The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8330the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8331respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8332equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8333.code
8334hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8335addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8336.endd
8337A named list may refer to other named lists:
8338.code
8339domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8340domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8341domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8342.endd
8343&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8344effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8345out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8346.code
8347domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8348domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8349.endd
8350The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8351list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8352means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8353.code
8354domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8355.endd
8356where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8357referenced lists if you can.
8358
8359.new
8360.cindex "hiding named list values"
8361.cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8362Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8363accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8364line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8365word &"hide"&. For example:
8366.code
8367hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8368.endd
8369.wen
8370
8371
8372Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8373address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8374lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8375.code
8376domains = +local_domains
8377.endd
8378on several of your routers
8379or in several ACL statements,
8380the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8381if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8382references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8383the same each time they are referenced.
8384
8385By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8386extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8387is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8388hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8389
8390
8391
8392.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8393.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8394.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8395At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8396configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8397write
8398.code
8399ALIST = host1 : host2
8400auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8401.endd
8402it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8403.code
8404auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8405.endd
8406Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8407list, and write
8408.code
8409hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8410auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8411.endd
8412the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8413.code
8414auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8415.endd
8416
8417
8418.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8419.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8420.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8421While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8422it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8423the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8424that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8425an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8426message. For example:
8427.code
8428domainlist special_domains = \
8429 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8430.endd
8431This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8432address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8433in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8434cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8435same list each time.
8436
8437By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8438cache the result anyway. For example:
8439.code
8440domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8441.endd
8442If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8443the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8444
8445
8446
8447.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8448.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8449.cindex "list" "domain list"
8450Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8451The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8452
8453.ilist
8454.cindex "primary host name"
8455.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8456.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8457.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8458.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8459If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8460as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8461possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8462differ only in their names.
8463.next
8464.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8465.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8466.cindex "domain literal"
8467If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8468in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8469only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8470&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8471control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8472In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8473.next
8474.cindex "@mx_any"
8475.cindex "@mx_primary"
8476.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8477.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8478If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8479has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8480.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8481&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8482are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8483local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8484but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8485preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8486
8487The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8488performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8489example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8490resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8491options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8492
8493Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8494patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8495list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8496ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8497on a router). For example:
8498.code
8499domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8500.endd
8501This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8502the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8503
8504The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8505host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8506contain negative items.
8507
8508Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8509be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8510list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8511.code
8512domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8513 an.other.domain : ...
8514.endd
8515so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8516involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8517.code
8518domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8519 an.other.domain ? ...
8520.endd
8521.next
8522.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8523.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8524.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8525If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8526are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8527domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8528list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8529matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8530list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8531&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8532
8533.next
8534.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8535.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8536If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8537expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8538function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8539Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8540default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8541with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8542are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8543
8544&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8545must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8546use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8547it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8548expression by expansion, of course).
8549.next
8550.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8551.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8552If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8553semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8554must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8555&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8556.code
8557domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8558.endd
8559The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8560key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8561only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8562is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8563or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8564&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8565other statements in the same ACL.
8566
8567.next
8568Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8569&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8570.code
8571domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8572.endd
8573This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8574works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8575
8576.next
8577.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8578Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8579a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8580original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8581select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8582value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8583expansion variable.
8584.next
8585If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8586semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8587pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8588chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8589.code
8590hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8591 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8592.endd
8593In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8594example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8595whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8596&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8597variable and can be referred to in other options.
8598.next
8599.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8600If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8601between the pattern and the domain.
8602.endlist
8603
8604Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8605.code
8606domainlist funny_domains = \
8607 @ : \
8608 lib.unseen.edu : \
8609 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8610 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8611 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8612 nis;domains.byname : \
8613 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8614.endd
8615There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8616an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8617explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8618but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8619patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8620patterns earlier.
8621
8622
8623
8624.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8625.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8626.cindex "list" "host list"
8627Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8628example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8629may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8630two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8631pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8632You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8633involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8634
8635
8636.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8637.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8638.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8639If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8640involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8641process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8642not used.
8643
8644.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8645The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8646the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8647
8648
8649
8650.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8651.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8652If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8653the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8654&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8655list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8656systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8657concerns.)
8658
8659The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8660inspecting its IP address:
8661
8662.ilist
8663If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8664with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8665to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8666&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8667This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8668with the IP address of the subject host.
8669
8670If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8671lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8672ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8673temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8674what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8675
8676.next
8677.cindex "@ in a host list"
8678If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8679domain name, as just described.
8680
8681.next
8682If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8683subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8684IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8685be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8686separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8687without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8688IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8689that can never match a client host.
8690
8691.next
8692.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8693If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8694the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8695interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8696.code
8697accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8698accept hosts = @[]
8699.endd
8700.next
8701.cindex "CIDR notation"
8702If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8703example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8704host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8705included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8706specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8707significant end of the address.
8708
8709&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8710of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8711address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8712addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8713.code
8714192.168.23.236/31
8715.endd
8716matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
871732 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8718matches.
8719
8720Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8721.code
8722recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8723 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8724.endd
8725The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8726appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8727For example:
8728.code
8729recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8730.endd
8731could make use of a file containing
8732.code
8733172.16.0.0/12
87343ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8735.endd
8736to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8737addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8738changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8739.code
8740recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8741 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8742.endd
8743The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8744list.
8745.endlist
8746
8747
8748
8749.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8750 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8751.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8752When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8753address, the pattern takes this form:
8754.display
8755&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8756.endd
8757For example:
8758.code
8759hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8760.endd
8761The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8762IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8763letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8764&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8765quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8766returned by the lookup is not used.
8767
8768.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8769.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8770Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8771patterns of this form:
8772.display
8773&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8774.endd
8775For example:
8776.code
8777net24-dbm;/networks.db
8778.endd
8779The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8780length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8781mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8782is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8783&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8784
8785When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8786of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8787terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8788to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8789recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8790(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8791For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8792converted using colons and not dots.
8793In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8794addresses are always used.
8795The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8796
8797Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8798colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8799However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8800configurations.
8801
8802&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8803IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8804the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8805case the IP address is used on its own.
8806
8807
8808
8809.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8810.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8811.cindex "unknown host name"
8812.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8813There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8814remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8815complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8816address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8817above.)
8818
8819If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8820patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8821Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8822DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8823Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8824effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8825Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8826
8827Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8828against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8829
8830By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8831if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8832&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8833are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8834security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8835for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8836Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8837discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8838found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8839
8840There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8841found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8842
8843.cindex "host" "alias for"
8844.cindex "alias for host"
8845As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8846of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8847
8848.ilist
8849.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8850If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8851the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8852&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8853requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8854expression.
8855.next
8856.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8857.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8858If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8859matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8860expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8861case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8862syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8863example,
8864.code
8865^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8866.endd
8867is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8868&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8869that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8870string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8871part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8872.code
8873sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8874.endd
8875&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8876&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8877example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8878required.
8879.endlist
8880
8881
8882
8883
8884.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8885.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8886While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8887name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8888from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8889behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8890
8891&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8892apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8893
8894.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8895.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8896Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8897lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8898Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8899does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8900To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8901&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8902not recognized in an indirected file).
8903
8904.ilist
8905If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8906cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8907.code
8908host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8909.endd
8910rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8911any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8912
8913.next
8914If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8915be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8916example:
8917.code
8918accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8919 192.168.4.5
8920.endd
8921accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8922whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8923name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8924.endlist
8925
8926Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8927list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8928list.
8929
8930.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8931 "SECTmixwilhos"
8932.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8933
8934This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8935as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8936wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8937
8938.ilist
8939If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8940IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8941addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8942.code
8943accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8944.endd
8945The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8946left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8947without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8948a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8949pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8950&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8951if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8952
8953.next
8954If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8955address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8956.code
8957accept hosts = *.friend.example
8958accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8959.endd
8960If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8961&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8962&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8963this section.
8964.endlist
8965
8966
8967.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8968 "SECTtemdnserr"
8969.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8970.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8971.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8972A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8973&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8974host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8975&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8976section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8977host lists such as whitelists.
8978
8979
8980
8981.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8982 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8983.cindex "unknown host name"
8984.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8985If a pattern is of the form
8986.display
8987<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8988.endd
8989for example
8990.code
8991dbm;/host/accept/list
8992.endd
8993a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8994lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8995is not used.
8996
8997&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8998keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8999addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
9000&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9001two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9002lookup, both using the same file.
9003
9004
9005
9006.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
9007If a pattern is of the form
9008.display
9009<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9010.endd
9011the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9012data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9013&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9014.code
9015hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9016 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9017.endd
9018The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9019can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9020use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9021operator.
9022
9023If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9024looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9025&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9026
9027Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9028host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9029&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9030still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9031effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9032See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9033
9034
9035
9036
9037
9038.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9039.cindex "list" "address list"
9040.cindex "address list" "empty item"
9041.cindex "address list" "patterns"
9042Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9043is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9044always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9045list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9046using this option setting:
9047.code
9048senders = :
9049.endd
9050The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9051data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9052detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9053and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9054
9055Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9056example:
9057.code
9058senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9059.endd
9060A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9061character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9062semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9063subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9064with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9065the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9066wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9067.code
9068deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9069 *@+hostile_domains:\
9070 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9071 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9072.endd
9073.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9074.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9075If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9076specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9077treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9078
9079If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9080contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9081address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9082domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9083is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9084.code
9085deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9086.endd
9087
9088The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9089address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9090senders:
9091
9092.ilist
9093.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9094.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9095If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9096done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9097You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9098as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9099to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9100.code
9101deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9102 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9103.endd
9104The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9105start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9106
9107.next
9108.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9109Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9110lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9111example:
9112.code
9113deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9114 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9115 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9116.endd
9117Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9118lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9119not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9120always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9121
9122Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9123cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9124panic log.
9125.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9126However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9127&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9128default. For example, with this lookup:
9129.code
9130accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9131.endd
9132the file could contains lines like this:
9133.code
9134user1@domain1.example
9135*@domain2.example
9136.endd
9137and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9138that are tried is:
9139.code
9140nimrod@jaeger.example
9141*@jaeger.example
9142*
9143.endd
9144&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9145would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9146
9147&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9148.code
9149deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9150deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9151.endd
9152The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9153because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9154domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9155.endlist
9156
9157
9158The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9159If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9160always fails.
9161
9162
9163.ilist
9164.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9165.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9166.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9167If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9168(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9169split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9170it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9171from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9172of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9173
9174.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9175The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9176keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9177patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9178even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9179with
9180.code
9181deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9182.endd
9183the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9184.code
9185baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9186.endd
9187to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9188
9189.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9190If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9191has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9192may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9193but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9194surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9195.code
9196aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9197 spammer3 : spammer4
9198.endd
9199As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9200doubling.
9201
9202If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9203of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9204list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9205might have entries like
9206.code
9207aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9208xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9209*: ^\d{8}$
9210.endd
9211in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9212local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9213each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9214chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9215
9216.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9217It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9218them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9219
9220.next
9221The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9222lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9223can only return a single list of local parts.
9224.endlist
9225
9226&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9227in these two examples:
9228.code
9229senders = +my_list
9230senders = *@+my_list
9231.endd
9232In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9233example it is a named domain list.
9234
9235
9236
9237
9238.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9239.cindex "case of local parts"
9240.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9241.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9242Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9243case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9244Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9245Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9246blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9247lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9248default.
9249
9250The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9251address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9252comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9253the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9254that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9255keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9256works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9257case-independent.
9258
9259.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9260To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9261an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9262part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9263longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9264lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9265performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9266become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9267
9268
9269
9270.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9271.cindex "list" "local part list"
9272.cindex "local part" "list"
9273Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9274lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9275setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9276set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9277case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9278matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9279&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9280option is case-sensitive from the start.
9281
9282If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9283comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9284only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9285Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9286that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9287&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9288Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9289types.
9290.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9291
9292
9293
9294
9295. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9296. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9297
9298.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9299.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9300Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9301them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9302
9303When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9304.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9305when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9306start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9307below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9308escape character, as described in the following section.
9309
9310Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9311dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9312options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9313the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9314conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9315reasons,
9316.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9317.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9318and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9319is not permitted.
9320
9321
9322
9323.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9324.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9325An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9326backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9327character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9328If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9329required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9330the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9331
9332.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9333A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9334two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9335expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9336.code
9337deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9338.endd
9339On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9340without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9341string.
9342
9343
9344
9345.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9346.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9347A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9348expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9349carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9350octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9351backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9352encoding.
9353
9354These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9355in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9356and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9357
9358
9359.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9360.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9361.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9362.oindex "&%-be%&"
9363Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9364takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9365arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9366to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9367since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9368value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9369database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9370and &%nhash%&.
9371
9372Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9373instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9374using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9375
9376.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9377If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9378from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9379option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9380read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9381.code
9382exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9383.endd
9384The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9385Exim message identifier. For example:
9386.code
9387exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9388.endd
9389This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9390is therefore restricted to admin users.
9391
9392
9393.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9394.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9395A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9396alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9397(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9398used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9399instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9400the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9401that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9402its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9403from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9404taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9405being expanded.
9406
9407
9408
9409
9410.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9411The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9412between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9413outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9414white space is significant.
9415
9416.vlist
9417.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9418.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9419Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9420.code
9421$local_part
9422${domain}
9423.endd
9424The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9425characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9426&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9427section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9428given, the expansion fails.
9429
9430.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9431.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9432The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9433<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9434.code
9435${lc:$local_part}
9436.endd
9437The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9438leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9439below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9440one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9441string easier to understand.
9442
9443.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9444This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9445expansion item below.
9446
9447
9448.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9449.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9450.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9451The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9452arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9453Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9454arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9455and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9456are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9457a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9458the result of the expansion.
9459If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9460the expansion result is an empty string.
9461If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9462
9463
9464.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9465.cindex authentication "results header"
9466.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9467.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9468This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9469&'Authentication-Results:'&
9470header line.
9471The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9472will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9473Methods that might be present in the result include:
9474.code
9475none
9476iprev
9477auth
9478spf
9479dkim
9480.endd
9481
9482Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9483.code
9484 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9485.endd
9486This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9487
9488
9489.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9490 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9491.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9492.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9493.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9494The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9495The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9496the certificate. Supported fields are:
9497.display
9498&`version `&
9499&`serial_number `&
9500&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9501&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9502&`notbefore `& time
9503&`notafter `& time
9504&`sig_algorithm `&
9505&`signature `&
9506&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9507&`ocsp_uri `& list
9508&`crl_uri `& list
9509.endd
9510If the field is found,
9511<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9512otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9513variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9514is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9515
9516If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9517key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9518extracted is used.
9519
9520Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9521
9522The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9523output a Distinguished Name string which is
9524not quite
9525parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9526(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9527RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9528a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9529result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9530The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9531a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9532Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9533
9534The field selectors marked as "time" above
9535take an optional modifier of "int"
9536for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9537Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9538in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9539
9540The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9541newline-separated by default,
9542(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9543The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9544a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9545
9546The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9547prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9548Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9549which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9550if so the element tags are omitted.
9551
9552If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9553
9554.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9555 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9556.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9557This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9558This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9559.code
9560EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9561.endd
9562set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9563object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9564(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9565
9566There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9567
9568When compiling
9569a local function that is to be called in this way,
9570first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9571and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9572The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9573are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9574must have the following type:
9575.code
9576int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9577.endd
9578Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9579function should return one of the following values:
9580
9581&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9582into the expanded string that is being built.
9583
9584&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9585from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9586
9587&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9588taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9589
9590&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9591
9592When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9593you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9594configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9595
9596
9597.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9598.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9599.cindex "environment" "values from"
9600The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9601removed.
9602This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9603If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9604and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9605
9606Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9607appear, for example:
9608.code
9609${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9610.endd
9611This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9612{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9613
9614If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9615search failure.
9616If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9617search success.
9618
9619The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9620&%add_environment%& main section options.
9621
9622
9623.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9624 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9625.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9626.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9627The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9628white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9629must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9630The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9631.display
9632<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9633.endd
9634.vindex "&$value$&"
9635where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9636values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9637values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9638described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9639for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9640the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9641otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9642variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9643is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9644
9645If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9646key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9647extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9648yield &"2001"&:
9649.code
9650${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9651${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9652.endd
9653Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9654appear, for example:
9655.code
9656${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9657.endd
9658This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9659{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9660
9661.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9662 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9663 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9664 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9665.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9666.cindex JSON expansions
9667The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9668white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9669must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9670The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9671.display
9672{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9673.endd
9674.vindex "&$value$&"
9675The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9676the spaces are optional.
9677Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9678For the &"json"& variant,
9679if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9680trailing quotes.
9681For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9682leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9683. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9684
9685The results of matching are handled as above.
9686
9687
9688.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9689 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9690.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9691.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9692The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9693apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9694This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9695behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9696extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9697argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9698<&'string3'&> as before.
9699
9700The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9701separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9702The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9703counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9704number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9705number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9706expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9707provided. For example:
9708.code
9709${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9710.endd
9711yields &"42"&, and
9712.code
9713${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9714.endd
9715yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9716empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9717
9718
9719.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9720 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9721 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9722 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9723.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9724.cindex JSON expansions
9725The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9726apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9727
9728Field selection and result handling is as above;
9729there is no choice of field separator.
9730For the &"json"& variant,
9731if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9732trailing quotes.
9733For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9734leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9735
9736
9737.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9738.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9739.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9740.vindex "&$item$&"
9741After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9742default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9743For each item
9744in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9745evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9746item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9747separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9748input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9749.code
9750${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9751.endd
9752yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9753to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9754
9755
9756.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9757.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9758.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9759This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9760early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9761(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9762
9763The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9764<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9765<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9766use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9767.code
9768${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9769.endd
9770The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9771or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9772Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9773function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9774first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9775.code
9776abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9777.endd
9778If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9779letters appear. For example:
9780.display
9781&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9782&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9783&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9784.endd
9785
9786.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9787 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9788 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9789 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9790 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9791 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9792 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9793 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9794.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9795.vindex "&$header_$&"
9796.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9797.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9798.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9799.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9800.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9801.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9802Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9803.code
9804$header_reply-to:
9805.endd
9806The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9807internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9808lines) may be present.
9809
9810The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9811the data in the header line is interpreted.
9812
9813.ilist
9814.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9815&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9816processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9817
9818.next
9819.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9820&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9821are multiple headers with a given name.
9822Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9823list-processing facilities can be used.
9824The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9825the content is &"raw"&.
9826
9827.next
9828.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9829&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9830or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9831character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9832&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9833.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9834produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9835what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9836
9837.next
9838&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9839standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9840be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9841returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9842&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9843a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9844.endlist ilist
9845
9846In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9847command of the following form:
9848.code
9849headers charset "UTF-8"
9850.endd
9851This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9852subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9853character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9854option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9855value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9856ISO-8859-1.
9857
9858Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9859any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9860&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9861if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9862
9863Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9864this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9865message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9866filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9867router or transport are not accessible.
9868
9869For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9870ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9871because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9872They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9873Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9874are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9875point they are added.
9876When any of the above ACLs ar
9877running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9878
9879Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9880following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9881this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9882white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9883expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9884expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9885section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9886header.)
9887
9888If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9889to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9890&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9891each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9892newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9893newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9894those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9895junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9896
9897.new
9898.cindex "tainted data"
9899When the headers are from an incoming message,
9900the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
9901.wen
9902
9903
9904.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9905.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9906.cindex &%hmac%&
9907This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9908shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9909RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9910&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9911cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9912or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9913present. For example:
9914.code
9915${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9916.endd
9917For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9918produces:
9919.code
9920dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9921.endd
9922As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9923an Exim configuration:
9924.code
9925SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9926.endd
9927In a router or a transport you could then have:
9928.code
9929headers_add = \
9930 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9931 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9932 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9933.endd
9934Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9935&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9936this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9937host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9938using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9939&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9940
9941
9942.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9943.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9944.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9945If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9946item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9947in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9948.code
9949${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9950.endd
9951The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9952true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9953be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9954case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9955&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9956
9957If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9958is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9959cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9960.code
9961condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9962.endd
9963you can use
9964.code
9965condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9966.endd
9967
9968
9969
9970.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9971.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9972.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9973This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9974folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9975For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9976
9977
9978
9979.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9980.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9981.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9982The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9983strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9984you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9985change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9986some of the braces:
9987.code
9988${length_<n>:<string>}
9989.endd
9990The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9991of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9992&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9993All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9994
9995
9996.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9997 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9998.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9999.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10000.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10001The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10002apart from an optional leading minus,
10003and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10004
10005After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10006default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10007
10008The first field of the list is numbered one.
10009If the number is negative, the fields are
10010counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10011The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10012then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10013
10014If the modulus of the
10015number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10016the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10017
10018For example:
10019.code
10020${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10021.endd
10022yields &"42"&, and
10023.code
10024${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10025.endd
10026yields &"result: 42"&.
10027
10028If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10029If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10030extracted is used.
10031You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10032
10033
10034.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10035 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10036This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
10037described in the next item.
10038
10039.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10040 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10041.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10042.cindex "file" "lookups"
10043.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10044The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10045discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10046lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10047<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10048
10049If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10050a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10051other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10052in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10053out by the system administrator.
10054
10055.vindex "&$value$&"
10056If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10057During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10058lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10059level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10060the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10061string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10062lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10063original lookup fails.
10064
10065If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10066data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10067expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10068the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10069appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10070to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10071{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10072successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10073
10074For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10075search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10076type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10077&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10078
10079.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10080If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10081and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10082They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10083
10084This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10085.code
10086${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10087.endd
10088This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10089the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10090.code
10091${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10092 {$value}fail}
10093.endd
10094
10095
10096.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10097.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10098.vindex "&$item$&"
10099After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10100default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10101For each item
10102in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10103expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10104for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10105setting is not included in the output. For example:
10106.code
10107${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10108.endd
10109expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10110value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10111and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10112
10113.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10114.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10115.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10116The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10117<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10118if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10119can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10120.code
10121${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10122.endd
10123The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10124the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10125processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10126slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10127example,
10128.code
10129${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10130.endd
10131returns the string &"6/33"&.
10132
10133
10134
10135.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10136.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10137.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10138This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10139interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10140expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10141additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10142name of the subroutine, is nine.
10143
10144The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10145the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10146way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10147Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10148return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10149not its contents.
10150
10151If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10152with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10153Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10154
10155The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10156out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10157
10158
10159.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10160.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10161The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10162keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10163it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10164to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10165as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10166and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10167
10168.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10169 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10170.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10171This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10172checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10173yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10174empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10175prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10176version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10177variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10178
10179These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10180retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10181against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10182which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10183
10184The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10185string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10186result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10187whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10188is the expansion of the third argument.
10189
10190All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10191However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10192For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10193
10194.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10195.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10196.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10197.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10198The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10199then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10200the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10201newlines are left in the string.
10202String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10203you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10204the string expansion fails.
10205
10206The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10207locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10208
10209
10210
10211.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10212 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10213.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10214.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10215.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10216This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10217string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10218examples:
10219.code
10220${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10221${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10222.endd
10223For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10224For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10225a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10226number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10227optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10228example:
10229.code
10230${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10231.endd
10232Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10233one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10234both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10235unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10236and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10237is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10238extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10239.code
10240${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10241.endd
10242
10243The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10244and must be present if the argument is given.
10245Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10246Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10247The first defines whether (the default)
10248or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10249Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10250.code
10251${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10252.endd
10253The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10254.code
10255${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10256.endd
10257The default is to not use TLS.
10258If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10259
10260A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10261that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10262turns them into spaces:
10263.code
10264${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10265.endd
10266As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10267happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10268addition, the following errors can occur:
10269
10270.ilist
10271Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10272.next
10273Failure to connect the socket;
10274.next
10275Failure to write the request string;
10276.next
10277Timeout on reading from the socket.
10278.endlist
10279
10280By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10281you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10282errors occurs. For example:
10283.code
10284${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10285 {socket failure}}
10286.endd
10287You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10288expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10289and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10290if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10291non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10292
10293The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10294locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10295
10296
10297.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10298.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10299.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10300.vindex "&$value$&"
10301.vindex "&$item$&"
10302This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10303<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10304separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10305Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10306assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10307list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10308them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10309iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10310added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10311number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10312.code
10313${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10314.endd
10315The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10316can be found:
10317.code
10318${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10319.endd
10320At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10321restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10322expansion items.
10323
10324.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10325This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10326expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10327
10328.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10329 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10330.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10331.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10332The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10333split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10334in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10335executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10336a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10337
10338Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10339which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10340simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10341script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10342variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10343quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10344in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10345around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10346variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10347character.
10348
10349The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10350and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10351.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10352.vindex "&$value$&"
10353If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10354and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10355from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10356<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10357expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10358&$value$&.
10359
10360If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10361can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10362command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10363of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10364
10365.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10366The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10367In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10368troubleshoot:
10369.code
10370warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10371 log_message = Output of id: $value
10372.endd
10373If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10374shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10375.code
10376${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10377.endd
10378
10379.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10380The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10381remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10382.code
10383if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10384 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10385 ...
10386endif
10387.endd
10388If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10389the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10390commands.
10391
10392&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10393option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10394testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10395by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10396
10397The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10398out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10399
10400
10401.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10402.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10403.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10404This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10405option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10406modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10407into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10408a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10409.code
10410${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10411.endd
10412yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10413if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10414substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10415.code
10416${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10417.endd
10418yields &"defabc"&, and
10419.code
10420${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10421.endd
10422yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10423the regular expression from string expansion.
10424
10425The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10426rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10427
10428
10429.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10430.cindex sorting "a list"
10431.cindex list sorting
10432.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10433After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10434default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10435The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10436of a two-argument expansion condition.
10437The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10438The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10439if the first value should sort before the second value.
10440The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10441the element being placed in &$item$&,
10442to give values for comparison.
10443
10444The item result is a sorted list,
10445with the original list separator,
10446of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10447
10448Examples:
10449.code
10450${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10451.endd
10452sorts a list of numbers, and
10453.code
10454${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10455.endd
10456will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10457
10458
10459.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10460.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10461.cindex "substring extraction"
10462.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10463The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10464<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10465if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10466can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10467.code
10468${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10469.endd
10470The second number is optional (in both notations).
10471If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10472omitted.
10473
10474The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10475&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10476length required. For example
10477.code
10478${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10479.endd
10480If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10481null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10482length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10483given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10484
10485The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10486from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10487the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10488.code
10489${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10490.endd
10491yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10492length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10493the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10494.code
10495${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10496.endd
10497yields an empty string, but
10498.code
10499${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10500.endd
10501yields &"1"&.
10502
10503When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10504is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10505string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10506no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10507.code
10508${substr_-1:abcde}
10509${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10510.endd
10511yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10512
10513All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10514
10515
10516
10517.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10518 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10519.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10520.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10521This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10522argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10523matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10524replacement list. For example
10525.code
10526${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10527.endd
10528yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10529last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10530last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10531place.
10532
10533All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10534
10535.endlist
10536
10537
10538
10539.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10540.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10541For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10542the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10543The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10544following operations can be performed:
10545
10546.vlist
10547.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10548.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10549.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10550The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10551header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10552not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10553
10554The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10555
10556
10557.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10558.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10559.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10560The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
105612822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10562operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10563result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10564doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10565Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10566
10567It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10568separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10569character. For example:
10570.code
10571${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10572.endd
10573expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10574first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10575separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10576separator explicitly:
10577.code
10578${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10579.endd
10580
10581Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10582expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10583address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10584processing lists.
10585
10586To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10587a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10588unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10589email address separator. For the example header line:
10590.code
10591From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10592.endd
10593The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10594properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10595It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10596example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10597de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10598The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10599quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10600.code
10601# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10602=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10603user@example.com
10604# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10605Last:user@example.com
10606# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10607user@example.com
10608# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10609フィリップ@example.jp
10610.endd
10611
10612.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10613.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10614.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10615The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10616base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10617Only lowercase letters are used.
10618
10619.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10620.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10621.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10622The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10623The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10624
10625.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10626.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10627.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10628The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10629base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10630the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10631its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10632filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10633to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10634
10635.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10636.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10637.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10638The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10639environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10640identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10641string.
10642
10643.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10644.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10645.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10646.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10647.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10648This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10649
10650If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10651returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10652
10653
10654.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10655.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10656.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10657.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10658This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10659
10660
10661.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10662.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10663.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10664The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10665from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10666
10667
10668.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10669.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10670.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10671If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10672escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10673significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10674is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10675
10676.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10677.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10678.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10679If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10680they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10681Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10682
10683
10684.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10685.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10686.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10687.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10688These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10689expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10690arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10691logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10692integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10693C programming language):
10694.table2 70pt 300pt
10695.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10696.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10697.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10698.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10699.irow "" "and (&&)"
10700.irow "" "xor (^)"
10701.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10702.endtable
10703Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10704space is permitted before or after operators.
10705
10706For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10707hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10708decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10709permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10710times, which often do have leading zeros.
10711
10712A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10713or 1024*1024*1024,
10714respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10715a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10716
10717.display
10718&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10719&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10720&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10721&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10722&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10723&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10724&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10725&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10726&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10727&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10728&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10729.endd
10730
10731As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10732.code
10733deny message = Too many bad recipients
10734 condition = \
10735 ${if and { \
10736 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10737 { \
10738 < \
10739 {$recipients_count} \
10740 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10741 } \
10742 }{yes}{no}}
10743.endd
10744The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10745fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10746
10747
10748.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10749.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10750The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10751example,
10752.code
10753${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10754.endd
10755first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10756and then re-expands what it has found.
10757
10758
10759.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10760.cindex "Unicode"
10761.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10762.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10763.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10764The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10765email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10766to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10767UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10768converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10769the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10770
10771Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10772ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10773For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10774way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10775characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10776single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10777translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10778
10779
10780.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10781.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10782.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10783The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10784be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10785change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10786.code
10787${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10788.endd
10789See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10790abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10791
10792
10793
10794.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10795.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10796.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10797.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10798This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10799be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10800
10801
10802
10803.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10804.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10805.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10806This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10807escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10808as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10809byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10810
10811
10812.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10813.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10814.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10815This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10816of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10817A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10818Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10819
10820.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10821.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10822.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10823.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10824This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10825Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10826set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10827A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10828Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10829
10830
10831.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10832.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10833.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10834.cindex "lower casing"
10835.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10836.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10837This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10838.code
10839${lc:$local_part}
10840.endd
10841Case is defined per the system C locale.
10842
10843.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10844.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10845.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10846The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10847can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10848changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10849.code
10850${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10851.endd
10852See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10853&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10854when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10855All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10856
10857
10858.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10859.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10860.cindex "list" "item count"
10861.cindex "list" "count of items"
10862.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10863The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10864
10865
10866.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10867.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10868.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10869The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10870expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10871If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10872and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10873Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10874matching list is returned.
10875
10876
10877.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10878.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10879.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10880The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10881extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10882empty.
10883The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10884
10885
10886.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10887.cindex "masked IP address"
10888.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10889.cindex "CIDR notation"
10890.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10891.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10892If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10893slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10894expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10895masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10896the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10897.code
10898${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10899.endd
10900returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10901be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10902address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10903terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10904.code
10905${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10906.endd
10907returns the string
10908.code
109093ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10910.endd
10911Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10912
10913
10914.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10915.cindex "MD5 hash"
10916.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10917.cindex certificate fingerprint
10918.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10919The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10920as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10921
10922If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10923returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10924
10925
10926.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10927.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10928.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10929The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10930that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10931strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10932.code
10933${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10934.endd
10935See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10936
10937
10938.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10939.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10940.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10941.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10942The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10943is an empty string or
10944contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10945Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10946Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10947respectively For example,
10948.code
10949${quote:ab"*"cd}
10950.endd
10951becomes
10952.code
10953"ab\"*\"cd"
10954.endd
10955The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10956variable or a message header.
10957
10958.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10959.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10960This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10961required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10962example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10963If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10964(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10965
10966This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10967will likely use the quoting form.
10968Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10969
10970
10971.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10972.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10973This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10974query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10975the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10976.code
10977${quote_ldap:two * two}
10978.endd
10979returns
10980.code
10981two%20%5C2A%20two
10982.endd
10983For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10984yields an unchanged string.
10985
10986
10987.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10988.cindex "random number"
10989This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10990supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10991on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10992If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10993If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10994for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10995Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10996srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10997random().
10998
10999
11000.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11001.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11002This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11003dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11004dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11005for DNS. For example,
11006.code
11007${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11008${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11009.endd
11010returns
11011.code
110124.2.0.192
11013f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11014.endd
11015
11016
11017.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11018.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11019.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11020.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11021This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11022encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11023assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11024&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11025contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11026characters
11027.code
11028? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11029.endd
11030it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11031string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11032characters.
11033
11034
11035.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11036.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11037.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11038.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11039This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11040bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11041character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11042not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11043
11044&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11045access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11046to use this operator as well.
11047
11048
11049
11050.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11051.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11052.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11053.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11054The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11055characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11056variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11057
11058
11059.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11060.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11061.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11062.cindex certificate fingerprint
11063.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11064The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11065it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11066
11067If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11068returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11069
11070
11071.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11072 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11073 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11074.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11075.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11076.cindex certificate fingerprint
11077.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11078.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11079.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11080The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11081and returns
11082it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11083
11084If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11085returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11086
11087The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11088(except for certificates, which are not supported).
11089Finally, if an underbar
11090and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11091member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11092Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11093
11094
11095.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11096 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11097.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11098.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11099.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11100The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11101and returns
11102it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11103
11104If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11105the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11106with 256 being the default.
11107
11108The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11109compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11110or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11111The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11112
11113
11114.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11115.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11116.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11117.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11118The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11119function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11120expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11121series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11122except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11123a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1112410-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11125&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11126can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11127
11128The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11129the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11130systems for files larger than 2GB.
11131
11132.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11133.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11134Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11135
11136
11137
11138.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11139.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11140.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11141.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11142The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11143decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11144All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11145
11146
11147.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11148.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11149.cindex "substring extraction"
11150.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11151The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11152can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11153that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11154.code
11155${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11156.endd
11157See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11158abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11159All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11160
11161.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11162.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11163.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11164This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11165seconds.
11166
11167.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11168.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11169.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11170The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11171represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11172number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11173&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11174
11175.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11176.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11177.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11178.cindex "upper casing"
11179.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11180.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11181This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11182Case is defined per the system C locale.
11183
11184.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11185.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11186.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11187.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11188.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11189.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11190This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11191In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11192final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11193If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11194the complexity will depend upon the task.
11195For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11196extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11197dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11198.code
11199condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11200.endd
11201(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11202literal question mark).
11203
11204.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11205 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11206 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11207 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11208.cindex expansion UTF-8
11209.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11210.cindex EAI
11211.cindex internationalisation
11212.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11213.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11214.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11215.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11216These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11217For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11218.endlist
11219
11220
11221
11222
11223
11224
11225.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11226.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11227The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11228while expanding strings:
11229
11230.vlist
11231.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11232.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11233.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11234Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11235condition.
11236
11237.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11238.cindex "numeric comparison"
11239.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11240There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11241are:
11242.display
11243&`= `& equal
11244&`== `& equal
11245&`> `& greater
11246&`>= `& greater or equal
11247&`< `& less
11248&`<= `& less or equal
11249.endd
11250For example:
11251.code
11252${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11253.endd
11254Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11255two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11256optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11257lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11258As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11259zero.
11260
11261In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11262<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1126310M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11264
11265
11266.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11267 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11268.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11269.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11270The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11271arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11272Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11273arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11274and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11275are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11276a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11277the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11278If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11279If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11280
11281.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11282.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11283.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11284This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11285a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11286(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11287false if zero.
11288An empty string is treated as false.
11289Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11290thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11291All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11292
11293When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11294make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11295For example:
11296.code
11297${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11298.endd
11299
11300
11301.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11302.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11303.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11304Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11305where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11306loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11307and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11308true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11309
11310Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11311
11312.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11313.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11314.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11315.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11316This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11317authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11318necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11319included in the binary.
11320
11321The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11322compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11323be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11324encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11325does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11326&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11327Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11328string in LDAP form is:
11329.code
11330{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11331.endd
11332If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11333be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11334.code
11335${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11336.endd
11337The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11338supported:
11339
11340.ilist
11341.cindex "MD5 hash"
11342.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11343&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11344printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11345length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11346(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11347hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11348comparison fails.
11349
11350.next
11351.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11352&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11353printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11354length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11355If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11356SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11357
11358.next
11359.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11360&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11361only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11362systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11363whatever its length.
11364
11365.next
11366.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11367&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11368use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11369modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11370.endlist
11371Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11372&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11373HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11374operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11375the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11376support &[crypt16()]&.
11377
11378Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11379it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11380turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11381&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11382algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11383
11384However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11385functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11386Exim is seen as very low priority.
11387
11388If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11389comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11390determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11391default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11392function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11393
11394.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11395.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11396.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11397The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11398variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11399variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11400.code
11401${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11402.endd
11403Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11404variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11405
11406.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11407 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11408.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11409This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11410exists in the message. For example,
11411.code
11412${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11413.endd
11414&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11415the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11416
11417.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11418 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11419.cindex "string" "comparison"
11420.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11421.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11422.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11423The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11424resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11425letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11426case is defined per the system C locale.
11427
11428.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11429.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11430.cindex "file" "existence test"
11431.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11432The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11433condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11434is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11435users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11436
11437.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11438.cindex "delivery" "first"
11439.cindex "first delivery"
11440.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11441.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11442This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11443attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11444
11445
11446.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11447 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11448.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11449.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11450.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11451.vindex "&$item$&"
11452These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11453the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11454the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11455The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11456be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11457condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11458.ilist
11459For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11460the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11461items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11462.next
11463For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11464and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11465all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11466.endlist
11467Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11468items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11469that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11470list separator is changed to a comma:
11471.code
11472${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11473.endd
11474The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11475being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11476
11477To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11478
11479.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11480 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11481 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11482 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11483.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11484.cindex JSON expansions
11485.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11486.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11487.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11488.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11489As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11490be a JSON array.
11491The array separator is not changeable.
11492For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11493and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11494
11495
11496
11497.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11498 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11499.cindex "string" "comparison"
11500.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11501.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11502.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11503The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11504string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11505comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11506case-independent.
11507Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11508
11509.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11510 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11511.cindex "string" "comparison"
11512.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11513.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11514.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11515The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11516string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11517includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11518case-independent.
11519Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11520
11521.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11522 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11523.cindex "string" "comparison"
11524.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11525Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11526strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11527is true.
11528For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11529
11530These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11531Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11532.code
11533${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11534 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11535${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11536 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11537.endd
11538
11539.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11540 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11541 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11542.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11543.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11544.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11545.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11546.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11547The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11548an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11549&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11550
11551For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11552which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11553colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11554hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11555component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11556
11557&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11558values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11559check.
11560This is no longer the case.
11561
11562The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11563host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11564.code
11565${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11566.endd
11567to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11568
11569.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11570.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11571.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11572.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11573This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11574&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11575queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11576query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11577password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11578server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11579with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11580will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11581of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11582this can be used.
11583
11584
11585.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11586 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11587.cindex "string" "comparison"
11588.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11589.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11590.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11591The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11592string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11593comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11594case-independent.
11595Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11596
11597.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11598 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11599.cindex "string" "comparison"
11600.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11601.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11602.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11603The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11604string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11605includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11606case-independent.
11607Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11608
11609
11610.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11611.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11612.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11613.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11614The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11615expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11616regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11617escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11618(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11619premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11620&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11621For example,
11622.code
11623${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11624.endd
11625If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11626backslashes is also required.
11627
11628The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11629The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11630metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11631and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11632the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11633metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11634All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11635but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11636
11637.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11638At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11639substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11640succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11641will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11642of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11643combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11644variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11645
11646.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11647.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11648See &*match_local_part*&.
11649
11650.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11651.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11652See &*match_local_part*&.
11653
11654.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11655.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11656This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11657be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11658address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11659list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11660.code
11661${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11662.endd
11663The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11664
11665.ilist
11666An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11667.next
11668A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11669.next
11670An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11671useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11672in a single test such as
11673. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11674. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11675. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11676. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11677.code
11678 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11679.endd
11680where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11681.next
11682The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11683.next
11684Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11685even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11686address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11687&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11688masks. For example:
11689.code
11690 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11691.endd
11692It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11693do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11694address mask, for example:
11695.code
11696 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11697.endd
11698However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11699just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11700.code
11701 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11702.endd
11703.endlist ilist
11704
11705Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11706Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11707
11708Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11709
11710.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11711.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11712.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11713.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11714.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11715This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11716possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11717condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11718example is:
11719.code
11720${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11721.endd
11722In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11723list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11724is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11725Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11726.code
11727${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11728.endd
11729.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11730For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11731item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11732have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11733caselessly.
11734
11735Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11736Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11737
11738&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11739hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11740how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11741matched using &%match_ip%&.
11742
11743.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11744.cindex "PAM authentication"
11745.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11746.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11747.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11748.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11749&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11750(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11751available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11752distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11753the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11754.code
11755SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11756.endd
11757in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11758in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11759
11760The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11761colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11762The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11763taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11764The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11765from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11766request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11767
11768There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11769characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11770separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11771item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11772of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11773.code
11774server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11775.endd
11776For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11777.code
11778server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11779.endd
11780In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11781running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11782messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11783. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11784
11785
11786.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11787.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11788.cindex "Cyrus"
11789.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11790.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11791This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11792This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11793that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11794deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11795
11796The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11797the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11798building Exim. For example:
11799.code
11800CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11801.endd
11802You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11803the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11804from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11805access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11806
11807The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11808password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11809configuration, you might have this:
11810.code
11811server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11812.endd
11813Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11814.code
11815server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11816.endd
11817.vitem &*queue_running*&
11818.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11819.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11820.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11821This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11822initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11823
11824
11825.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11826.cindex "Radius"
11827.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11828.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11829Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11830set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11831the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11832support.
11833
11834With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11835library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11836this library, you need to set
11837.code
11838RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11839.endd
11840in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11841&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11842.code
11843RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11844.endd
11845in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11846You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11847Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11848
11849The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11850Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11851the authentication is successful. For example:
11852.code
11853server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11854.endd
11855
11856
11857.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11858 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11859.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11860.cindex "Cyrus"
11861.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11862.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11863This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11864daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11865Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11866by a process that is not running as root.
11867
11868The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11869the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11870building Exim. For example:
11871.code
11872CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11873.endd
11874You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11875the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11876from the Cyrus SASL library.
11877
11878Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11879two are mandatory. For example:
11880.code
11881server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11882.endd
11883The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11884in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11885realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11886.endlist vlist
11887
11888
11889
11890.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11891.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11892Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11893and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11894conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11895sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11896the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11897
11898
11899.vlist
11900.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11901.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11902.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11903The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11904any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11905For example,
11906.code
11907${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11908.endd
11909When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11910evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11911numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11912
11913.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11914.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11915.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11916The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11917all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11918sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11919the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11920parsed but not evaluated.
11921.endlist
11922.ecindex IIDexpcond
11923
11924
11925
11926
11927.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11928.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11929This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11930of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11931support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11932
11933.vlist
11934.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11935.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11936When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11937captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11938processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11939In the expansion condition case
11940they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11941values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11942variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11943precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11944Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11945matching condition.
11946
11947.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11948Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11949any arguments are copied to these variables,
11950any unused variables being made empty.
11951
11952.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11953Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11954can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11955long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11956example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11957variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11958used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11959same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11960with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11961during subsequent delivery.
11962
11963.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11964These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11965are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11966received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11967message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11968also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11969message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11970and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11971delivery.
11972
11973.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11974Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11975this variable has the number of arguments.
11976
11977.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11978.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11979After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11980message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11981be preserved by coding like this:
11982.code
11983warn !verify = sender
11984 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11985.endd
11986You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11987&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11988failure.
11989
11990.vitem &$address_data$&
11991.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11992This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11993value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11994and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11995the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11996for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11997user filter files.
11998
11999If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12000a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12001conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12002to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12003of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12004from the child's routing.
12005
12006If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12007sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12008&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12009address.
12010
12011In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12012after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12013these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12014
12015.vitem &$address_file$&
12016.vindex "&$address_file$&"
12017When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12018to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12019is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12020default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12021.code
12022/home/r2d2/savemail
12023.endd
12024then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12025contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12026.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12027For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12028then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12029to the relevant file.
12030
12031.vitem &$address_pipe$&
12032.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12033When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12034this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12035
12036.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
12037.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12038These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12039&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12040
12041.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12042.cindex "authentication" "id"
12043.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12044When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12045preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12046&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12047user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12048in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12049&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12050
12051When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12052the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12053process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12054command line option.
12055This second case also sets up information used by the
12056&$authresults$& expansion item.
12057
12058.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12059.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12060.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12061When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12062will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12063id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12064available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12065A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12066authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12067the ACL's as well.
12068
12069
12070.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12071.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12072.cindex "authentication" "sender"
12073.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12074.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12075When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12076SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12077described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12078&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12079available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12080sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12081
12082.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12083When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12084value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12085name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12086can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12087
12088
12089.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12090.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12091.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12092This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12093command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12094possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12095(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12096&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12097is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12098negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12099an undefined mechanism.
12100
12101.vitem &$av_failed$&
12102.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12103This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12104extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12105problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12106the ACL malware condition.
12107
12108.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12109.cindex "message body" "line count"
12110.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12111.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12112When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12113number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12114
12115.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12116.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12117.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12118.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12119.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12120When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12121number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12122
12123.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12124.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12125This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12126it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12127chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12128
12129.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12130.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12131This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12132up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12133file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12134
12135.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12136.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12137.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12138The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12139not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12140&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12141incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12142
12143.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12144.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12145.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12146The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12147not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12148&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12149incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12150
12151.vitem &$callout_address$&
12152.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12153After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12154address that was connected to.
12155
12156.vitem &$compile_number$&
12157.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12158The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12159of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12160compilations of the same version of Exim.
12161
12162.vitem &$config_dir$&
12163.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12164The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12165&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12166contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12167&$config_dir$& is ".".
12168
12169.vitem &$config_file$&
12170.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12171The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12172
12173.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12174 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12175 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12176 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12177Results of DMARC verification.
12178For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12179
12180.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12181Results of DKIM verification.
12182For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12183
12184.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12185 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12186 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12187 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12188 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12189 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12190 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12191 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12192 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12193 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12194 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12195 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12196 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12197 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12198 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12199 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12200 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12201 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12202 &$dkim_key_length$&
12203These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12204For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12205
12206.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12207.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12208When a message has been received this variable contains
12209a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12210For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12211
12212.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12213 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12214 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12215 &$dnslist_value$&
12216.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12217.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12218.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12219.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12220.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12221When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12222the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12223looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12224main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12225
12226.vitem &$domain$&
12227.vindex "&$domain$&"
12228When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12229contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12230case for &$domain$&.
12231
12232Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12233&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12234is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12235message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12236
12237When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12238RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12239have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12240at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12241the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12242which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12243
12244.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12245At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12246set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12247
12248The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12249
12250.ilist
12251When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12252the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12253&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12254normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12255is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12256&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12257the &(smtp)& transport.
12258
12259.next
12260When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12261&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12262it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12263rewrite domains by file lookup.
12264
12265.next
12266With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12267&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12268a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12269is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12270that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12271recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12272
12273.next
12274.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12275.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12276When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12277the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12278.endlist
12279
12280.new
12281.cindex "tainted data"
12282If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12283the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12284See also &$domain_verified$&.
12285.wen
12286
12287
12288.vitem &$domain_data$&
12289.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12290When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12291means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12292of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12293address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12294transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12295used.
12296
12297&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12298domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12299the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12300to nothing.
12301
12302.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12303.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12304This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12305
12306.vitem &$exim_path$&
12307.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12308This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12309
12310.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12311.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12312This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12313
12314.vitem &$exim_version$&
12315.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12316This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12317The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12318Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12319There may be other characters following the minor version.
12320This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12321
12322.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12323This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12324inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12325be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12326characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12327See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12328
12329.vitem &$headers_added$&
12330.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12331Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12332the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12333The headers are a newline-separated list.
12334
12335.vitem &$home$&
12336.vindex "&$home$&"
12337When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12338directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12339means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12340explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12341by a setting on the transport itself.
12342
12343When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12344of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12345&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12346
12347.vitem &$host$&
12348.vindex "&$host$&"
12349If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12350list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12351to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12352to local and remote transports.
12353
12354.cindex "transport" "filter"
12355.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12356For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12357&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12358particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12359using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12360&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12361is connected.
12362
12363When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12364&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12365client is connected.
12366
12367
12368.vitem &$host_address$&
12369.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12370This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12371for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12372when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12373
12374.vitem &$host_data$&
12375.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12376If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12377result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12378allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12379.code
12380deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12381message = $host_data
12382.endd
12383.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12384.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12385.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12386This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12387message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12388name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12389variables is set to &"1"&.
12390
12391.ilist
12392If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12393succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12394
12395.next
12396If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12397tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12398lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12399.endlist ilist
12400
12401Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12402single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12403names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12404is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12405&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12406IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12407sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12408lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12409the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12410&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12411
12412.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12413Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12414&%authresults%& expansion item.
12415
12416
12417.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12418.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12419See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12420
12421.vitem &$host_port$&
12422.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12423This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12424for an outbound connection.
12425
12426.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12427.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12428This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12429directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12430working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12431to &$spool_directory$& later.
12432
12433.vitem &$inode$&
12434.vindex "&$inode$&"
12435The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12436option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12437of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12438a unique name for the file.
12439
12440.vitem &$interface_address$&
12441.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12442This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12443
12444.vitem &$interface_port$&
12445.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12446This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12447
12448.vitem &$item$&
12449.vindex "&$item$&"
12450This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12451conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12452&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12453empty.
12454
12455.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12456.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12457This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12458contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12459lookup.
12460
12461.vitem &$load_average$&
12462.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12463This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12464is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12465variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12466
12467.vitem &$local_part$&
12468.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12469When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12470variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12471delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12472session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12473
12474Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12475&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12476&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12477because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12478once.
12479
12480.new
12481.cindex "tainted data"
12482If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12483the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12484
12485&*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12486attacker.
12487Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12488for file access.
12489This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12490For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12491&$local_part_verified$& variable rather than this one.
12492For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12493which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12494rather than this variable.
12495If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12496the retrieved data.
12497.wen
12498
12499.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12500.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
12501.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12502.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
12503.cindex affix variables
12504If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12505value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12506any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12507&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12508.new
12509If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12510the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12511&$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate.
12512.wen
12513
12514When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12515result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12516the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12517&$address_pipe$&).
12518
12519When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12520local part of the recipient address.
12521
12522When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12523&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12524it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12525
12526In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12527the addresses
12528.code
12529"abc:xyz"@test.example
12530abc\:xyz@test.example
12531.endd
12532the value of &$local_part$& is
12533.code
12534abc:xyz
12535.endd
12536If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12537inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12538have:
12539.code
12540data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12541.endd
12542&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12543to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12544&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12545
12546.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12547.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12548When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12549lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12550router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12551to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12552handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12553
12554&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12555matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12556available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12557variable expands to nothing.
12558
12559.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12560.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12561.cindex affix variables
12562When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12563specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12564variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12565
12566.new
12567.vitem &$local_part_prefix_v$&
12568.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
12569When &$local_part_prefix$& is valid and the prefix match used a wildcard,
12570the portion matching the wildcard is available in this variable.
12571.wen
12572
12573.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12574.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12575When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12576specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12577variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12578
12579.new
12580.vitem &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12581.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
12582When &$local_part_suffix$& is valid and the suffix match used a wildcard,
12583the portion matching the wildcard is available in this variable.
12584.wen
12585
12586.new
12587.vitem &$local_part_verified$&
12588.vindex "&$local_part_verified$&"
12589If the router generic option &%check_local_part%& has run successfully,
12590this variable has the user database version of &$local_part$&.
12591Such values are not tainted and hence usable for building file names.
12592.wen
12593
12594.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12595.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12596This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12597a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12598
12599.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12600.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12601See &$local_user_uid$&.
12602
12603.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12604.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12605This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12606&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12607are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12608and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12609router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12610are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12611
12612.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12613.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12614This contains the expanded value of the
12615&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12616been read.
12617
12618.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12619.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12620The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12621log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12622referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12623the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12624
12625.vitem &$log_space$&
12626.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12627The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12628partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12629whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12630ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12631the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12632
12633
12634.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12635.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12636This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12637a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12638.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12639It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12640&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12641and &"yes"& if it was.
12642Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12643the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12644as authenticated data.
12645
12646.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12647.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12648This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12649&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12650&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12651contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12652without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12653variable is empty.
12654
12655.vitem &$malware_name$&
12656.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12657This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12658content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12659when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12660
12661.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12662.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12663.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12664.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12665This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12666received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12667character(s).
12668It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12669
12670.vitem &$message_age$&
12671.cindex "message" "age of"
12672.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12673This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12674of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12675delivery attempt.
12676
12677.vitem &$message_body$&
12678.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12679.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12680.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12681.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12682.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12683This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12684being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12685number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12686&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12687
12688.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12689By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12690easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12691this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12692zeros are always converted into spaces.
12693
12694.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12695.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12696.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12697.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12698This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12699body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12700&$message_body$&.
12701
12702.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12703.cindex "body of message" "size"
12704.cindex "message body" "size"
12705.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12706When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12707in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12708separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12709also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12710
12711If the spool file is wireformat
12712(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12713the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12714
12715.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12716.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12717When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12718unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12719An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12720received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12721line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12722&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12723
12724.vitem &$message_headers$&
12725.vindex &$message_headers$&
12726This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12727is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12728lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12729same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12730
12731.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12732.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12733This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12734contents of header lines is done.
12735
12736.vitem &$message_id$&
12737This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12738
12739.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12740.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12741This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12742message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12743During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12744number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12745routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12746&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12747lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12748from the body is not counted.
12749
12750As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12751appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12752&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12753file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12754header and the body).
12755
12756Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12757.code
12758deny message = Too many lines in message header
12759 condition = \
12760 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12761.endd
12762In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12763message has not yet been received.
12764
12765This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12766
12767.vitem &$message_size$&
12768.cindex "size" "of message"
12769.cindex "message" "size"
12770.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12771When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12772most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12773message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12774deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12775expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12776doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12777precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12778&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12779
12780.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12781While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12782contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12783value may not, of course, be truthful.
12784
12785.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12786A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12787available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12788details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12789
12790.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12791These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12792of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12793
12794.vitem &$original_domain$&
12795.vindex "&$domain$&"
12796.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12797When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12798same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12799generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12800variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12801differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12802aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12803single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12804
12805If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12806filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12807part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12808
12809.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12810.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12811.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12812When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12813same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12814local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12815part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12816filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12817the original address.
12818
12819If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12820case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12821This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12822one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12823delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12824
12825If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12826filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12827part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12828
12829.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12830.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12831.cindex "sender" "gid"
12832.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12833.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12834This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12835message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12836gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12837normally the gid of the Exim user.
12838
12839.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12840.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12841.cindex "sender" "uid"
12842.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12843.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12844The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12845messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12846For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12847user.
12848
12849.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12850.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12851This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12852above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12853
12854.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12855.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12856This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12857(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12858
12859.vitem &$pid$&
12860.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12861.vindex "&$pid$&"
12862This variable contains the current process id.
12863
12864.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12865.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12866.cindex "transport" "filter"
12867.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12868This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12869&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12870&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12871(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12872It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12873variable"& error if encountered.
12874
12875.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12876.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12877This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12878configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12879a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12880&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12881qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12882
12883
12884.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12885 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12886 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12887 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12888 &$proxy_session$&
12889These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12890or SOCKS5 support.
12891For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12892
12893.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12894.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12895This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12896current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12897
12898.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12899This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12900which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12901&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12902
12903.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12904This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12905which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12906&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12907
12908.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12909This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12910which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12911&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12912
12913.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12914.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12915The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12916
12917.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12918.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12919The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12920or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12921
12922.vitem &$queue_name$&
12923.vindex &$queue_name$&
12924.cindex "named queues" variable
12925.cindex queues named
12926The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12927
12928.vitem &$queue_size$&
12929.vindex "&$queue_size$&"
12930.cindex "queue" "size of"
12931.cindex "spool" "number of messages"
12932This variable contains the number of messages queued.
12933It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
12934
12935.vitem &$r_...$&
12936.vindex &$r_...$&
12937.cindex router variables
12938Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12939They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12940The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12941and the eventual transport.
12942
12943.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12944.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12945When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12946RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12947RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12948
12949.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12950.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12951.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12952When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12953RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12954temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12955
12956.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12957.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12958When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12959RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12960permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12961
12962.vitem &$received_count$&
12963.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12964This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12965including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12966is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12967delivering.
12968
12969.vitem &$received_for$&
12970.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12971If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12972variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12973built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12974the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12975
12976.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12977.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12978As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12979variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12980is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12981&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12982the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12983option.
12984
12985As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12986could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12987on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12988values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12989messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12990time.
12991For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12992
12993.vitem &$received_port$&
12994.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12995See &$received_ip_address$&.
12996
12997.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12998.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12999When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13000protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13001by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13002&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13003(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13004is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13005connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13006
13007Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13008automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13009&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13010encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13011where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13012STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13013
13014The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13015messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13016identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13017
13018.vitem &$received_time$&
13019.vindex "&$received_time$&"
13020This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13021as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13022
13023.vitem &$recipient_data$&
13024.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13025This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13026condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13027until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13028.display
13029&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13030&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13031.endd
13032&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13033method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13034The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13035expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13036
13037.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13038.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13039In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13040information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13041
13042.ilist
13043&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13044was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13045
13046.next
13047&"route"&: Routing failed.
13048
13049.next
13050&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13051or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13052MAIL).
13053
13054.next
13055&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13056.next
13057
13058&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13059.endlist
13060
13061The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13062rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13063
13064.vitem &$recipients$&
13065.vindex "&$recipients$&"
13066This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13067a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13068is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13069unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13070cases:
13071
13072.olist
13073In a system filter file.
13074.next
13075In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13076is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13077&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13078&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13079.next
13080From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13081.endlist
13082
13083
13084.vitem &$recipients_count$&
13085.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13086When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13087envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13088from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13089increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13090
13091
13092.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13093.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13094This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13095&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13096
13097.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13098.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13099When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13100these variables contain the
13101captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13102
13103
13104.vitem &$reply_address$&
13105.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13106When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13107&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13108contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13109white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13110decoding or character code translation takes place.
13111
13112.vitem &$return_path$&
13113.vindex "&$return_path$&"
13114When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13115the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13116in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13117same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13118mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13119for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13120address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13121that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13122the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13123envelope sender.
13124
13125.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13126.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13127This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13128
13129.vitem &$router_name$&
13130.cindex "router" "name"
13131.cindex "name" "of router"
13132.vindex "&$router_name$&"
13133During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13134
13135.vitem &$runrc$&
13136.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13137.vindex "&$runrc$&"
13138This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13139&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13140assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13141preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13142reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13143another.
13144
13145.vitem &$self_hostname$&
13146.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13147.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13148When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13149local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13150One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13151happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13152original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13153
13154.vitem &$sender_address$&
13155.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13156When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13157that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13158is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13159value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13160
13161.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13162.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13163.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13164If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13165sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13166distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13167after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13168longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13169
13170.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13171.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13172The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13173
13174.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13175.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13176The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13177
13178.vitem &$sender_data$&
13179.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13180This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13181in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13182value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13183this:
13184.display
13185&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13186&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13187.endd
13188&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13189method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13190The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13191expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13192
13193.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13194.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13195When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13196name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13197brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13198enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13199issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13200looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13201&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13202start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13203verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13204the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13205the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13206
13207.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13208.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13209This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13210.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13211done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13212
13213.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13214.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13215When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13216command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13217set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13218the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13219
13220.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13221.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13222When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13223this variable contains that
13224host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13225
13226.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13227.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13228This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13229driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13230received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13231&$authenticated_id$&.
13232
13233.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13234.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13235If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13236(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13237otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13238resolver library states that both
13239the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13240other times, this variable is false.
13241
13242.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13243It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13244library, by setting:
13245.code
13246dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13247.endd
13248
13249Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13250validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13251
13252If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13253mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13254
13255This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13256DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13257all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13258is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13259
13260
13261.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13262.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13263When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13264host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13265other means, this variable is empty.
13266
13267.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13268If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13269&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13270A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13271via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13272any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13273&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13274
13275.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13276However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13277DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13278&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13279
13280Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13281host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13282in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13283is set to &"1"&.
13284
13285Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13286maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13287these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13288following are true:
13289
13290.ilist
13291A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13292.next
13293The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13294configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13295to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13296.next
13297Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13298that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13299&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13300.next
13301The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13302In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13303EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13304.next
13305The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13306domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13307. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13308. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13309.code
13310 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13311.endd
13312which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13313IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13314.endlist
13315
13316
13317.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13318.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13319When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13320number that was used on the remote host.
13321
13322.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13323.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13324When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13325identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13326been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13327called Exim.
13328
13329.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13330A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13331&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13332&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13333
13334.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13335.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13336.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13337.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13338This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13339either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13340there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13341there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13342the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13343followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13344first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13345the parentheses.
13346
13347There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13348was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13349address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13350all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13351into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13352
13353.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13354.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13355In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13356about the failure. The details are the same as for
13357&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13358
13359.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13360.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13361This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13362been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13363used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13364on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13365connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13366
13367.vitem &$sending_port$&
13368.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13369This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13370been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13371connections, see &$received_port$&.
13372
13373.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13374.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13375During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13376host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13377&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13378value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13379
13380.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13381.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13382During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13383entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13384the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13385.code
13386MAIL FROM:<>
13387MAIL FROM: <>
13388.endd
13389For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13390command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13391rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13392the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13393
13394.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13395.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13396.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13397While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13398argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13399space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13400somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13401
13402.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13403.cindex SMTP "command history"
13404.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13405A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13406received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13407are remembered.
13408
13409.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13410.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13411This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13412daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13413in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13414connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13415the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13416never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13417there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13418single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13419daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13420
13421.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13422These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13423that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13424filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13425example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13426message is junk mail.
13427
13428.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13429A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13430is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13431&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13432
13433.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13434 &$spf_received$& &&&
13435 &$spf_result$& &&&
13436 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13437 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13438These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13439For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13440
13441.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13442.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13443The name of Exim's spool directory.
13444
13445.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13446.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13447The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13448being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13449If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13450is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13451
13452.vitem &$spool_space$&
13453.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13454The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13455Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13456variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13457find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13458value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13459megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13460.code
13461condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13462.endd
13463See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13464
13465
13466.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13467.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13468This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13469command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13470command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13471interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13472
13473.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13474.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13475Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13476on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13477this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13478If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13479The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13480when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13481
13482The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13483except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13484the outbound.
13485
13486.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13487.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13488Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13489on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13490this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13491If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13492
13493.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13494.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13495.cindex certificate variables
13496This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13497inbound connection when the message was received.
13498It is only useful as the argument of a
13499&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13500or a &%def%& condition.
13501
13502&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13503when a list of more than one
13504file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13505The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13506
13507.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13508.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13509This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13510inbound connection when the message was received.
13511It is only useful as the argument of a
13512&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13513or a &%def%& condition.
13514If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13515which is not the leaf.
13516
13517.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13518.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13519This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13520outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13521&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13522or a &%def%& condition.
13523
13524.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13525.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13526This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13527outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13528&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13529or a &%def%& condition.
13530If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13531which is not the leaf.
13532
13533.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13534.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13535This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13536message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13537
13538The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13539except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13540the outbound.
13541
13542.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13543.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13544This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13545outbound SMTP connection was made,
13546and &"0"& otherwise.
13547
13548.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13549.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13550.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13551When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13552connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13553example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13554received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13555&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13556non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13557
13558The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13559but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13560becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13561
13562.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13563.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13564As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13565
13566.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13567.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13568This variable is
13569cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13570and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13571&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13572details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13573
13574.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13575.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13576As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13577
13578.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13579.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13580DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13581
13582.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13583.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13584When a message is received from a remote client connection
13585the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13586.code
135870 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
135881 No response to request
135892 Response not verified
135903 Verification failed
135914 Verification succeeded
13592.endd
13593
13594.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13595.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13596When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13597the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13598See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13599
13600.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13601.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13602.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13603.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13604When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13605connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13606the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13607&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13608If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13609which is not the leaf.
13610
13611The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13612except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13613the outbound.
13614
13615.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13616.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13617When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13618connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13619the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13620&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13621If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13622which is not the leaf.
13623
13624.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13625.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13626.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13627.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13628When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13629Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13630If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13631some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13632will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13633a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13634used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13635
13636The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13637except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13638the outbound.
13639
13640.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13641.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13642.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13643During outbound
13644SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13645the transport.
13646
13647.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13648.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13649Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13650
13651.vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13652.vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13653When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13654this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13655
13656.vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13657.vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13658When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13659this variable is set to the protocol version.
13660
13661
13662.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13663.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13664The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13665files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13666
13667.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13668.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13669The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13670
13671.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13672.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13673The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13674
13675.vitem &$tod_full$&
13676.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13677A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13678+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13679positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13680values for those that are behind (west).
13681
13682.vitem &$tod_log$&
13683.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13684The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
136851995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13686
13687.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13688.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13689This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13690is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13691flag.
13692
13693.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13694.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13695This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13696-0500.
13697
13698.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13699.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13700This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13701by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13702
13703.vitem &$transport_name$&
13704.cindex "transport" "name"
13705.cindex "name" "of transport"
13706.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13707During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13708
13709.vitem &$value$&
13710.vindex "&$value$&"
13711This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13712or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13713&*reduce*& expansion.
13714
13715.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13716.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13717While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13718contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13719Otherwise, empty.
13720
13721.vitem &$version_number$&
13722.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13723The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13724by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13725
13726.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13727.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13728This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13729delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13730
13731.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13732.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13733This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13734delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13735.endlist
13736.ecindex IIDstrexp
13737
13738
13739
13740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13742
13743.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13744.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13745Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13746Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13747use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13748your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13749the line
13750.code
13751EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13752.endd
13753in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13754
13755
13756.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13757.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13758Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13759&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13760no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13761interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13762the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13763option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13764a newly created Perl interpreter.
13765
13766The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13767need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13768should usually be something like
13769.code
13770perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13771.endd
13772where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13773use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13774soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13775the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13776its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13777fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13778necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13779the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13780two ways:
13781
13782.ilist
13783.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13784Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13785a startup when Exim is entered.
13786.next
13787The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13788overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13789.endlist
13790
13791There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13792initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13793
13794.ilist
13795.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13796.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13797To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13798interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13799taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13800option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13801defaults to false.
13802
13803
13804.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13805When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13806of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13807by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13808forms:
13809.code
13810${perl{foo}}
13811${perl{foo}{argument}}
13812${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13813.endd
13814which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13815arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13816with an error message of the form
13817.code
13818Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13819.endd
13820The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13821it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13822return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13823an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13824by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13825that was passed to &%die%&.
13826
13827
13828.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13829Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13830is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13831the Perl code
13832.code
13833my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13834.endd
13835makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13836Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13837&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13838
13839If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13840&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13841expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13842an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13843
13844.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13845.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13846Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13847&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13848debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13849&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13850timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13851
13852
13853.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13854.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13855You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13856Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13857before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13858SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13859is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13860error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13861avoided, but the output is lost.
13862
13863.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13864The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13865Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13866you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13867output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13868change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13869For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13870.code
13871$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13872.endd
13873Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13874example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13875include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13876as the first subroutine argument.
13877.ecindex IIDperl
13878
13879
13880. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13881. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13882
13883.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13884 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13885 "Starting the daemon"
13886.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13887.cindex "interface" "listening"
13888.cindex "network interface"
13889.cindex "interface" "network"
13890.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13891.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13892.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13893.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13894A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13895hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13896or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13897works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13898In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13899IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13900knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13901
13902.olist
13903When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13904and ports to listen on.
13905.next
13906When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13907are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13908processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13909same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13910when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13911local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13912option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13913as an error situation.
13914.next
13915When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13916for the outgoing connection.
13917.endlist
13918
13919
13920Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13921of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13922addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13923standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13924rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13925
13926In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13927interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13928options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13929chapter describes how they operate.
13930
13931When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13932actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13933
13934
13935
13936.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13937When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13938option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13939following options:
13940
13941.ilist
13942&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13943or service names.
13944(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13945.next
13946&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13947listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13948.endlist
13949
13950The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13951described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13952it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13953colons. For example:
13954.code
13955local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13956 192.168.23.65 ; \
13957 ::1 ; \
13958 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13959.endd
13960There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13961in &%local_interfaces%&:
13962
13963.olist
13964The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13965on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13966.code
13967local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13968 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13969.endd
13970.next
13971The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13972with a colon separator, for example:
13973.code
13974local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13975 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13976.endd
13977.endlist
13978
13979When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13980default setting contains just one port:
13981.code
13982daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13983.endd
13984If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13985specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13986&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13987&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13988IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13989
13990
13991
13992.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13993The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13994as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13995case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13996instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13997default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13998.code
13999local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14000.endd
14001when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14002.code
14003local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14004.endd
14005Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14006
14007
14008
14009.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14010The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14011&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14012instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14013option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14014the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14015exim.
14016
14017The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14018changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14019If there are any items that do not
14020contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14021&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14022items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14023replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14024.code
14025-oX 1225
14026.endd
14027overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14028whereas
14029.code
14030-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14031.endd
14032overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14033(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14034value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14035
14036
14037
14038.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14039.cindex "submissions protocol"
14040.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14041.cindex "smtps protocol"
14042.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14043.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14044Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14045&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14046For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14047STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14048the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14049If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14050(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14051the 465 TCP ports.
14052
14053If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14054service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14055proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14056
14057The common use of this option is expected to be
14058.code
14059tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14060.endd
14061per RFC 8314.
14062There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14063to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14064
14065&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14066daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14067&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14068because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14069connections via the daemon.)
14070
14071
14072
14073
14074.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14075.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14076IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14077can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14078interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14079address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14080percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14081adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14082.code
14083fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14084.endd
14085To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14086allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14087to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14088percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14089address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14090&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14091.code
14092IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14093.endd
14094is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14095Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14096instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14097function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14098&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14099
14100.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14101.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14102Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14103run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14104using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14105connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14106.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14107&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14108activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14109that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14110etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14111to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14112
14113On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14114disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14115option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14116and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14117IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14118
14119
14120
14121.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14122The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14123.code
14124daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14125local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14126.endd
14127This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14128Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14129the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14130read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14131
14132To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14133.code
14134daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14135.endd
14136(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14137.code
14138local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14139 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14140.endd
14141To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14142IPv4 loopback address only:
14143.code
14144local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14145.endd
14146To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14147.code
14148local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14149.endd
14150&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14151
14152
14153
14154.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14155The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14156whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14157addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14158treated as local.
14159
14160For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14161the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14162available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14163(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14164
14165Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14166many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14167email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14168interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14169&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14170&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14171used for listening. Consider this example:
14172.code
14173local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14174 192.168.53.235 ; \
14175 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14176
14177extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14178.endd
14179The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14180address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14181Exim is routing.
14182
14183In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14184address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14185desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14186these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14187This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14188during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14189host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14190addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14191
14192
14193
14194.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14195Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14196allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14197there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14198&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14199description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14200details.
14201
14202
14203
14204
14205. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14206. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14207
14208.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14209.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14210.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14211The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14212
14213.ilist
14214Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14215&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14216.next
14217Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14218&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14219section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14220.next
14221Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14222(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14223&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14224only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14225settings.
14226.endlist
14227
14228This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14229types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14230in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14231are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14232an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14233listed in more than one group.
14234
14235.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14236.table2
14237.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14238.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14239.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14240.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14241.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14242.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14243.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14244.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14245.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14246.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14247.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14248.endtable
14249
14250
14251.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14252.table2
14253.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14254.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14255.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14256.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14257.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14258.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14259.endtable
14260
14261
14262
14263.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14264.table2
14265.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14266.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14267.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14268.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14269.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14270.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14271.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14272.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14273.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14274.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14275.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14276.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14277.endtable
14278
14279
14280
14281.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14282.table2
14283.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14284.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14285.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14286.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14287.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14288.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14289.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14290.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14291.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14292.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14293.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14294.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14295.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14296.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14297.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14298.endtable
14299
14300
14301
14302.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14303.table2
14304.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14305.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14306.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14307.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14308.endtable
14309
14310
14311
14312.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14313.table2
14314.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14315.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14316.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14317.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14318.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14319.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14320.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14321.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14322.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14323.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14324.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14325.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14326.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14327.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14328.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14329.endtable
14330
14331
14332
14333.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14334.table2
14335.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14336.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14337.endtable
14338
14339
14340
14341.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14342.table2
14343.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14344.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14345.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14346.endtable
14347
14348
14349
14350.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14351.table2
14352.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14353.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14354.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14355.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14356.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14357.row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14358.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14359.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14360.endtable
14361
14362
14363
14364.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14365.table2
14366.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14367.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14368.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14369.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14370.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14371.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14372.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14373.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14374.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14375.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14376.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14377.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14378.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14379.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14380.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14381.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14382 connection"
14383.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14384.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14385.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14386.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14387.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14388.endtable
14389
14390
14391
14392.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14393.table2
14394.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14395.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14396.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14397.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14398.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14399.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14400.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14401.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14402.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14403.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14404.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14405.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14406.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14407.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14408.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14409.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14410.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14411.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14412.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14413.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14414.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14415.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14416 words""&"
14417.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14418.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14419.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14420.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14421.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14422.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14423.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14424.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14425.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14426.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14427.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14428.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14429.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14430.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14431.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14432.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14433.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14434.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14435.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14436.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14437.endtable
14438
14439
14440
14441.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14442.table2
14443.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14444 item"
14445.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14446 item"
14447.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14448.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14449.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14450.endtable
14451
14452
14453
14454.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14455.table2
14456.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14457.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14458.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14459.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14460.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14461.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14462.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14463.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14464.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14465.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14466.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14467.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14468.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14469.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14470.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14471.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14472.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14473.endtable
14474
14475
14476
14477.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14478.table2
14479.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14480.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14481.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14482.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14483.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14484.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14485.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14486.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14487.endtable
14488
14489
14490
14491.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14492.table2
14493.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14494.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14495.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14496.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14497.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14498.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14499.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14500.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14501.endtable
14502
14503
14504
14505
14506.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14507.table2
14508.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14509.endtable
14510
14511
14512
14513
14514
14515.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14516See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14517
14518.table2
14519.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14520.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14521.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14522.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14523.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14524.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14525.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14526.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14527.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14528.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14529.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14530.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14531.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14532.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14533.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14534.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14535.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14536 connection"
14537.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14538.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14539.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14540.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14541.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14542.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14543.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14544.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14545.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14546.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14547.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14548.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14549.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14550.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14551.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14552.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14553.endtable
14554
14555
14556
14557.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14558.table2
14559.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14560.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14561.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14562.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14563.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14564.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14565.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14566.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14567.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14568.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14569.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14570.endtable
14571
14572
14573
14574.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14575.table2
14576.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14577.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14578.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14579.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14580 words""&"
14581.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14582.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14583.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14584.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14585.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14586.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14587.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14588.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14589.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14590.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14591.endtable
14592
14593
14594
14595.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14596.table2
14597.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14598.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14599 directory"
14600.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14601.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14602.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14603.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14604.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14605.endtable
14606
14607
14608
14609.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14610.table2
14611.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14612.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14613.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14614.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14615.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14616.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14617.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14618.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14619.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14620.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14621.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14622.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14623.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14624.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14625.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14626.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14627.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14628.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14629.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14630.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14631.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14632.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14633.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14634.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14635.endtable
14636
14637
14638
14639.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14640.table2
14641.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14642.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14643.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14644.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14645.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14646.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14647.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14648.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14649.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14650.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14651.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14652.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14653.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14654.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14655.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14656.endtable
14657
14658
14659
14660.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14661Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14662&dagger;.
14663
14664.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14665.cindex "8BITMIME"
14666.cindex "8-bit characters"
14667.cindex "log" "selectors"
14668.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14669This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14670EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14671However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14672takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14673
14674Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14675feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14676It now defaults to true.
14677A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14678.display
14679&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14680.endd
14681
14682To log received 8BITMIME status use
14683.code
14684log_selector = +8bitmime
14685.endd
14686
14687.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14688.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14689.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14690This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14691read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14692further details.
14693
14694.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14695This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14696messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14697SMTP messages.
14698
14699.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14700.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14701.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14702This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14703non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14704
14705.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14706.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14707.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14708This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14709received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14710
14711.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14712.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14713This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14714See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14715
14716.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14717.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14718This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14719processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14720acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14721
14722.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14723.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14724.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14725.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14726.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14727This option defines the ACL that,
14728if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14729is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14730processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14731acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14732
14733.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14734.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14735This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14736(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14737of a received message.
14738See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14739
14740.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14741.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14742This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14743received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14744
14745.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14746.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14747This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14748received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14749
14750.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14751.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14752.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14753This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14754command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14755
14756
14757.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14758.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14759This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14760received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14761
14762.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14763.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14764This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14765a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14766&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14767
14768.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14769.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14770This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14771extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14772section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14773
14774.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14775.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14776This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14777ends without a QUIT command being received.
14778See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14779
14780.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14781This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14782received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14783further details.
14784
14785.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14786.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14787This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14788received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14789
14790.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14791.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14792This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14793received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14794
14795.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14796.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14797This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14798received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14799
14800.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14801.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14802This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14803received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14804
14805.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14806.cindex "environment" "set values"
14807This option adds individual environment variables that the
14808currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14809Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14810
14811See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14812
14813.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14814.cindex "admin user"
14815This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14816current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14817colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14818programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14819admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14820not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14821To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14822
14823.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14824.cindex "domain literal"
14825If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14826email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14827format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14828has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14829
14830Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14831format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14832addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14833&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14834domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14835configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14836the local host's IP addresses.
14837
14838
14839.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14840.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14841It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14842and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14843MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14844that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14845practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14846&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14847recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14848
14849.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14850.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14851.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14852Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14853camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14854that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14855This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14856
14857If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14858UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14859letters, digits, and hyphens.
14860
14861If Exim is built with internationalization support
14862and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14863this option can be left as default.
14864Without that,
14865if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14866adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14867suitable setting is:
14868.code
14869dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14870 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14871.endd
14872Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14873.code
14874dns_check_names_pattern =
14875.endd
14876That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14877
14878
14879.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14880.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14881.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14882If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14883response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14884Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14885Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14886advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14887authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14888&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14889authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14890
14891Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14892and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14893not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14894authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14895to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14896which Exim advertises AUTH.
14897
14898.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14899If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14900is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14901option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14902.code
14903auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14904.endd
14905.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14906If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14907the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14908expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14909
14910
14911.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14912.cindex "thawing messages"
14913.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14914If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14915new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14916this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14917being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14918saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14919
14920&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14921&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14922thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14923
14924
14925.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14926This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14927It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14928.code
14929sophie:/var/run/sophie
14930.endd
14931If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14932before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14933
14934
14935.option bi_command main string unset
14936.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14937This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14938the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14939just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14940required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14941
14942
14943.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14944.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14945.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14946This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14947for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14948chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14949
14950
14951.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14952When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14953message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14954delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14955
14956.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14957.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14958This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14959bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14960causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14961value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14962message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14963error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14964point at which the error was detected are returned.
14965.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14966
14967.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14968.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14969.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14970.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14971This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14972that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14973when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14974The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14975If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14976treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14977
14978The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14979during reception of a message.
14980In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14981
14982The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14983
14984
14985.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14986If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14987bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14988&%bounce_return_body%&.
14989
14990
14991.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14992.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14993.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14994.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14995This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14996senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14997limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14998any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14999that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15000
15001When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15002greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15003added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15004to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15005size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15006messages.
15007
15008.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15009.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15010.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15011.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15012This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15013bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15014connection. A typical setting might be:
15015.code
15016bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15017.endd
15018which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15019.code
15020MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15021.endd
15022The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15023address.
15024
15025.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15026.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15027.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15028This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15029domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15030section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15031
15032
15033.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15034This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15035domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15036section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15037
15038
15039.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15040This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15041address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15042section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15043
15044
15045.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15046This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15047address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15048section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15049
15050
15051.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15052This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15053callout verification. The default value is
15054.code
15055$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15056.endd
15057See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15058
15059
15060.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15061See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15062
15063
15064.option check_log_space main integer 10M
15065See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15066
15067.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15068.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15069.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15070RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15071system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15072word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15073multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15074exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15075of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15076set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15077
15078
15079.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15080See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15081
15082
15083.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15084.cindex "checking disk space"
15085.cindex "disk space, checking"
15086.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15087The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15088message is accepted.
15089
15090.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15091.vindex "&$log_space$&"
15092.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15093.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15094When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15095want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15096testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15097&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15098
15099
15100&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15101either value is greater than zero, for example:
15102.code
15103check_spool_space = 100M
15104check_spool_inodes = 100
15105.endd
15106The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15107SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15108transit.
15109
15110&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15111files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15112&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15113
15114If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15115incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15116error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15117SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15118&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15119&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15120
15121The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15122number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15123If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15124
15125For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15126failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15127it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15128
15129There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15130Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15131high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15132may wish to deliberately disable them.
15133
15134.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15135.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15136.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15137The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15138these hosts.
15139Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15140
15141.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15142.cindex "restricting access to features"
15143This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15144administrative user.
15145This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15146
15147.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15148.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15149.cindex memory debugging
15150This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15151management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15152it should normally be left as default.
15153
15154.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15155.cindex "port" "for daemon"
15156.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15157This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15158listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15159backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15160
15161.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15162.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15163This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15164the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15165(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15166defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15167&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15168
15169.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15170See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15171
15172.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15173.cindex "warning of delay"
15174.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15175.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15176When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15177intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15178after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15179string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15180message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15181between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15182with
15183.code
15184delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15185.endd
15186the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15187the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15188because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15189just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15190.code
15191delay_warning = 6h
15192.endd
15193messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15194a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15195.code
15196delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15197.endd
15198Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15199which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15200Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15201
15202.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15203.vindex "&$domain$&"
15204The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15205deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15206expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15207forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15208&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15209not sent. The default is:
15210.code
15211delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15212 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15213 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15214 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15215 } {no}{yes}}
15216.endd
15217This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15218&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15219&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15220&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15221
15222.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15223.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15224.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15225If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15226delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15227the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15228of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15229chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15230
15231.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15232.cindex "load average"
15233.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15234When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15235becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15236ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15237See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15238
15239
15240.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15241.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15242Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15243message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15244handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15245should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15246removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15247occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15248
15249.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15250.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15251This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15252ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15253a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15254build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15255really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15256distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15257
15258When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15259updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15260such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15261Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15262
15263
15264.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15265.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15266If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15267activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15268that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15269etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15270to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15271
15272
15273.new
15274.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15275.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15276This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15277.wen
15278and an order of processing.
15279Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15280
15281Acceptable values include:
15282.code
15283sha1
15284sha256
15285sha512
15286.endd
15287
15288Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15289
15290.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15291This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15292and an order of processing.
15293Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15294
15295.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15296If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15297first success.
15298
15299.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15300.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15301This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15302It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15303the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15304See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15305
15306
15307.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15308.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15309DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15310&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15311keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15312incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15313may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15314anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15315This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15316by a setting such as this:
15317.code
15318dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15319.endd
15320This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15321&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15322since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15323&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15324when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15325options are applied after this global option.
15326
15327.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15328.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15329When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15330names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15331the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15332contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15333a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15334done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15335value of this option. The default pattern is
15336.code
15337dns_check_names_pattern = \
15338 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15339.endd
15340which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15341they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15342permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15343accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15344&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15345empty string.
15346
15347.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15348This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15349DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15350
15351.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15352This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15353reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15354section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15355
15356.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15357.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15358This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15359not do it internally.
15360As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15361If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15362
15363The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15364thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15365given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15366
15367
15368.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15369.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15370.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15371If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15372DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15373default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15374
15375If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15376
15377
15378.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15379.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15380.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15381.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15382When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15383looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15384(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15385domain matches this list.
15386
15387This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15388not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15389servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15390Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15391this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15392only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15393
15394
15395.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15396.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15397.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15398.cindex "DNS" timeout
15399The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15400retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15401defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15402time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15403totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15404take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15405parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15406but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15407to set in them.
15408See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15409
15410
15411.option dns_retry main integer 0
15412See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15413
15414
15415.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15416.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15417.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15418If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15419(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15420DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15421match with this expanded domain list.
15422
15423Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15424authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15425bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15426mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15427Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15428a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15429
15430Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15431to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15432zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15433
15434If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15435in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15436authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15437authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15438record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15439
15440.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15441.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15442.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15443.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15444.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15445If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15446DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15447the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15448on.
15449
15450If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15451
15452OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15453means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15454is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15455
15456
15457.option drop_cr main boolean false
15458This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15459handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15460described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15461
15462.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15463.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15464.cindex "DSN" "success"
15465.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15466DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15467and accepted from, these hosts.
15468Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15469and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15470A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15471A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15472are sent.
15473
15474.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15475.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15476.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15477This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15478bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15479Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15480.code
15481dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15482.endd
15483The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15484panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15485
15486.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15487.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15488Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15489message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15490handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15491message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15492be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15493the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15494delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15495
15496
15497.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15498.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15499.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15500Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15501generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15502coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15503items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15504a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15505must be enclosed in double quotes.
15506
15507Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15508(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15509the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15510items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15511are examined. For example:
15512.code
15513errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15514 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15515 postmaster@mydomain.example
15516.endd
15517.vindex "&$domain$&"
15518.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15519The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15520and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15521there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15522.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15523variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15524
15525
15526.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15527.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15528By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15529.display
15530&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15531.endd
15532.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15533where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15534A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15535&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15536overrides the default.
15537
15538Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15539&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15540and warning messages. For example:
15541.code
15542errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15543.endd
15544The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15545address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15546&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15547own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15548not used.
15549
15550
15551.option event_action main string&!! unset
15552.cindex events
15553This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15554For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15555
15556
15557.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15558.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15559.cindex "Exim group"
15560This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15561privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15562option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15563of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15564configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15565security issues.
15566
15567
15568.option exim_path main string "see below"
15569.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15570This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15571needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15572the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15573is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15574other place.
15575&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15576you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15577where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15578settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15579
15580
15581.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15582.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15583.cindex "Exim user"
15584This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15585privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15586time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15587options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15588
15589Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15590&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15591not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15592used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15593
15594
15595.option exim_version main string "current version"
15596.cindex "Exim version"
15597.cindex customizing "version number"
15598.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15599This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15600various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15601
15602
15603.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15604This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15605routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15606&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15607
15608
15609. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15610. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15611
15612.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15613 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15614.oindex "&%-t%&"
15615.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15616.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15617According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15618are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15619envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15620line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15621behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15622command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15623&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15624argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15625addresses.
15626
15627
15628.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15629.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15630On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15631distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15632related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15633Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15634errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15635many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15636retries.
15637
15638.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15639You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15640a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15641search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15642
15643
15644
15645.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15646.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15647On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15648ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15649delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15650&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15651feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15652warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15653freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15654is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15655supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15656message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15657freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15658log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15659logging that you require.
15660
15661
15662.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15663.cindex "HP-UX"
15664.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15665Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15666password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15667looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15668headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15669of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15670it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15671upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15672
15673When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15674expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15675login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15676user's name.
15677
15678.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15679Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15680pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15681name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15682.code
15683gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15684gecos_name = $1
15685.endd
15686
15687.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15688See &%gecos_name%& above.
15689
15690
15691.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15692This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15693server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15694implementations of TLS.
15695
15696
15697.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15698This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15699the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15700
15701See
15702&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15703for documentation.
15704
15705
15706
15707.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15708This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15709&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15710default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15711ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15712insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15713
15714
15715
15716.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15717.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15718.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15719This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15720section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15721&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15722sections are rejected.
15723
15724
15725.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15726.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15727.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15728This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15729all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15730header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15731zero means &"no limit"&.
15732
15733
15734
15735
15736.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15737.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15738.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15739Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15740mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15741some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15742this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15743if you want to do semantic checking.
15744See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15745set.
15746
15747
15748.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15749.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15750.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15751.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15752This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15753all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15754hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15755.code
15756helo_allow_chars = _
15757.endd
15758Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15759
15760
15761.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15762.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15763.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15764If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15765list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15766default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15767its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15768do.
15769
15770
15771.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15772.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15773.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15774By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15775&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15776to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15777condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15778Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15779to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15780necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15781encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15782Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15783
15784When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15785&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15786EHLO command either:
15787
15788.ilist
15789is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15790.next
15791.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15792.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15793matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15794calling host address, or
15795.next
15796when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15797.endlist
15798
15799However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15800fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15801be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15802
15803If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15804.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15805&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15806
15807.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15808.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15809.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15810Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15811backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15812name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15813&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15814rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15815If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15816error.
15817
15818.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15819.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15820.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15821This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15822manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15823&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15824verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15825item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15826it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15827
15828This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15829delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15830configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15831domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15832&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15833
15834A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15835messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15836time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15837retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15838
15839
15840.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15841.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15842Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15843is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15844&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15845option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15846default configuration file contains
15847.code
15848host_lookup = *
15849.endd
15850which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15851is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15852
15853After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15854has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15855this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15856
15857.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15858.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15859After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15860unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15861&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15862&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15863
15864
15865.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15866This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15867to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15868first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15869if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15870if you want.
15871
15872&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15873multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15874&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15875case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15876
15877
15878
15879.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15880.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15881If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15882as soon as the connection is made.
15883This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15884nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15885connections immediately.
15886
15887The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15888ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15889sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15890incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15891chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15892
15893
15894.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15895.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15896This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15897happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15898you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15899127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15900the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15901list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15902local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15903.code
15904hosts_connection_nolog = :
15905.endd
15906If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15907
15908
15909
15910.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15911.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15912This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15913connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15914
15915
15916.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15917.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15918.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15919If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15920if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15921records
15922or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15923host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15924
15925This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15926&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15927section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15928&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15929that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15930chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15931interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15932
15933
15934.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15935.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15936This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15937to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15938The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15939
15940
15941
15942.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15943.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15944.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15945This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15946that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15947suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15948
15949After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15950because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15951message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15952the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15953again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15954bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15955for frozen messages. For example,
15956.code
15957ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15958.endd
15959retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15960failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15961failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15962value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15963dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15964&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15965
15966
15967.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15968.cindex "&""From""& line"
15969.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15970Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15971the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15972message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15973such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15974match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15975process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15976&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15977
15978
15979.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15980See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15981
15982.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15983.cindex "environment" "values from"
15984This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15985You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15986these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15987during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15988installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15989environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15990external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15991
15992Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15993(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15994
15995WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15996FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15997unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15998that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15999
16000Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16001&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16002current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16003anymore.
16004
16005See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16006environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16007transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16008details.
16009
16010
16011.option keep_malformed main time 4d
16012This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16013have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16014next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16015logged.
16016
16017
16018.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16019.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16020.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16021This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16022a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16023While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16024Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16025and constrained to be a directory.
16026
16027
16028.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16029.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16030.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16031This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16032a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16033While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16034Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16035and constrained to be a file.
16036
16037
16038.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16039.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16040.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16041This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16042Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16043Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16044
16045
16046.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16047.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16048.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16049This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16050to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16051Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16052identity to be proven.
16053
16054
16055.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16056.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16057This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16058the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16059cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16060
16061
16062.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16063.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16064This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16065LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16066details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16067with LDAP support.
16068
16069
16070.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16071.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16072This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16073A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16074See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16075Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16076to hard/demand.
16077
16078
16079.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16080.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16081If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16082connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16083"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16084of SSL-on-connect.
16085In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16086by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16087This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16088
16089
16090.option ldap_version main integer unset
16091.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16092This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16093LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16094-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16095the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16096has been built with LDAP support.
16097
16098
16099
16100.option local_from_check main boolean true
16101.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16102.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16103When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16104an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16105checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16106the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16107
16108&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16109locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16110&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16111
16112You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16113on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16114&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16115and the default qualify domain.
16116
16117If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16118and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16119&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16120&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16121
16122.cindex "envelope from"
16123.cindex "envelope sender"
16124These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16125is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16126&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16127
16128For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16129request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16130has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16131
16132
16133
16134
16135.option local_from_prefix main string unset
16136When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16137matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16138ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16139done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16140appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16141&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16142example, if
16143.code
16144local_from_prefix = *-
16145.endd
16146is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16147.code
16148From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16149.endd
16150will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16151matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16152qualify domain.
16153
16154
16155.option local_from_suffix main string unset
16156See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16157
16158
16159.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16160This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16161listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16162&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16163options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16164&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16165&%local_interfaces%& is
16166.code
16167local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16168.endd
16169when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16170.code
16171local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16172.endd
16173
16174.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16175.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16176.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16177This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16178&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16179the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16180message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16181non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16182
16183
16184
16185.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16186.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16187When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16188an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16189do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16190also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16191See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16192&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16193
16194
16195
16196
16197.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16198.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16199.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16200.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16201Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16202uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16203value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16204after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16205host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16206range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16207systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16208&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16209characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16210time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16211section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16212
16213
16214
16215.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16216.cindex "log" "file path for"
16217This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16218files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16219when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16220name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16221or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16222they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16223A path must start with a slash.
16224To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16225Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16226section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16227used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16228variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16229configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16230&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16231early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16232
16233
16234.option log_selector main string unset
16235.cindex "log" "selectors"
16236This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16237writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16238minus characters. For example:
16239.code
16240log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16241.endd
16242A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16243logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16244
16245
16246.option log_timezone main boolean false
16247.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16248.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16249.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16250By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16251timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16252in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16253avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16254&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16255timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16256of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16257&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16258another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16259
16260
16261.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16262.cindex "too many open files"
16263.cindex "open files, too many"
16264.cindex "file" "too many open"
16265.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16266.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16267This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16268lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16269Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16270file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16271recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16272actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16273as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16274open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16275&%lookup_open_max%&.
16276
16277
16278.option max_username_length main integer 0
16279.cindex "length of login name"
16280.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16281.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16282Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16283&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16284this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16285an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16286
16287
16288.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16289.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16290.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16291.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16292.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16293By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16294the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16295option is set true, this no longer happens.
16296
16297
16298.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16299.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16300.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16301.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16302.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16303This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16304&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16305
16306
16307.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16308.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16309If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16310(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16311locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16312means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16313Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16314Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16315replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16316empty string, the option is ignored.
16317
16318
16319.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16320If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16321the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16322message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16323take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16324the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16325it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16326yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16327before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16328that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16329means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16330colons will become hyphens.
16331
16332
16333.option message_logs main boolean true
16334.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16335.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16336If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16337&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16338Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16339minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16340per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16341which is not affected by this option.
16342
16343
16344.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16345.cindex "message" "size limit"
16346.cindex "limit" "message size"
16347.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16348This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16349value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16350to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16351TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16352optionally followed by K or M.
16353
16354&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16355other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16356the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16357error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16358&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16359
16360Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16361exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16362failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16363an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16364the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16365message that an individual transport can process.
16366
16367If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16368maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16369failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16370virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16371probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16372default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16373some problems may result.
16374
16375A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16376SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16377SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16378
16379
16380.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16381.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16382This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16383.code
16384SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16385.endd
16386in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16387moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16388and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16389standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16390lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16391
16392
16393.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16394Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16395it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16396contains a full description of this facility.
16397
16398
16399
16400.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16401.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16402This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16403be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16404option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16405
16406
16407.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16408This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16409message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16410recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16411It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16412safety precaution.
16413
16414When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16415list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16416the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16417contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16418can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16419
16420If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16421&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16422example is
16423.code
16424never_users = root:daemon:bin
16425.endd
16426Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16427harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16428transport driver.
16429
16430
16431.new
16432.option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16433This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16434listens for work and information-requests.
16435Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16436should need to modify the default.
16437
16438The option is expanded before use.
16439If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16440is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16441Otherwise, it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16442to Exim.
16443
16444If the Exim command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&
16445then a notifier socket is not created.
16446.wen
16447
16448
16449.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16450.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16451This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16452by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16453each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16454
16455This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16456available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16457The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16458the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16459list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16460&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16461names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16462
16463Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16464SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16465yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16466adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16467invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16468
16469The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16470
16471Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16472"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16473with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16474some now infamous attacks.
16475
16476Examples:
16477.code
16478# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16479openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16480 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16481
16482# Disable older protocol versions:
16483openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16484.endd
16485
16486Possible options may include:
16487.ilist
16488&`all`&
16489.next
16490&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16491.next
16492&`cipher_server_preference`&
16493.next
16494&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16495.next
16496&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16497.next
16498&`legacy_server_connect`&
16499.next
16500&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16501.next
16502&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16503.next
16504&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16505.next
16506&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16507.next
16508&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16509.next
16510&`no_compression`&
16511.next
16512&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16513.next
16514&`no_sslv2`&
16515.next
16516&`no_sslv3`&
16517.next
16518&`no_ticket`&
16519.next
16520&`no_tlsv1`&
16521.next
16522&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16523.next
16524&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16525.next
16526&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16527.next
16528&`single_dh_use`&
16529.next
16530&`single_ecdh_use`&
16531.next
16532&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16533.next
16534&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16535.next
16536&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16537.next
16538&`tls_d5_bug`&
16539.next
16540&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16541.endlist
16542
16543As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16544all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16545to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16546to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16547release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16548where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16549
16550
16551.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16552.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16553This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16554to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16555The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16556
16557
16558.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16559.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16560.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16561.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16562The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16563percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16564replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16565also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16566option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16567but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16568an ACL.
16569
16570&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16571trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16572if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16573implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16574routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16575a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16576local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16577
16578
16579.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16580.cindex "Perl"
16581This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16582interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16583
16584
16585.option perl_startup main string unset
16586.cindex "Perl"
16587This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16588interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16589
16590.option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16591.cindex "Perl"
16592This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16593
16594
16595.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16596.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16597This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16598data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16599&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16600PostgreSQL support.
16601
16602
16603.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16604.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16605.cindex "pid file, path for"
16606This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16607process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16608to the host name:
16609.code
16610pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16611.endd
16612If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16613spool directory.
16614The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16615option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16616of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16617
16618
16619.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16620.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16621This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16622PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16623control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16624&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16625for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16626that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16627not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16628
16629.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16630.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16631.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16632If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16633this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16634and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16635commands are acceptable.
16636When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16637
16638See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16639
16640Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16641
16642
16643.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16644.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16645This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16646to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16647If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16648If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16649an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16650is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16651
16652.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16653.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16654If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16655completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16656called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16657purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16658volume of mail. Use with care!
16659
16660
16661.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16662.cindex "name" "of local host"
16663.cindex "host" "name of local"
16664.cindex "local host" "name of"
16665.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16666This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16667HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16668option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16669The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16670server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16671
16672If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16673name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16674contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16675&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16676version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16677explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16678
16679
16680.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16681.cindex "printing characters"
16682.cindex "8-bit characters"
16683By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1668432&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16685when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16686sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16687is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16688characters.
16689
16690This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16691&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16692the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16693described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16694Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16695standards.
16696
16697
16698.option process_log_path main string unset
16699.cindex "process log path"
16700.cindex "log" "process log"
16701.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16702This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16703&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16704utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16705in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16706can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16707different spool directories.
16708
16709
16710.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16711.cindex "restricting access to features"
16712.oindex "&%-M%&"
16713.oindex "&%-R%&"
16714.oindex "&%-q%&"
16715The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16716admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16717&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16718
16719
16720.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16721.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16722.cindex "address" "qualification"
16723This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16724addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16725recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16726are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16727also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16728locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16729
16730Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16731unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16732&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16733addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16734necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16735addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16736&%primary_hostname%& value.
16737
16738
16739.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16740This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16741addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16742
16743
16744
16745.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16746.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16747.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16748.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16749This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16750A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16751domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16752next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16753
16754
16755.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16756.cindex "restricting access to features"
16757.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16758The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16759queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16760&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16761See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16762
16763
16764.option queue_only main boolean false
16765.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16766.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16767If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16768whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16769next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16770delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16771
16772The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16773and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16774&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16775&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16776
16777
16778.option queue_only_file main string unset
16779.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16780.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16781This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16782one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16783it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16784each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16785For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16786&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16787.code
16788queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16789.endd
16790causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16791&_/some/file_& exists.
16792
16793
16794.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16795.cindex "load average"
16796.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16797.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16798If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16799all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16800happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16801the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16802the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16803false.
16804
16805Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16806option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16807determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16808&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16809
16810
16811.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16812.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16813When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16814because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16815all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16816This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16817threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16818connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16819circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16820where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16821should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16822re-evaluated for each message.
16823
16824
16825.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16826.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16827When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16828setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16829&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16830to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16831
16832
16833.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16834.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16835If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16836in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16837must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16838single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16839and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16840single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16841the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16842avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16843&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16844when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16845large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16846
16847
16848
16849.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16850.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16851This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16852can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16853but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16854start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16855very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16856however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16857started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16858
16859Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16860the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16861run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16862the daemon's command line.
16863
16864.cindex queues named
16865.cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
16866To set limits for different named queues use
16867an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16868
16869.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16870.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16871.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16872.cindex "first pass routing"
16873When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16874received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16875However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16876&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16877message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16878has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16879when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16880over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16881SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16882&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16883&%queue_domains%&.
16884
16885
16886.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16887.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16888This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16889maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16890the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16891&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16892controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16893
16894.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16895.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16896.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16897This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16898added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16899on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16900used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16901added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16902&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16903header lines.
16904The default setting is:
16905
16906.code
16907received_header_text = Received: \
16908 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16909 {${if def:sender_ident \
16910 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16911 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16912 by $primary_hostname \
16913 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16914 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16915 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16916 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16917 ${if def:sender_address \
16918 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16919 id $message_exim_id\
16920 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16921.endd
16922
16923The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16924support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16925locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16926header lines such as the following:
16927.code
16928Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16929by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16930(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16931id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16932for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16933Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16934id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16935.endd
16936Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16937the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16938checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16939message was accepted.
16940
16941
16942.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16943.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16944.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16945.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16946When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16947counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16948have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16949This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16950
16951
16952.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16953.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16954.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16955This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16956recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16957qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16958affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16959addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16960host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16961or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16962option was not set.
16963
16964
16965.option recipients_max main integer 0
16966.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16967.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16968If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16969original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16970by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16971all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16972Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16973done.
16974
16975.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16976&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16977RCPT commands in a single message.
16978
16979
16980.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16981If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16982recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16983error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16984error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16985initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16986for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16987
16988
16989.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16990.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16991This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16992hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16993does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16994message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16995have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16996deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16997deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16998each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16999same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17000&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17001with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17002tagged with its process id.
17003
17004This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17005message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17006manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17007deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17008is received.
17009
17010.cindex "number of deliveries"
17011.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17012If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17013need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17014are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17015daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17016fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17017runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17018delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17019then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17020&%remote_max_parallel%&.
17021
17022If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17023&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17024doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17025host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17026
17027
17028.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17029.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17030.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17031When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17032domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17033.code
17034remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17035.endd
17036would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17037then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17038
17039
17040.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17041.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17042This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17043database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17044host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17045past failures.
17046
17047
17048.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17049.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17050.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17051Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17052intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17053straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17054retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17055the default value.
17056
17057
17058.option return_path_remove main boolean true
17059.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17060RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17061&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17062The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17063MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17064in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17065&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17066received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17067the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17068
17069
17070.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17071This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17072
17073
17074.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17075.cindex "RFC 1413"
17076.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17077RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17078an item in the list.
17079The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17080for the system.
17081
17082.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17083.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17084.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17085This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17086no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17087
17088
17089.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17090.cindex "unqualified addresses"
17091.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17092This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17093sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17094&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17095not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17096it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17097&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17098using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17099
17100
17101.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17102.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17103.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17104This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17105If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17106and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17107Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17108
17109
17110
17111.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17112.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17113This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17114TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17115connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17116other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17117still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17118this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17119connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17120tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17121hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17122
17123
17124
17125.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17126.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17127.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17128.cindex "inetd"
17129This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17130that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17131control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17132value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17133non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17134set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17135
17136A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17137has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17138that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17139and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17140
17141
17142.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17143.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17144.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17145Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17146the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17147check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17148client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17149client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17150
17151When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17152allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17153but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17154or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17155starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17156counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17157following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17158MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17159
17160
17161.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17162You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17163check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17164changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17165live with.
17166
17167
17168. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17169. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17170. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17171. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17172. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17173. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17174. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17175. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17176. the option name to split.
17177
17178.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17179 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17180.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17181.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17182The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17183prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17184results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17185response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17186precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17187seen).
17188
17189
17190.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17191.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17192.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17193This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17194host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17195expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17196reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17197connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17198is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17199of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17200required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17201
17202&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17203constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17204happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17205without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17206could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17207doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17208
17209
17210
17211.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17212.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17213.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17214.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17215If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17216listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17217in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17218fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17219subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17220to all messages received in the same connection.
17221
17222A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17223if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17224also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17225various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17226
17227
17228. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17229
17230.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17231 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17232.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17233.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17234This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17235automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17236the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17237and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17238number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17239are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17240restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17241systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17242dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17243
17244
17245.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17246.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17247.cindex "host" "reserved"
17248When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17249number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17250that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17251&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17252restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17253of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17254of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17255the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17256individual host.
17257
17258For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17259set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17260connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17261provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17262
17263
17264.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17265.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17266.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17267.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17268This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17269several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17270is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17271responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17272incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17273
17274.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17275The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17276is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17277in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17278
17279If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17280expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17281used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17282panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17283value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17284For example:
17285.code
17286smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17287 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17288.endd
17289
17290Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17291messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17292verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17293&%helo_data%& value.
17294
17295.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17296.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17297.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17298.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17299.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17300This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17301positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17302.code
17303smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17304 $version_number $tod_full
17305.endd
17306Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17307multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17308appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17309in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17310multiline response).
17311
17312
17313.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17314.cindex "checking disk space"
17315.cindex "disk space, checking"
17316.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17317When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17318option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17319spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17320leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17321is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17322
17323
17324.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17325.cindex "connection backlog"
17326.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17327.cindex "backlog of connections"
17328This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17329this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17330of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17331attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17332say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17333out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17334value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17335attacks by SYN flooding.
17336
17337
17338.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17339.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17340.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17341The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17342the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17343synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17344fewer, but they still exist.
17345
17346Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17347for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17348client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17349SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17350for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17351input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17352does detect many instances.
17353
17354The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17355If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17356hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17357(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17358
17359
17360
17361.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17362.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17363.vindex "&$domain$&"
17364If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17365command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17366chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17367are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17368argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17369example:
17370.code
17371smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17372 $sender_host_address
17373.endd
17374.new
17375If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17376be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17377In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17378if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17379.wen
17380
17381A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17382complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17383run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17384a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17385receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17386the command.
17387
17388
17389.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17390.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17391When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17392one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17393section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17394
17395
17396.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17397.cindex "load average"
17398If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17399accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17400If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17401the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17402systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17403&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17404
17405
17406
17407.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17408.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17409.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17410Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17411particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17412.code
17413RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17414.endd
17415causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17416(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17417example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17418too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17419dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17420
17421.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17422When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17423&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17424Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17425&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17426not count towards the limit.
17427
17428
17429
17430.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17431.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17432.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17433If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17434Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17435that subvert web
17436clients
17437into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17438non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17439
17440
17441
17442.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17443.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17444.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17445.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17446Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17447can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17448recipients.
17449
17450Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17451facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17452&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17453&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17454
17455When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17456&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17457rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17458respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17459values:
17460
17461.ilist
17462A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17463.next
17464An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17465fractional parts are allowed here.
17466.next
17467A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17468.next
17469A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17470because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17471.endlist
17472
17473For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17474first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17475.code
17476smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17477smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17478.endd
17479The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17480two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17481seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17482delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17483
17484
17485.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17486See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17487
17488
17489.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17490See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17491
17492
17493.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17494.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17495.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17496This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17497input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17498data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17499the message is abandoned.
17500A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17501.code
17502SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17503SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17504.endd
17505The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17506means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17507
17508If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17509expanded before use and may depend on
17510&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17511
17512
17513.oindex "&%-os%&"
17514The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17515&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17516this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17517of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17518timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17519
17520
17521.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17522This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17523&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17524
17525
17526.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17527.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17528.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17529In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17530&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17531reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17532to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17533policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17534&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17535example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17536.code
17537550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17538550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17539.endd
17540
17541
17542.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17543.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17544When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17545the availability thereof is advertised in
17546response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17547chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17548
17549
17550.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17551This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17552extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17553See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17554
17555
17556
17557.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17558This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17559See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17560
17561
17562
17563.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17564.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17565.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17566.cindex "directories, multiple"
17567If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17568subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17569sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17570subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17571arrival of the message.
17572
17573Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17574where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17575directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17576directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17577are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17578
17579It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17580changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17581&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17582after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17583automatically deleted.
17584
17585When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17586changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17587trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17588sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17589sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17590spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17591particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17592if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17593entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17594
17595
17596.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17597.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17598This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17599it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17600configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17601string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17602&$primary_hostname$&.
17603
17604If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17605that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17606log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17607Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17608as failures in the configuration file.
17609
17610By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17611tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17612
17613.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17614.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17615If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17616for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17617Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17618Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17619option.
17620
17621The following variables will not have useful values:
17622.code
17623$max_received_linelength
17624$body_linecount
17625$body_zerocount
17626.endd
17627
17628Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17629and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17630(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17631will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17632
17633Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17634(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17635The transmission benefit is maintained.
17636
17637.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17638.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17639This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17640access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17641
17642.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17643.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17644This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17645variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17646is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17647&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17648
17649.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17650.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17651If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17652items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17653treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17654passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17655option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17656
17657
17658.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17659.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17660.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17661If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17662ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17663MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17664domain causes a syntax error.
17665However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17666syntax checking.
17667
17668
17669.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17670.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17671When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17672separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17673be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17674separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17675nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17676particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17677both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17678containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17679Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17680the LOG_ALERT priority.
17681
17682
17683.option syslog_facility main string unset
17684.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17685This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17686syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17687&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17688If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17689details of Exim's logging.
17690
17691
17692.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17693.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17694If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17695omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17696the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17697to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17698into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17699
17700
17701
17702.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17703.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17704This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17705syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17706&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17707
17708
17709
17710.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17711.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17712If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17713omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17714details of Exim's logging.
17715
17716
17717.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17718.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17719.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17720.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17721This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17722the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17723must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17724generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17725appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17726which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17727&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17728A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17729
17730
17731.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17732.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17733This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17734&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17735implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17736During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17737
17738
17739.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17740.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17741This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17742command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17743the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17744
17745.option system_filter_group main string unset
17746.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17747This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17748gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17749with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17750
17751.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17752.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17753.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17754This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17755is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17756contains the pipe command.
17757
17758
17759.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17760.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17761This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17762is used in a system filter.
17763
17764
17765.option system_filter_user main string unset
17766.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17767If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17768delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17769process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17770Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17771is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17772configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17773specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17774&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17775
17776If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17777under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17778transport option overrides.
17779
17780
17781.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17782.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17783.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17784.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17785If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17786TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17787turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17788performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17789should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17790However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17791this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17792daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17793TCP_NODELAY.
17794
17795
17796.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17797.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17798.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17799If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17800message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17801is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17802bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17803sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17804If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17805frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17806
17807&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17808frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17809messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17810
17811
17812.option timezone main string unset
17813.cindex "timezone, setting"
17814.cindex "environment" "values from"
17815The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17816running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17817created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17818to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17819.code
17820timezone = UTC
17821.endd
17822The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17823or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17824is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17825time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17826runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17827unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17828
17829
17830.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17831.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17832.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17833.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17834When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17835of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17836response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17837chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17838Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17839using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17840is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17841
17842
17843.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17844.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17845.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17846The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17847files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17848Commonly only one file is needed.
17849The server's private key is also
17850assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17851&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17852
17853&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17854receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17855use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17856option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17857
17858&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17859separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17860
17861&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17862when a list of more than one
17863file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17864The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17865
17866If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17867if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17868Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17869&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17870
17871If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17872generated for every connection.
17873
17874.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17875.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17876.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17877This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17878be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17879
17880Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17881
17882&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17883for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17884For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17885
17886See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17887
17888
17889.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17890.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17891The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17892the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17893interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17894suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17895
17896The value must be at least 1024.
17897
17898The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17899hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17900by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17901
17902If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17903number.
17904
17905Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17906little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17907larger prime than requested.
17908
17909
17910.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17911.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17912The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17913to be used by Exim.
17914
17915This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17916The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17917
17918&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17919for other TLS library versions,
17920using a filename with site-generated
17921local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17922other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17923"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17924
17925If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17926then it names a file from which DH
17927parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17928PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17929OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17930fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17931loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17932and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17933
17934If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17935loaded by Exim.
17936
17937If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17938Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17939does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17940See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17941
17942If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17943a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17944
17945In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
179462.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17947in IKE is assigned number 23.
17948
17949Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17950of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17951sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17952the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17953&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17954
17955The available standard primes are:
17956&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17957&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17958&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17959&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17960
17961The available additional primes are:
17962&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17963
17964Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17965Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17966The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17967of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17968(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17969
17970At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17971they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17972candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17973
17974The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17975to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17976whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17977tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17978need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17979userbase.
17980
17981Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17982is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17983applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17984used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17985mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17986prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17987acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17988
17989
17990.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17991.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17992This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17993It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17994
17995After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17996&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17997for valid selections.
17998
17999For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18000&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18001&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18002
18003If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
18004
18005
18006.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18007.cindex TLS "certificate status"
18008.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18009This option
18010must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18011status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18012Certificate Authority.
18013
18014Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18015The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18016
18017For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18018for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18019of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18020The ordering of the two lists must match.
18021The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18022
18023The file(s) should be in DER format,
18024except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18025or for OpenSSL,
18026when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18027The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18028a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18029files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18030If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18031(this only works under TLS1.3)
18032they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18033
18034Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18035PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18036TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18037although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18038
18039.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18040.cindex SSMTP
18041.cindex SMTPS
18042This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18043operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18044set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18045further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18046
18047
18048
18049.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
18050.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18051The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18052files which contains the server's private keys.
18053If this option is unset, or if
18054the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18055key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18056&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18057
18058See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18059
18060
18061.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18062.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18063.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18064If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18065&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18066support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18067TLS session.
18068
18069
18070.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18071.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18072.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18073This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18074The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18075connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18076different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18077permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18078in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18079preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18080&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18081
18082
18083.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18084.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18085.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18086See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18087
18088
18089.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18090.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18091.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18092The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18093word "system"
18094or the absolute path to
18095a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18096match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18097
18098The "system" value for the option will use a
18099system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18100This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18101and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18102must be specified.
18103
18104The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18105preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18106
18107With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18108explicitly
18109either by file or directory
18110are added to those given by the system default location.
18111
18112These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18113than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18114the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18115connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18116Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18117use the explicit directory version.
18118
18119See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18120
18121A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18122being unset.
18123
18124
18125.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18126.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18127.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18128This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18129certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18130&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18131either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18132&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18133
18134Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18135&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18136present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18137aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18138the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18139connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18140ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18141
18142A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18143matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18144certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18145abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18146state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18147such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18148but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18149certificate"&.
18150
18151Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18152certificates.
18153
18154
18155.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18156.cindex "trusted groups"
18157.cindex "groups" "trusted"
18158This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18159option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18160which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18161specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18162details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18163&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18164are trusted.
18165
18166.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18167.cindex "trusted users"
18168.cindex "user" "trusted"
18169This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18170option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18171trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18172&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18173If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18174Exim user are trusted.
18175
18176.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18177.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18178.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18179This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18180the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18181gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18182used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18183can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18184is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18185&%-F%& option.
18186
18187.option unknown_username main string unset
18188See &%unknown_login%&.
18189
18190.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18191.cindex "trusted users"
18192.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18193.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18194.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18195.cindex "envelope from"
18196.cindex "envelope sender"
18197When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18198normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18199default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18200senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18201is used) is ignored.
18202
18203However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18204to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18205.code
18206exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18207.endd
18208.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18209The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18210other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18211users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18212patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18213identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18214users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18215followed by a hyphen
18216by a setting like this:
18217.code
18218untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18219.endd
18220If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18221restriction, you can use
18222.code
18223untrusted_set_sender = *
18224.endd
18225The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18226only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18227to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18228parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18229&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18230necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18231overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18232described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18233
18234The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18235&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18236&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18237envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18238sender address.
18239
18240
18241.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18242.cindex "&""From""& line"
18243.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18244Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18245an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18246particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18247of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18248matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18249&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18250default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18251.code
18252From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18253From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18254.endd
18255The pattern can be seen by running
18256.code
18257exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18258.endd
18259It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18260year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18261regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18262&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18263(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18264&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18265
18266
18267.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18268See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18269
18270
18271.option warn_message_file main string unset
18272.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18273.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18274This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18275for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18276been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18277&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18278&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18279
18280
18281.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18282.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18283If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18284See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18285.ecindex IIDconfima
18286.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18287
18288
18289
18290
18291. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18292. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18293
18294.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18295.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18296.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18297This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18298Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18299
18300For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18301&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18302which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18303provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18304&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18305
18306
18307
18308.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18309.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18310The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18311precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18312router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18313&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18314delivery of the address to be deferred.
18315
18316.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18317When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18318accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18319routers, and the eventual transport.
18320
18321&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18322that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18323in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18324either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18325put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18326
18327Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18328with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18329on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18330&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18331&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18332
18333The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18334for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18335you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18336.code
18337uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18338.endd
18339In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18340.code
18341file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18342.endd
18343This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18344lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18345
18346See also the &%set%& option below.
18347
18348.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18349.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18350The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18351from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18352&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18353ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18354verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18355
18356
18357
18358.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18359.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18360.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18361If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18362by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18363your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18364having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18365routing.
18366
18367
18368
18369.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18370.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18371.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18372This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18373routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18374&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18375&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18376value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18377includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18378well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18379you could put:
18380.code
18381cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18382.endd
18383on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18384and
18385.code
18386cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18387.endd
18388on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18389this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18390explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18391logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18392
18393
18394.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18395.cindex "case of local parts"
18396.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18397By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18398manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18399If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18400this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18401part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18402turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18403more details.
18404
18405.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18406.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18407.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18408The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18409router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18410an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18411is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18412addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18413and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18414
18415This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18416recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18417modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18418(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18419
18420
18421
18422.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18423.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18424.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18425.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18426.vindex "&$home$&"
18427When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18428address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18429local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18430than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18431holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18432user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18433preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18434given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18435overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18436the router is skipped.
18437
18438If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18439or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18440setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18441two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18442setting to achieve this. For example:
18443.code
18444local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18445.endd
18446Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18447up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18448&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18449
18450
18451
18452.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18453.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18454This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18455router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18456evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18457result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18458&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18459router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18460
18461If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18462precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18463
18464This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18465All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18466
18467The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18468running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18469the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18470.code
18471condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18472.endd
18473Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18474.code
18475condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18476.endd
18477
18478A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18479.code
18480condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18481condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18482condition = foobar
18483.endd
18484
18485If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18486of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18487be specified using &%condition%&.
18488
18489Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18490are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18491they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18492parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18493ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18494Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18495Router rules processing behavior.
18496
18497This is best illustrated in an example:
18498.code
18499# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18500# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18501
18502$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18503true {yes} {no}}
18504
18505$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18506 {yes} {no}}
18507.endd
18508In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18509&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18510default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18511(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18512string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18513with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18514resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18515&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18516
18517In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18518&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18519mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18520conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18521string characters.
18522
18523Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18524true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18525match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18526contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18527expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18528
18529
18530.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18531.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18532If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18533option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18534the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18535If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18536output, and Exim carries on processing.
18537This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18538so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18539option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18540variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18541&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18542are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18543The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18544
18545
18546
18547.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18548If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18549or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18550unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18551transport option of the same name.
18552
18553.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18554.cindex "MX record" "security"
18555.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18556.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18557.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18558DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18559the dnssec request bit set.
18560This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18561
18562.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18563.cindex "MX record" "security"
18564.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18565.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18566.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18567DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18568the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18569(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18570This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18571
18572
18573.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18574.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18575.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18576If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18577the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18578lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18579expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18580a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18581
18582
18583
18584.option driver routers string unset
18585This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18586to be used.
18587
18588
18589.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18590.cindex "DSN" "success"
18591.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18592If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18593Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18594instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18595Not effective on redirect routers.
18596
18597
18598
18599.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18600.cindex "envelope from"
18601.cindex "envelope sender"
18602.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18603If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18604transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18605there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18606message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18607provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18608expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18609
18610The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18611subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18612settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18613setting.
18614
18615If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18616the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18617address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18618expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18619
18620If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18621SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18622any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18623sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18624settings:
18625.code
18626errors_to =
18627errors_to = ""
18628.endd
18629An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18630this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18631no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18632address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18633overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18634
18635.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18636If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18637MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18638path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18639setting &%return_path%&.
18640
18641The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18642manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18643implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18644
18645
18646
18647.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18648.cindex "address" "testing"
18649.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18650.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18651.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18652If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18653as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18654want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18655on for the system alias file.
18656See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18657are evaluated.
18658
18659The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18660&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18661an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18662
18663
18664
18665.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18666.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18667Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18668&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18669
18670
18671
18672.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18673If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18674verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18675
18676
18677
18678.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18679If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18680verifying a sender, verification fails.
18681
18682
18683
18684.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18685.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18686.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18687String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18688colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18689changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18690each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18691defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18692&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18693
18694If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18695associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18696list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18697randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18698transport for further details.
18699
18700
18701.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18702.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18703.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18704.cindex "transport" "local"
18705.cindex "router" "setting group"
18706When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18707specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18708process.
18709The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18710error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18711The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18712is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18713and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18714
18715
18716
18717.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18718.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18719.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18720This option specifies a list of text headers,
18721newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18722that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18723Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18724option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18725the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18726&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18727message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18728header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18729&"see"& the added header lines.
18730
18731The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18732&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18733an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18734failures are treated as configuration errors.
18735
18736Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18737for a router; all listed headers are added.
18738
18739&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18740router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18741
18742.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18743.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18744&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18745additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18746For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18747address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18748modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18749circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18750which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18751avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18752
18753
18754
18755.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18756.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18757.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18758This option specifies a list of text headers,
18759colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18760that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18761However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
18762Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
18763.new
18764If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
18765.wen
18766The way in which
18767the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18768section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18769the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18770to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18771&"see"& the original header lines.
18772
18773The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
18774&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18775the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18776errors.
18777
18778Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18779for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18780
18781&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18782router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18783
18784&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18785removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18786routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18787warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18788
18789&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18790items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18791To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18792
18793
18794
18795.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18796.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18797.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18798Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18799entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18800IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18801address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18802like
18803.code
18804remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18805.endd
18806by setting
18807.code
18808ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18809.endd
18810on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18811discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18812attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18813domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18814Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18815router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18816
18817You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18818means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18819.code
18820ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18821ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18822.endd
18823The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18824in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18825
18826This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18827addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18828is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18829domain that is being routed.
18830
18831.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18832During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18833checked.
18834
18835.option initgroups routers boolean false
18836.cindex "additional groups"
18837.cindex "groups" "additional"
18838.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18839.cindex "transport" "local"
18840If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18841the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18842&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18843any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18844and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18845
18846
18847
18848.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18849.cindex affix "router precondition"
18850.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18851.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18852If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18853one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18854section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18855evaluated.
18856
18857The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18858used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18859asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18860the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18861some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18862.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18863.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18864Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18865section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18866
18867.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18868.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18869During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18870running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18871expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18872the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18873a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18874command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18875This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18876the relevant transport.
18877
18878.new
18879.vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
18880If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
18881wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
18882.wen
18883
18884When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18885behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18886means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18887callout.
18888
18889The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18890&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18891&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18892to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18893immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18894.code
18895real_localuser:
18896 driver = accept
18897 local_part_prefix = real-
18898 check_local_user
18899 transport = local_delivery
18900.endd
18901For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18902router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18903.code
18904 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18905 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18906.endd
18907
18908If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18909both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18910are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18911separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18912
18913
18914.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18915See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18916
18917
18918
18919.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18920.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18921.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18922This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18923local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18924&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18925mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18926character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18927parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18928&%username-foo%&.
18929
18930
18931.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18932See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18933
18934
18935
18936.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18937.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18938.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18939The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18940See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18941are evaluated, and
18942section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18943string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18944example:
18945.code
18946local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18947.endd
18948.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18949If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18950for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18951expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18952example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18953send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18954each virtual domain:
18955.code
18956postmaster:
18957 driver = redirect
18958 local_parts = postmaster
18959 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18960.endd
18961
18962
18963.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18964.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18965.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18966Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18967deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18968recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18969this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18970router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18971router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18972redirect addresses.
18973
18974
18975
18976.option more routers boolean&!! true
18977The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18978that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18979result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18980fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18981delivery to be deferred.
18982
18983If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18984further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18985.oindex "&%self%&"
18986However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18987means of the setting
18988.code
18989self = pass
18990.endd
18991or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18992does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18993case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18994
18995Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18996expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18997controls what happens next.
18998
18999
19000.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19001.cindex "timeout" "of router"
19002.cindex "router" "timeout"
19003If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19004address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19005router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19006intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19007host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19008
19009There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19010lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19011applies to all of them.
19012
19013
19014
19015.option pass_router routers string unset
19016.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19017Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19018&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19019routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19020these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19021router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19022of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19023be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19024to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19025&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19026
19027
19028
19029.option redirect_router routers string unset
19030.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19031Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19032generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19033example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19034point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19035
19036The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19037It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19038instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19039which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19040
19041
19042
19043.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19044.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19045.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19046This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19047router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19048Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19049through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19050
19051Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19052be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19053(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19054If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19055failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19056
19057If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19058below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19059&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19060existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19061preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19062
19063.cindex "NFS"
19064If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19065the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19066unavailable.
19067
19068This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19069options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19070look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19071full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19072these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19073to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19074that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19075transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19076
19077During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19078facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19079This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19080operates as follows:
19081
19082If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19083characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19084comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19085but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19086used. For example:
19087.code
19088require_files = mail:/some/file
19089require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
19090.endd
19091If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19092&%require_files%& condition fails.
19093
19094Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19095checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19096directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19097access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19098
19099&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19100incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19101may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19102may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19103user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19104
19105&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19106&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19107without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19108is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19109check again in that process.
19110
19111The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19112be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19113existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19114circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19115not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19116for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19117as if the file did not exist. For example:
19118.code
19119require_files = +/some/file
19120.endd
19121If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19122handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19123option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19124
19125
19126
19127.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19128.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19129.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19130When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19131in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19132domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19133other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19134Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19135latter kind.
19136
19137This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19138hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19139router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19140&%check_local_user%&,
19141&%local_parts%&,
19142&%condition%&,
19143&%local_part_prefix%&,
19144&%local_part_suffix%&,
19145&%senders%& or
19146&%require_files%&
19147set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19148for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19149same name.
19150
19151Failing to set this option when it is needed
19152(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19153can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19154
19155The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19156appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19157independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19158
19159
19160
19161.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19162.cindex "router" "home directory for"
19163.cindex "home directory" "for router"
19164.vindex "&$home$&"
19165This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19166&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19167transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19168sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19169forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19170cause the router to defer.
19171
19172Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19173&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19174place.
19175(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19176are evaluated.)
19177While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19178&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19179
19180When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19181the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19182delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19183of these values that is set:
19184
19185.ilist
19186The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19187.next
19188The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19189.next
19190The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19191.next
19192The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19193.endlist
19194
19195In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19196router, but not for the transport.
19197
19198
19199
19200.option self routers string freeze
19201.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19202.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19203This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19204list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19205and &(manualroute)& routers.
19206Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19207of remote hosts.
19208Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19209&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19210host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19211The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19212&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19213
19214Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19215example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19216error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19217reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19218freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19219cases:
19220
19221.vlist
19222.vitem &%defer%&
19223Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19224
19225.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19226The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19227be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19228behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19229
19230.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19231The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19232reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19233rewritten.
19234
19235.vitem &%pass%&
19236.oindex "&%more%&"
19237.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19238The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19239&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19240subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19241name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19242distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19243combination
19244.code
19245self = pass
19246no_more
19247.endd
19248ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19249Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19250be passed to the next router.
19251
19252.vitem &%fail%&
19253Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19254
19255.vitem &%send%&
19256.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19257The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19258setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19259makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19260is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19261different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19262.endlist
19263
19264
19265
19266.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19267.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19268If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19269address matches something on the list.
19270See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19271are evaluated.
19272
19273There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19274dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19275setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19276to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19277set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19278verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19279SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19280matters.
19281
19282
19283.option set routers "string list" unset
19284.cindex router variables
19285This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19286because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19287The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19288usual way.
19289
19290Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19291and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19292Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19293When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19294to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19295the address.
19296The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19297The variables can be used by the router options
19298(not including any preconditions)
19299and by the transport.
19300Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19301Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19302
19303This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19304many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19305
19306
19307.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19308.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19309.cindex "packet radio"
19310.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19311There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19312it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19313mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19314routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19315is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19316code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19317SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19318
19319.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19320The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19321by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19322expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19323For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19324If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19325address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19326up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19327produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19328addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19329.code
19330translate_ip_address = \
19331 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19332 {$value}fail}}
19333.endd
19334The file would contain lines like
19335.code
1933610.2.3.128/26 some.host
1933710.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19338.endd
19339You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19340are doing.
19341
19342
19343
19344.option transport routers string&!! unset
19345This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19346and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19347only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19348after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19349and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19350delivery is deferred.
19351
19352The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19353have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19354(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19355
19356
19357
19358.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19359.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19360This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19361to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19362explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19363file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19364option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19365overridden by a setting on the transport.
19366If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19367logged, and delivery is deferred.
19368See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19369environment.
19370
19371
19372
19373
19374.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19375.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19376This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19377local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19378configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19379pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19380string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19381setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19382If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19383logged, and delivery is deferred.
19384
19385If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19386&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19387the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19388the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19389is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19390
19391See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19392environment.
19393
19394
19395
19396
19397.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19398.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19399The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19400that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19401result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19402fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19403delivery to be deferred.
19404
19405When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19406address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19407overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19408&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19409the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19410sometimes true and sometimes false).
19411
19412.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19413Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19414qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19415delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19416In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19417&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19418to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19419&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19420
19421&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19422this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19423only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19424no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19425a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19426duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19427duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19428&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19429so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19430&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19431
19432Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19433&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19434subsequent routers.
19435
19436
19437.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19438.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19439.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19440.cindex "transport" "local"
19441.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19442.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19443When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19444specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19445The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19446error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19447This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19448The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19449the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19450a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19451See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19452&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19453
19454
19455
19456.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19457Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19458&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19459
19460
19461.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19462.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19463.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19464.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19465If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19466delivering in cutthrough mode or
19467testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19468with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19469restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19470&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19471
19472&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19473SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19474accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19475user or group.
19476
19477
19478.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19479If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19480addresses,
19481delivering in cutthrough mode
19482or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19483See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19484are evaluated.
19485See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19486
19487
19488.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19489If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19490or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19491See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19492are evaluated.
19493See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19494.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19495.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19496
19497
19498
19499
19500
19501
19502. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19503. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19504
19505.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19506.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19507.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19508The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19509used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19510be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19511specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19512it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19513up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19514.code
19515localusers:
19516 driver = accept
19517 domains = mydomain.example
19518 check_local_user
19519 transport = local_delivery
19520.endd
19521The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19522&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19523When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19524address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19525
19526
19527
19528
19529
19530
19531. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19532. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19533
19534.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19535.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19536.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19537The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19538recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19539unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19540
19541If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19542SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19543MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19544However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19545records.
19546
19547MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19548looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19549When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19550except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19551IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19552generic option, the router declines.
19553
19554Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19555to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19556are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19557
19558.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19559.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19560.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19561If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19562address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19563happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19564
19565
19566.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19567There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19568Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19569SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19570MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19571problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19572
19573For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19574&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19575&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19576an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19577domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19578such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19579proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19580look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19581case routing fails.
19582
19583
19584.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19585.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19586There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19587an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19588domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19589
19590The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19591is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19592
19593Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19594.ilist
19595The domain does not exist in DNS
19596.next
19597The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19598convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19599for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19600.next
19601Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19602.next
19603MX record points to a non-existent host.
19604.next
19605MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19606&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19607.next
19608MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19609addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19610.next
19611The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19612&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19613.next
19614&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19615not be found in the MX records (see below)
19616.endlist
19617
19618
19619
19620
19621.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19622.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19623The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19624
19625.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19626.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19627If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19628(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19629process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19630differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19631the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19632
19633
19634.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19635.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19636The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19637addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19638enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19639required. For example,
19640.code
19641check_srv = smtp
19642.endd
19643looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19644expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19645to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19646submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19647option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19648normal way.
19649
19650When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19651the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19652host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19653this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19654SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19655according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19656
19657When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19658the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19659records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19660this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19661defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19662and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19663have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19664trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19665
19666See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19667when there is a DNS lookup error.
19668
19669
19670
19671
19672.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19673.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19674DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19675which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19676rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19677This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19678domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19679However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19680also being queued.
19681
19682
19683.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19684.cindex IPv6 disabling
19685.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19686The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19687or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19688(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19689only A records are used.
19690
19691.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19692.cindex IPv4 preference
19693.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19694The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19695or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19696(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19697A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19698
19699.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19700.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19701.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19702A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19703record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19704For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19705records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19706setting:
19707.code
19708mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19709.endd
19710This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19711has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19712the address record.
19713
19714
19715.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19716If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19717DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19718&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19719
19720
19721
19722
19723.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19724.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19725.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19726When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19727lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19728single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19729called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19730&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19731resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19732&'resolv.conf'&.
19733
19734
19735
19736.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19737.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19738.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19739If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19740qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19741an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19742expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19743occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19744&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19745any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19746header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19747
19748This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19749ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19750sense.
19751
19752When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19753servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19754making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19755some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19756name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19757header rewriting.
19758
19759
19760.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19761.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19762Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19763to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19764options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19765default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19766servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19767any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19768
19769If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19770domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19771local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19772lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19773routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19774message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19775without processing them independently,
19776provided the following conditions are met:
19777
19778.ilist
19779No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19780&%headers_remove%&.
19781.next
19782The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19783the domain.
19784.endlist
19785
19786
19787
19788
19789.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19790.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19791When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19792lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19793applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19794the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19795domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19796up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19797&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19798actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19799
19800Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19801record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19802local wildcard.
19803
19804
19805
19806.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19807If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19808DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19809&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19810
19811
19812
19813
19814.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19815.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19816If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19817added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19818if
19819.code
19820widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19821.endd
19822is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19823&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19824&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19825and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19826the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19827when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19828
19829
19830.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19831When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19832of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19833corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19834is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19835
19836These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19837for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19838such as that implied by
19839.code
19840domains = @mx_any
19841.endd
19842that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19843entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19844.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19845.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19846
19847
19848
19849
19850
19851
19852
19853
19854
19855. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19856. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19857
19858.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19859.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19860.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19861.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19862This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19863verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19864generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19865takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19866router handles the address
19867.code
19868root@[192.168.1.1]
19869.endd
19870by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19871consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19872are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19873.code
19874postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19875.endd
19876Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19877grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19878
19879.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19880If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19881declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19882&%self%& option determines what happens.
19883
19884The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19885controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19886also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19887Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19888
19889
19890
19891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19892. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19893
19894.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19895.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19896.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19897The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19898Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19899not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19900must set
19901.code
19902ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19903.endd
19904in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19905
19906The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19907connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19908a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19909message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19910this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19911can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19912must not be specified for it.
19913
19914.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19915.option hosts iplookup string unset
19916This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19917names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19918(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19919and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19920happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19921
19922
19923.option optional iplookup boolean false
19924If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19925is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19926delivery to the address is deferred.
19927
19928
19929.option port iplookup integer 0
19930.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19931This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19932call.
19933
19934
19935.option protocol iplookup string udp
19936This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19937protocols is to be used.
19938
19939
19940.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19941This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19942default value is:
19943.code
19944$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19945.endd
19946The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19947query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19948
19949
19950.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19951If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19952returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19953string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19954in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19955&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19956whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19957up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19958
19959
19960.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19961This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19962returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19963router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19964response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19965check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19966address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19967the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19968following could be used:
19969.code
19970response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19971reroute = $local_part@$1
19972.endd
19973
19974.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19975This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19976machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19977call. It does not apply to UDP.
19978
19979
19980
19981
19982. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19984
19985.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19986.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19987.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19988.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19989The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19990routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19991route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19992normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19993route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19994messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19995
19996The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19997it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19998has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19999include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20000&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20001generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20002being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20003
20004.vindex "&$host$&"
20005In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20006router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20007an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20008transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20009with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20010passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20011host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20012text string.
20013
20014The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20015&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20016or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20017any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20018below, following the list of private options.
20019
20020
20021.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20022
20023.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20024The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20025
20026.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20027See &%host_find_failed%&.
20028
20029.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20030This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20031address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20032of the following values:
20033.code
20034decline
20035defer
20036fail
20037freeze
20038ignore
20039pass
20040.endd
20041The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20042error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20043forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20044&%pass_router%&),
20045.oindex "&%more%&"
20046overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20047router only if &%more%& is true.
20048
20049The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20050cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20051controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20052as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20053
20054The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20055state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20056generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20057
20058
20059.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20060.cindex "randomized host list"
20061.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20062If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20063is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20064overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20065crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20066same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20067(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20068deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20069
20070When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20071into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20072set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20073item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20074.code
20075route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20076.endd
20077The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20078randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20079If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20080randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20081&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20082
20083
20084.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20085If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20086Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20087example:
20088.code
20089route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20090.endd
20091If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20092router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20093deferred.
20094
20095
20096.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20097This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20098unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20099that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20100
20101
20102.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20103.cindex "address" "copying routing"
20104Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20105router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20106router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20107default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20108servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20109any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20110
20111If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20112domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20113local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20114lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20115&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20116addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20117same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20118if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20119
20120
20121
20122
20123.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20124The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20125rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20126entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20127described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20128Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20129.display
20130<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20131.endd
20132The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20133no options:
20134.code
20135route_list = \
20136 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20137 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20138.endd
20139The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20140list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20141usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20142single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20143pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20144&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20145except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20146That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20147lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20148in a &%route_list%&).
20149
20150The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20151matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20152then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20153&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20154
20155
20156
20157.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20158The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20159routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20160hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20161The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20162Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20163expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20164like this:
20165.code
20166dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20167thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20168.endd
20169This data can be accessed by setting
20170.code
20171route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20172.endd
20173Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20174decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20175requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20176possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20177be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20178
20179
20180
20181
20182.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20183A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20184always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20185declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20186and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20187If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20188The format of each item
20189in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20190as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20191
20192If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20193variables are set during its expansion:
20194
20195.ilist
20196.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20197If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20198&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20199.code
20200route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20201.endd
20202.next
20203&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20204.next
20205&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20206
20207.next
20208.vindex "&$value$&"
20209If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20210looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20211.code
20212route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20213.endd
20214.endlist
20215
20216Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20217semicolon is the default route list separator.
20218
20219
20220
20221.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20222Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20223optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20224(see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20225When no port is given, an IP address
20226is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20227specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20228by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20229
20230.ilist
20231Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20232the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20233be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20234.code
20235route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20236route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20237.endd
20238.next
20239When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20240colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20241enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20242number follows. For example:
20243.code
20244route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20245.endd
20246.endlist
20247
20248.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20249When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20250the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20251delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20252option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20253transport.
20254
20255Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20256hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20257interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20258records in the DNS. For example:
20259.code
20260route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20261.endd
20262If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20263example:
20264.code
20265route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20266.endd
20267If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20268randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20269that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20270be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20271Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20272happens is controlled by the
20273.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20274&%self%& option of the router.
20275
20276A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20277hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20278lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20279below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20280preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20281randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20282defined by MX preferences.
20283
20284If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20285not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20286preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20287
20288If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20289depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20290is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20291Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20292
20293If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20294most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20295router.
20296
20297DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20298failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20299&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20300
20301The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20302whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20303
20304
20305
20306.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20307The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20308One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20309&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20310other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20311per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20312routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20313
20314.ilist
20315&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20316setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20317.next
20318&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20319overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20320.next
20321&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20322find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20323also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20324.next
20325&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20326no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20327timeout), delivery is deferred.
20328.next
20329&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20330.next
20331&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20332.endlist
20333
20334For example:
20335.code
20336route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20337 domain2 host4:host5
20338.endd
20339If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20340DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20341result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20342or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20343call.
20344
20345&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20346called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20347instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20348lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20349function called.
20350
20351&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20352inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20353option specified.
20354
20355
20356
20357If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20358&%host_find_failed%& option.
20359
20360.vindex "&$host$&"
20361When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20362The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20363
20364
20365
20366.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20367In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20368transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20369
20370.ilist
20371.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20372The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20373&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20374named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20375.code
20376domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20377.endd
20378You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20379your first router something like this:
20380.code
20381smart_route:
20382 driver = manualroute
20383 domains = !+local_domains
20384 transport = remote_smtp
20385 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20386.endd
20387This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20388&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20389they are tried in order
20390(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20391Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20392.code
20393smart_route:
20394 driver = manualroute
20395 transport = remote_smtp
20396 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20397.endd
20398There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20399However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20400example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20401precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20402always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20403would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20404always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20405&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20406
20407.next
20408.cindex "mail hub example"
20409A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20410records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20411the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20412machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20413&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20414to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20415using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20416lookup is easier to manage.
20417
20418If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20419to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20420example:
20421.code
20422hub_route:
20423 driver = manualroute
20424 transport = remote_smtp
20425 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20426.endd
20427This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20428whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20429if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20430that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20431domain can be used to find the host:
20432.code
20433through_firewall:
20434 driver = manualroute
20435 transport = remote_smtp
20436 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20437.endd
20438The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20439hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20440data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20441next router.
20442
20443.next
20444.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20445.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20446You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20447SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20448storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20449can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20450.code
20451save_in_file:
20452 driver = manualroute
20453 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20454 route_list = saved.domain.example
20455.endd
20456though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20457several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20458different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20459.code
20460save_in_file:
20461 driver = manualroute
20462 route_list = \
20463 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20464 *.saved.domain2.example \
20465 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20466 batch_pipe
20467.endd
20468.vindex "&$domain$&"
20469.vindex "&$host$&"
20470The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20471doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20472file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20473the address if the lookup fails.
20474
20475.next
20476.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20477Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20478&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20479one way it can be done:
20480.code
20481# Transport
20482uucp:
20483 driver = pipe
20484 user = nobody
20485 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20486 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20487 return_fail_output = true
20488
20489# Router
20490uucphost:
20491 transport = uucp
20492 driver = manualroute
20493 route_data = \
20494 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20495.endd
20496The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20497.code
20498darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20499.endd
20500It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20501makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20502&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20503.endlist
20504.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20505.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20506
20507
20508
20509
20510
20511
20512
20513
20514. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20515. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20516
20517.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20518.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20519.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20520.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20521The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20522and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20523mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20524However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20525&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20526be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20527options:
20528.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20529
20530.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20531This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20532command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20533expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20534&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20535
20536
20537.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20538.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20539This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20540address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20541uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20542gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20543
20544
20545.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20546.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20547This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20548command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20549it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20550using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20551not set, a value for the gid also.
20552
20553&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20554root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20555However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20556usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20557is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20558the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20559gid.
20560
20561
20562.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20563This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20564before running the command.
20565
20566
20567.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20568If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20569is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20570timeout.
20571
20572
20573The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20574the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20575containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20576the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20577field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20578
20579.ilist
20580&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20581below).
20582.next
20583&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20584&%no_more%& is set.
20585.next
20586&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20587subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20588of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20589included in the SMTP response.
20590.next
20591&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20592subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20593included in any SMTP response.
20594.next
20595&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20596.next
20597&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20598&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20599.next
20600&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20601new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20602or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20603.endlist
20604
20605When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20606number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20607the page):
20608.code
20609ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20610LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20611.endd
20612The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20613is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20614used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20615an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20616
20617The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20618As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20619in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20620&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20621(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20622
20623If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20624find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20625anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20626goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20627result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20628
20629.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20630If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20631variable. For example, this return line
20632.code
20633accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20634.endd
20635routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20636the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20637.ecindex IIDquerou1
20638.ecindex IIDquerou2
20639
20640
20641
20642
20643. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20644. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20645
20646.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20647.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20648.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20649.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20650.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20651The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20652common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20653(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20654files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20655redirected in several different ways:
20656
20657.ilist
20658It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20659independently.
20660.next
20661It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20662.next
20663It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20664.next
20665It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20666.next
20667It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20668.next
20669It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20670.next
20671It can be discarded.
20672.endlist
20673
20674The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20675However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20676files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20677&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20678
20679If success DSNs have been requested
20680.cindex "DSN" "success"
20681.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20682redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20683
20684
20685
20686.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20687The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20688expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20689contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20690options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20691aliases, in a configuration like this:
20692.code
20693system_aliases:
20694 driver = redirect
20695 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20696.endd
20697If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20698expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20699expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20700cause delivery to be deferred.
20701
20702A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20703&_.forward_& files, like this:
20704.code
20705userforward:
20706 driver = redirect
20707 check_local_user
20708 file = $home/.forward
20709 no_verify
20710.endd
20711If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20712empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20713is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20714yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20715comments.
20716
20717.new
20718.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20719.cindex redirect "tainted data"
20720Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20721
20722&*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20723directly for redirection,
20724as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20725In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20726on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20727the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20728.wen
20729
20730
20731
20732.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20733.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20734It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20735&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20736
20737.ilist
20738When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20739running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20740the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20741practice the router may not be able to operate.
20742.next
20743However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20744is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20745local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20746saves some resources.
20747.endlist
20748
20749
20750
20751
20752
20753
20754.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20755.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20756.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20757The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20758can be interpreted in two different ways:
20759
20760.ilist
20761If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20762&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20763&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20764respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20765in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20766document is intended for use by end users.
20767.next
20768Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20769described in the next section.
20770.endlist
20771
20772When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20773in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20774generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20775configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20776for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20777
20778
20779
20780.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20781.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20782When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20783comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20784addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20785&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20786disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20787depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20788commas or newlines.
20789If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20790quotes.
20791
20792Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20793also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20794next newline character is ignored.
20795
20796If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20797double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20798(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20799&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20800removed.
20801
20802.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20803&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20804and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20805of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20806special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20807&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20808setting:
20809.code
20810data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20811.endd
20812
20813
20814.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20815.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20816.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20817.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20818A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20819consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20820automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20821is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20822Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20823as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20824complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20825
20826.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20827Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20828filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20829mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20830&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20831.code
20832cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20833.endd
20834.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20835.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20836For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20837preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20838it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20839synonymously.
20840
20841If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
208422822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20843domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20844addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20845force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20846
20847Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20848Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20849contains:
20850.code
20851Sam.Reman: spqr
20852.endd
20853Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20854messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20855this forward file:
20856.code
20857Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20858.endd
20859With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20860&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20861second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20862and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20863should really contain
20864.code
20865spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20866.endd
20867but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20868below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20869&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20870
20871
20872
20873.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20874In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20875lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20876
20877.ilist
20878.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20879.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20880An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20881as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20882command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20883Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20884which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20885
20886Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20887the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20888the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20889in double quotes, for example:
20890.code
20891"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20892.endd
20893since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20894quote just the command. An item such as
20895.code
20896|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20897.endd
20898is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20899
20900Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20901of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20902redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20903quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20904string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20905are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20906data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20907transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20908an &%accept%& router.
20909
20910.next
20911.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20912.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20913An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20914parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20915.code
20916/home/world/minbari
20917.endd
20918is treated as a filename, but
20919.code
20920/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20921.endd
20922is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20923the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20924forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20925filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20926
20927Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20928which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20929
20930.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20931However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20932bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20933instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20934
20935.next
20936.cindex "included address list"
20937.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20938If an item is of the form
20939.code
20940:include:<path name>
20941.endd
20942a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20943point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20944out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20945by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20946item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20947the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20948.code
20949list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20950.endd
20951It must be given as
20952.code
20953list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20954.endd
20955.new
20956.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20957.cindex redirect "tainted data"
20958Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20959.wen
20960.next
20961.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20962.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20963.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20964.cindex "black hole"
20965.cindex "abandoning mail"
20966Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20967&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20968the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20969.code
20970:blackhole:
20971.endd
20972can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20973done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20974&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20975
20976&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20977delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20978are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20979database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20980&_/dev/null_&.
20981
20982.next
20983.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20984.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20985.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20986.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20987.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20988An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20989redirection items of the form
20990.code
20991:defer:
20992:fail:
20993.endd
20994respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20995to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20996text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20997associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20998.code
20999X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21000.endd
21001In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21002of a
21003.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21004VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21005default.
21006.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21007The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21008the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21009
21010.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21011By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21012&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21013space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21014followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21015code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21016incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21017suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21018&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21019ignored.
21020
21021.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21022In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21023default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21024therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21025
21026Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21027not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21028normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21029as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21030lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21031
21032During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21033containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21034whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21035subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21036deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21037rules still apply.
21038
21039.next
21040.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21041Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21042chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21043for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21044&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21045router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21046results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21047.endlist
21048
21049
21050.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21051.cindex "duplicate addresses"
21052.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21053.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21054Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21055to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21056routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21057aliasing scheme of the type
21058.code
21059pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21060localpart1: pipe
21061localpart2: pipe
21062.endd
21063does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21064when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21065discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21066such as
21067.code
21068localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21069localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21070.endd
21071does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21072the pipes are distinct.
21073
21074
21075
21076.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21077.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21078.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21079When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21080leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21081afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21082delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21083members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21084can be used to avoid this.
21085
21086
21087.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21088.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21089If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21090error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21091for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21092detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21093deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21094
21095
21096
21097.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21098
21099.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21100The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21101
21102
21103.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21104Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21105data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21106
21107
21108.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21109.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21110If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21111and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21112
21113
21114.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21115.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21116.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21117Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21118&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21119are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21120lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21121
21122It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21123the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21124
21125
21126The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21127&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21128&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21129files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21130true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21131
21132
21133
21134.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21135.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21136Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21137This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21138default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21139let ordinary users do.
21140
21141
21142
21143.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21144This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21145as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21146Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21147configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21148for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21149
21150When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21151is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21152the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21153and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21154domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21155&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21156.code
21157\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21158.endd
21159Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21160&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21161originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21162(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21163&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21164&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21165file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21166original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21167
21168
21169.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21170When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21171when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21172&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21173&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21174deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21175is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21176&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21177
21178
21179
21180.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21181When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21182this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21183permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21184option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21185&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21186
21187
21188.option data redirect string&!! unset
21189This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21190set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21191list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21192expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21193has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21194
21195When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21196filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21197terminated with newline characters. For example:
21198.code
21199data = #Exim filter\n\
21200 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21201.endd
21202If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21203you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21204choice into a newline.
21205
21206
21207.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21208A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21209ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21210specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21211configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21212
21213
21214.option file redirect string&!! unset
21215This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21216is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21217use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21218failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21219must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21220data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21221entirely of comments), the router declines.
21222
21223.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21224If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21225runs a check on the containing directory,
21226unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21227If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21228happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21229is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21230not, the router declines.
21231
21232
21233.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21234.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21235A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21236ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21237specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21238configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21239it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21240
21241
21242.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21243When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21244relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21245relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21246relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21247
21248
21249.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21250.cindex "restricting access to features"
21251.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21252If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21253redirection list.
21254
21255
21256.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21257.cindex "restricting access to features"
21258.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21259If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21260&%allow_filter%& is true.
21261
21262
21263
21264
21265.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21266.cindex "restricting access to features"
21267.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21268.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21269.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21270.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21271If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21272specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21273conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21274set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21275locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21276
21277
21278.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21279.cindex "restricting access to features"
21280.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21281If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21282make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21283functions.
21284
21285.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21286.cindex "restricting access to features"
21287.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21288.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21289If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21290make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21291
21292.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21293.cindex "restricting access to features"
21294.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21295If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21296permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21297under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21298&_.forward_& files).
21299
21300
21301.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21302.cindex "restricting access to features"
21303.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21304If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21305to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21306
21307
21308.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21309.cindex "restricting access to features"
21310.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21311This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21312it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21313of the embedded Perl support.
21314
21315
21316.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21317.cindex "restricting access to features"
21318.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21319If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21320to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21321
21322
21323.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21324.cindex "restricting access to features"
21325.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21326If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21327to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21328
21329
21330.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21331.cindex "restricting access to features"
21332.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21333If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21334message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21335files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21336&%one_time%& is set.
21337
21338
21339.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21340.cindex "restricting access to features"
21341.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21342If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21343to make use of &%run%& items.
21344
21345
21346.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21347.cindex "restricting access to features"
21348.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21349If this option is true, items of the form
21350.code
21351:include:<path name>
21352.endd
21353are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21354
21355
21356.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21357.cindex "restricting access to features"
21358.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21359.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21360If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21361specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21362forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21363
21364
21365.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21366.cindex "restricting access to features"
21367.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21368If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21369&%allow_filter%& is true.
21370
21371
21372.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21373.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21374If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21375of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21376the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21377
21378
21379
21380
21381.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21382.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21383If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21384generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21385generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21386bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21387bounce may well quote the generated address.
21388
21389
21390.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21391.cindex "EACCES"
21392If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21393EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21394file did not exist.
21395
21396
21397.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21398.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21399If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21400ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21401router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21402
21403Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21404router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21405(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21406against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21407is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21408is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21409a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21410that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21411
21412
21413
21414.option include_directory redirect string unset
21415If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21416redirection list must start with this directory.
21417
21418
21419.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21420This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21421&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21422
21423
21424.option one_time redirect boolean false
21425.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21426.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21427.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21428.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21429.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21430Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21431files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21432of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21433is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21434but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21435message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21436lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21437before they subscribed.
21438
21439If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21440deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21441&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21442&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21443attempt.
21444
21445&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21446router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21447reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21448permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21449
21450&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21451to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21452and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21453
21454&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21455&%one_time%&.
21456
21457The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21458addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21459addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21460&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21461typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21462expansion.
21463
21464
21465.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21466.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21467.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21468.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21469.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21470This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21471This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21472See &%check_owner%& above.
21473
21474
21475.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21476This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21477The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21478&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21479
21480
21481.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21482.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21483A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21484starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21485transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21486name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21487When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21488
21489
21490.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21491.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21492If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21493generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21494in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21495expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21496to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21497&$qualify_recipient$&.
21498
21499This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21500but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21501not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21502addresses.
21503
21504.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21505.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21506.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21507.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21508If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21509set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21510without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21511address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21512&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21513this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21514
21515
21516.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21517If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21518any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21519the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21520only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21521&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21522
21523
21524.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21525A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21526&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21527by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21528transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21529are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21530
21531
21532.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21533.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21534If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21535subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21536and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21537
21538
21539.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21540The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21541:subaddress part of an address.
21542
21543.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21544The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21545of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21546(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21547
21548
21549.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21550.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21551To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21552&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21553(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21554&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21555needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21556
21557
21558
21559.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21560.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21561.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21562.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21563.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21564.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21565.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21566.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21567If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21568non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21569&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21570giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21571are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21572&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21573be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21574&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21575
21576If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21577errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21578the following routers.
21579
21580If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21581error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21582taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21583so it is passed to the following routers.
21584
21585.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21586Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21587action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21588&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21589
21590&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21591lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21592option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21593notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21594.code
21595userforward:
21596 driver = redirect
21597 allow_filter
21598 check_local_user
21599 file = $home/.forward
21600 file_transport = address_file
21601 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21602 reply_transport = address_reply
21603 no_verify
21604 skip_syntax_errors
21605 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21606 syntax_errors_text = \
21607 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21608 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21609 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21610 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21611 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21612 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21613 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21614 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21615 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21616 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21617.endd
21618You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21619&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21620put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21621.code
21622real_localuser:
21623 driver = accept
21624 check_local_user
21625 local_part_prefix = real-
21626 transport = local_delivery
21627.endd
21628For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21629router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21630.code
21631 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21632 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21633.endd
21634
21635
21636.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21637See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21638
21639
21640.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21641See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21642.ecindex IIDredrou1
21643.ecindex IIDredrou2
21644
21645
21646
21647
21648
21649
21650. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21651. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21652
21653.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21654 "Environment for local transports"
21655.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21656.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21657.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21658Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21659transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21660in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21661mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21662
21663Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21664some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21665transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21666&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21667
21668The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21669different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21670settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21671or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21672configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21673
21674
21675
21676.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21677.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21678.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21679If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21680simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21681the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21682rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21683time.
21684
21685However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21686locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21687.code
21688my_transport:
21689 driver = pipe
21690 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21691.endd
21692This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21693messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21694&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21695file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21696
21697
21698
21699
21700.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21701.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21702.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21703All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21704overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21705set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21706delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21707group (set by the transport). For example:
21708.code
21709# Routers ...
21710# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21711local_users:
21712 driver = accept
21713 check_local_user
21714 transport = group_delivery
21715
21716# Transports ...
21717# This transport overrides the group
21718group_delivery:
21719 driver = appendfile
21720 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21721 group = mail
21722.endd
21723If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21724address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21725gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21726set.
21727
21728.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21729When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21730function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21731&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21732by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21733for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21734
21735.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21736The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21737is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21738receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21739original gid is also used.
21740
21741This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21742following that is set is used:
21743
21744.ilist
21745A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21746.next
21747A &%group%& setting of the router;
21748.next
21749A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21750&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21751.next
21752The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21753.next
21754In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21755the uid is the creator's uid;
21756.next
21757The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21758.endlist
21759
21760If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21761no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21762This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21763The first of the following that is set is used:
21764
21765.ilist
21766A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21767.next
21768In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21769.next
21770A &%user%& setting of the router;
21771.next
21772A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21773.next
21774The Exim uid.
21775.endlist
21776
21777Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21778&%never_users%& list.
21779
21780
21781
21782
21783
21784.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21785.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21786.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21787.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21788.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21789Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21790the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21791However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21792are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21793for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21794
21795.ilist
21796The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21797.next
21798The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21799.next
21800The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21801.next
21802The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21803.endlist
21804
21805The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21806
21807.ilist
21808The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21809.next
21810The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21811.endlist
21812
21813
21814If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21815value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21816directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21817
21818
21819
21820.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21821.vindex "&$domain$&"
21822.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21823.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21824Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21825variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21826deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21827at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21828other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21829never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21830and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21831.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21832.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21833.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21834
21835
21836
21837
21838
21839
21840
21841. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21842. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21843
21844.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21845.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21846.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21847.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21848The following generic options apply to all transports:
21849
21850
21851.option body_only transports boolean false
21852.cindex "transport" "body only"
21853.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21854.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21855If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21856mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21857or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21858&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21859automatically suppress them.
21860
21861
21862.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21863.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21864This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21865transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21866If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21867logged, and delivery is deferred.
21868
21869
21870.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21871If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21872deliveries by the transport or for any
21873transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21874what you are doing.
21875
21876
21877.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21878.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21879If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21880option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21881transport is run.
21882If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21883output, and Exim carries on processing.
21884This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21885so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21886option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21887variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21888one.
21889The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21890transport and the router that called it.
21891
21892.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21893.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21894If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21895This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21896header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21897requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21898safely be resent to other recipients.
21899
21900
21901.option driver transports string unset
21902This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21903There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21904
21905
21906.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21907.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21908If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21909This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21910delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21911configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21912address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21913header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21914its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21915resent to other recipients.
21916
21917
21918.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21919.cindex events
21920This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21921For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21922
21923
21924.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21925.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21926This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21927value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21928&%user%& (see below).
21929
21930
21931.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21932.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21933.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21934This option specifies a list of text headers,
21935newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21936which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21937portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21938&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21939routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21940is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21941errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21942
21943Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21944for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21945
21946
21947.option headers_only transports boolean false
21948.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21949.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21950.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21951If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21952exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21953transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21954checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21955
21956
21957.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21958.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21959.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21960This option specifies a list of text headers,
21961colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21962to be removed from the message.
21963However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
21964Each list item is separately expanded.
21965If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21966is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21967errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21968.new
21969If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
21970.wen
21971
21972Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21973in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21974routers.
21975
21976Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21977for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21978
21979&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21980items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21981To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21982
21983
21984
21985.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21986.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21987.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21988This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21989that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21990option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21991the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21992message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21993example,
21994.code
21995headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21996 x@y w@z
21997.endd
21998changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21999&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22000header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22001only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22002the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22003filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22004affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22005envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22006change envelope recipients at this time.
22007
22008
22009.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22010.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22011.vindex "&$home$&"
22012This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22013overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22014placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22015used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22016&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22017&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22018for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22019deferred.
22020
22021
22022.option initgroups transports boolean false
22023.cindex "additional groups"
22024.cindex "groups" "additional"
22025.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22026If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22027transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22028to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22029
22030
22031.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22032.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22033.cindex transport "parallel processes"
22034.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22035.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22036If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22037it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22038The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22039
22040.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22041Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22042incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22043is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22044Obviously there is scope for
22045records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22046guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22047
22048If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22049relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22050start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22051may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22052are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22053
22054
22055.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22056.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22057.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22058.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22059This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22060expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22061digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22062including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22063delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22064message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22065the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22066ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22067&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22068delivered.
22069
22070
22071
22072.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22073.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22074.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22075.cindex "local part" "prefix"
22076.cindex "local part" "suffix"
22077When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22078affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22079form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22080that contains
22081.code
22082local_part_prefix = *-
22083.endd
22084routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22085is delivered with
22086.code
22087RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22088.endd
22089This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22090recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22091whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22092deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22093&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22094
22095
22096.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22097.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22098When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22099in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22100is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22101deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22102part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22103temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22104deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22105
22106However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22107as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22108(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22109this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22110
22111For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22112the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22113on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22114
22115
22116.option return_path transports string&!! unset
22117.cindex "envelope sender"
22118.cindex "envelope from"
22119.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22120.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22121If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22122the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22123that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22124designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22125SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22126only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22127header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22128
22129&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22130&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22131
22132.vindex "&$return_path$&"
22133The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22134either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22135&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22136replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22137option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22138section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22139
22140&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22141remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22142the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22143This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22144&%errors_to%& in a router.
22145
22146
22147
22148.option return_path_add transports boolean false
22149.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
22150If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22151Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22152mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22153have easy access to it.
22154
22155RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22156the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22157header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22158option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22159incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22160recipients.
22161
22162
22163.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22164See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22165
22166
22167.option shadow_transport transports string unset
22168.cindex "shadow transport"
22169.cindex "transport" "shadow"
22170A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22171another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22172
22173Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22174&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22175string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22176passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22177expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22178cause a log line to be written.
22179
22180The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22181subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22182provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22183is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22184ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22185of the form
22186.code
22187ST=<shadow transport name>
22188.endd
22189If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22190parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22191purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22192provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22193headers that some sites insist on.
22194
22195
22196.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22197.cindex "transport" "filter"
22198.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22199This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22200at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22201individual users or via a system filter.
22202If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22203
22204When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22205&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22206the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22207input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22208command must be specified as an absolute path.
22209
22210The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22211terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22212SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22213lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22214settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22215&(pipe)& transports.
22216
22217The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22218standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22219destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22220filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22221are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22222
22223The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22224care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22225test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22226SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22227
22228.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22229A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22230at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22231message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22232a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22233not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22234
22235.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22236A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22237being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22238support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22239at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22240more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22241the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22242additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22243
22244.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22245The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22246the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22247parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22248Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22249section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22250to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22251of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22252an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22253&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22254
22255.vindex "&$host$&"
22256.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22257The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22258transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22259which the message is being sent. For example:
22260.code
22261transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22262 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22263.endd
22264
22265Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22266generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22267command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22268.ilist
22269If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22270part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22271expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22272example:
22273.code
22274transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22275.endd
22276This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22277&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22278stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22279the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22280&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22281Exim tried to expand the first one.
22282.next
22283Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22284expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22285arguments. Consider this example:
22286.code
22287transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22288 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22289.endd
22290The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22291if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22292.code
22293transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22294 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22295.endd
22296.endlist
22297
22298The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22299For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22300normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22301A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22302serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22303the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22304bounced from a transport filter.
22305
22306If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22307passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22308message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22309
22310
22311.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22312.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22313When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22314that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22315temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22316&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22317way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22318error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22319becomes a temporary error.
22320
22321
22322.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22323.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22324.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22325This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22326run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22327given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22328associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22329option is not set.
22330
22331For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22332specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22333&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22334
22335.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22336For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22337sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22338to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22339retry data.
22340.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22341.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22342.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22343
22344
22345
22346
22347
22348
22349. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22350. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22351
22352.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22353 "Address batching"
22354.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22355The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22356one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22357remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22358normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22359transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22360copy of the message is delivered each time.
22361
22362.cindex "batched local delivery"
22363.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22364.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22365In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22366local transport, for example:
22367
22368.ilist
22369In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22370delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22371recipients saves space.
22372.next
22373In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22374a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22375.next
22376In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22377to a scanner program or
22378to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22379acceptable.
22380.endlist
22381
22382These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22383(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22384repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22385
22386The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22387delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22388(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22389&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22390(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22391to certain conditions:
22392
22393.ilist
22394.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22395If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22396batching is possible.
22397.next
22398.vindex "&$domain$&"
22399If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22400addresses with the same domain are batched.
22401.next
22402.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22403If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22404addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22405customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22406including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22407from taking place.
22408.next
22409Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22410delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22411group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22412be the same.
22413.endlist
22414
22415In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22416both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22417is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22418course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22419option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22420&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22421&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22422.code
22423check_string = "."
22424escape_string = ".."
22425.endd
22426when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22427given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22428&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22429
22430.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22431If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22432&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22433that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22434transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22435addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22436
22437.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22438.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22439If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22440transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22441the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22442of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22443argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22444delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22445are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22446
22447
22448
22449
22450. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22451. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22452
22453.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22454.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22455.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22456.cindex "directory creation"
22457.cindex "creating directories"
22458The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22459file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22460files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22461format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22462University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22463being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22464to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22465delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22466supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22467directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22468
22469The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22470default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22471SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22472included.
22473
22474.cindex "quota" "system"
22475Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22476also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22477system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22478
22479If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22480partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22481modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22482creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22483
22484Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22485file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22486private options.
22487
22488The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22489users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22490putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22491&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22492option).
22493
22494
22495
22496.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22497The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22498the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22499the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22500normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22501
22502.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22503.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22504However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22505directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22506forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22507user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22508the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22509name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22510operation. There are two cases:
22511
22512.ilist
22513If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22514must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22515common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22516different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22517default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22518name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22519&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22520.next
22521If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22522used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22523contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22524.endlist
22525.new
22526.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22527.cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22528Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22529This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22530as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22531which returns a path (or component).
22532.wen
22533
22534
22535.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22536.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22537As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22538have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22539form:
22540.code
22541save folder23
22542.endd
22543or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22544.code
22545require "fileinto";
22546fileinto "folder23";
22547.endd
22548In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22549must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22550case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22551is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22552way of handling this requirement:
22553.code
22554file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22555 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22556 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22557 {$address_file} \
22558 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22559 }} \
22560 }
22561.endd
22562With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22563location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22564&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22565
22566&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22567&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22568the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22569you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22570&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22571path to the transport.
22572
22573&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22574the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22575
22576
22577
22578
22579.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22580.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22581
22582
22583
22584.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22585.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22586.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22587.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22588Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22589regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22590delivery is deferred.
22591
22592
22593.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22594.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22595.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22596By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22597that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22598are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22599what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22600are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22601
22602
22603.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22604See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22605However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22606happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22607file.
22608
22609
22610.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22611See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22612
22613
22614.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22615When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22616option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22617delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22618file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22619
22620
22621.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22622When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22623is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22624process is running.
22625
22626
22627.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22628.cindex "&""From""& line"
22629As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22630matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22631replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22632a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22633contains is significant.
22634
22635If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22636are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22637configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22638&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22639&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22640
22641The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22642suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22643&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22644if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22645.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22646.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22647.code
22648check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22649escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22650message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22651message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22652.endd
22653.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22654.cindex "directory creation"
22655When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22656directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22657is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22658
22659The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22660operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22661example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22662is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22663in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22664
22665
22666
22667.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22668This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22669by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22670directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22671delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22672beneath.
22673
22674The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22675&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22676set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22677given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22678are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22679by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22680&%file_must_exist%&.
22681
22682
22683.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22684This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22685or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22686redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22687
22688When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22689into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22690appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22691(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22692&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22693
22694
22695.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22696.cindex "base62"
22697.vindex "&$inode$&"
22698When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22699&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22700whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22701.code
22702q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22703.endd
22704This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22705inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22706option.
22707
22708
22709.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22710If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22711&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22712
22713
22714.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22715See &%check_string%& above.
22716
22717
22718.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22719This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22720&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22721of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22722specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22723&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22724&%file%&.
22725
22726.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22727.cindex "locking files"
22728.cindex "lock files"
22729If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22730mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22731
22732The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22733path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22734examples:
22735.code
22736file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22737file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22738file = $home/inbox
22739.endd
22740.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22741In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22742is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22743create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22744deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22745run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22746
22747
22748
22749.option file_format appendfile string unset
22750.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22751This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22752before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22753start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22754colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22755second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22756string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22757transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22758this added to it:
22759.code
22760file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22761 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22762.endd
22763Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22764a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22765to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22766to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22767is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22768match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22769delivery is deferred.
22770
22771
22772.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22773If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22774A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22775If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22776
22777
22778.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22779.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22780.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22781.cindex "locking files"
22782By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22783when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22784sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22785Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22786for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22787deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22788mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22789misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22790
22791On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22792not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22793is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22794and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22795
22796If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22797timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22798retries is
22799.code
22800(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22801.endd
22802rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22803which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22804&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22805
22806You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22807local deliveries because of errors of the form
22808.code
22809failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22810.endd
22811
22812.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22813This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22814&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22815&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22816
22817
22818.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22819This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22820for details of locking.
22821
22822
22823.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22824This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22825is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22826
22827
22828.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22829This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22830used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22831
22832
22833.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22834.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22835When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22836exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22837accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22838
22839
22840.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22841.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22842.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22843If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22844number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22845followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22846external source that maintains the data.
22847
22848
22849.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22850.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22851.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22852If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22853size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22854This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22855maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22856it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22857
22858
22859
22860.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22861.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22862If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22863file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22864transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22865&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22866&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22867directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22868SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22869&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22870
22871
22872.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22873.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22874.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22875This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22876a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22877directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22878calculation. The default value is:
22879.code
22880maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22881.endd
22882This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22883(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22884&_Trash_&
22885folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22886.code
22887maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22888.endd
22889This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22890directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22891calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22892directly into that directory.
22893
22894
22895.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22896This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22897&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22898
22899
22900.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22901This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22902section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22903
22904
22905.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22906.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22907The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22908If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22909creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22910quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22911value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22912&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22913
22914.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22915.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22916.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22917The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22918effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22919matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22920containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22921delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22922&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22923See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22924
22925
22926.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22927.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22928If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22929new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22930SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22931below for further details.
22932
22933
22934.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22935This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22936section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22937
22938
22939.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22940This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22941section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22942
22943
22944.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22945.cindex "locking files"
22946.cindex "file" "locking"
22947.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22948.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22949This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22950set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22951the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22952traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22953IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22954
22955&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22956automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22957empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22958combination:
22959.code
22960mbx_format = true
22961message_prefix =
22962message_suffix =
22963.endd
22964If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22965&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22966is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22967&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22968interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22969should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22970going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22971mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22972
22973If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22974the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22975(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22976append messages to it.
22977
22978
22979.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22980.cindex "&""From""& line"
22981The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22982The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22983in which case it is:
22984.code
22985message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22986 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22987.endd
22988&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22989&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22990
22991.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22992The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22993The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22994in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22995setting
22996.code
22997message_suffix =
22998.endd
22999&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23000&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23001
23002.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23003If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23004has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23005permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23006if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23007a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23008value, and this option is ignored.
23009
23010
23011.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23012This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23013mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23014true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23015continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23016
23017
23018.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23019If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23020successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23021on users about incoming mail.
23022
23023
23024.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23025.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23026This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23027or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23028is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23029all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23030individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23031&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23032have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23033
23034As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23035multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23036For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23037
23038A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23039may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23040If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23041become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23042Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23043the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23044
23045The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23046(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23047for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23048and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23049large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23050be handled.
23051
23052The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23053quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23054
23055&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23056
23057The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23058the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23059be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23060fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23061system quota failures.
23062
23063By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23064mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23065last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23066during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23067refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23068message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23069changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23070for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23071continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23072delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23073
23074
23075.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23076This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23077into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23078called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23079delivery directory.
23080
23081
23082.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23083This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23084number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23085can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23086failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23087&"no quota"&.
23088
23089The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23090quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23091
23092.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23093See &%quota%& above.
23094
23095
23096.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23097This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23098for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23099these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23100If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23101captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23102file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23103
23104This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23105&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23106facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23107the file length to the filename. For example:
23108.code
23109maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23110quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23111.endd
23112An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23113number of lines in the message.
23114
23115The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23116filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23117sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23118
23119Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23120
23121This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23122may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23123will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23124disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23125a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23126as is used to adjust the effective size.
23127
23128
23129.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23130See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23131&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23132.code
23133quota_warn_message = "\
23134 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23135 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23136 This message is automatically created \
23137 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23138 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23139 a warning threshold that is\n\
23140 set by the system administrator.\n"
23141.endd
23142
23143
23144.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23145.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23146.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23147.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23148This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23149resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23150size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23151threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23152may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23153sign. For example:
23154.code
23155quota = 10M
23156quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23157.endd
23158If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23159percent sign is ignored.
23160
23161The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23162and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23163warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23164the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23165can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23166&'From:'& line, the default is:
23167.code
23168From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23169.endd
23170.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23171If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23172option.
23173
23174The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23175are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23176percentage.
23177
23178
23179.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23180.cindex "envelope from"
23181.cindex "envelope sender"
23182If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23183format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23184you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23185so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23186for details of batch SMTP.
23187
23188
23189.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23190.cindex "carriage return"
23191.cindex "linefeed"
23192This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23193(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23194of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23195of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23196
23197&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23198(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23199in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23200carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23201have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23202changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23203
23204
23205.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23206This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23207exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23208&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23209that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23210&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23211
23212
23213.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23214This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23215the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23216&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23217each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23218
23219This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23220&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23221where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23222both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23223
23224.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23225Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23226have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23227&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23228the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23229error.
23230
23231&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23232is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23233
23234
23235.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23236If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23237appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23238&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23239sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23240&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23241delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23242
23243.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23244In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23245necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23246achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23247file corruption.
23248
23249The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23250It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23251except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23252
23253
23254.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23255This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23256set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23257locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23258of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23259are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23260the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23261rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23262does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23263
23264You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23265&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23266MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23267without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23268
23269
23270
23271
23272.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23273.cindex "appending to a file"
23274.cindex "file" "appending"
23275Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23276
23277.ilist
23278If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23279return is given.
23280
23281.next
23282.cindex "directory creation"
23283If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23284&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23285&%directory_mode%& option.
23286
23287.next
23288If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23289indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23290transport.
23291
23292.next
23293.cindex "file" "locking"
23294.cindex "locking files"
23295.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23296If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23297reliably over NFS, as follows:
23298
23299.olist
23300Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23301current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23302as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23303.next
23304Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23305.next
23306If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23307Unlink the hitching post name.
23308.next
23309Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23310then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23311of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23312restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23313.next
23314If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23315up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23316mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23317lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23318existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23319it before trying again.
23320.endlist olist
23321
23322.next
23323A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23324so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23325than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23326
23327.next
23328.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23329.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23330If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23331&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23332checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23333is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23334ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23335directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23336idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23337checked.
23338
23339.next
23340If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23341and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23342different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23343delivery is deferred.
23344
23345.next
23346If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23347If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23348is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23349permissions.
23350
23351.next
23352The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23353If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23354hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23355
23356.next
23357If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23358changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23359have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23360
23361.next
23362If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23363option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23364directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23365open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23366except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23367set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23368the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23369that prevents link following.
23370
23371.next
23372.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23373If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23374existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23375being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23376after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23377
23378.next
23379If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23380
23381.next
23382.cindex "file" "locking"
23383.cindex "locking files"
23384Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23385are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23386&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23387However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23388file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23389.code
23390/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23391.endd
23392using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23393the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23394the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23395
23396If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23397depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23398&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23399
23400If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23401&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23402to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23403delivery is deferred.
23404
23405If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23406&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23407waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23408immediately. It retries up to
23409.code
23410(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23411.endd
23412times (rounded up).
23413.endlist
23414
23415At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23416and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23417
23418
23419.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23420.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23421.cindex "&""From""& line"
23422When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23423delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23424activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23425&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23426router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23427configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23428ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23429
23430No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23431locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23432separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23433of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23434newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23435&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23436any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23437
23438If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23439the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23440different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23441deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23442
23443
23444.cindex "maildir format"
23445.cindex "mailstore format"
23446There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23447done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23448&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23449formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23450SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23451
23452.cindex "directory creation"
23453In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23454sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23455option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23456constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23457the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23458&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23459deferred.
23460
23461
23462
23463.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23464.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23465If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23466it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23467directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23468directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23469&_new_& subdirectory.
23470
23471In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23472<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23473Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23474before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23475filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23476opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23477Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23478
23479Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23480called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23481do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23482path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23483&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23484contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23485&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23486&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23487
23488These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23489and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23490folders. Consider this example:
23491.code
23492maildir_format = true
23493directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23494 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23495 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23496maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23497.endd
23498If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23499delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23500the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23501not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23502&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23503&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23504
23505However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23506delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23507does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23508&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23509directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23510
23511&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23512not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23513&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23514
23515.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23516.cindex "maildir++"
23517If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23518&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23519the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23520Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23521down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23522the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23523amount of space used.
23524
23525One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23526computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23527checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23528needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23529use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23530of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23531
23532
23533
23534
23535.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23536If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23537When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23538tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23539name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23540the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23541
23542
23543.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23544Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23545&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23546happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23547variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23548forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23549be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23550Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23551empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23552colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23553maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23554backwards compatibility).
23555
23556For one common implementation, you might set:
23557.code
23558maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23559.endd
23560but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23561
23562It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23563as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23564&[stat()]& each message file.
23565
23566
23567.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23568.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23569.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23570If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23571storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23572within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23573creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23574the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23575to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23576
23577The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23578messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23579in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23580value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23581is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23582need to know the quota.
23583
23584If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23585file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23586
23587A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23588maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23589See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23590details.
23591
23592
23593.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23594.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23595If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23596files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23597message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23598this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23599contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23600itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23601
23602During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23603&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23604&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23605mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23606file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23607the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23608
23609The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23610option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23611the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23612There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23613greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23614appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23615
23616If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23617failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23618configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23619&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23620
23621
23622.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23623If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23624file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23625messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23626section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23627.code
23628directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23629.endd
23630might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23631then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23632expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23633.ecindex IIDapptra1
23634.ecindex IIDapptra2
23635
23636
23637
23638
23639
23640
23641. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23642. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23643
23644.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23645.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23646.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23647The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23648the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23649automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23650&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23651to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23652
23653If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23654&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23655delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23656that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23657another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23658
23659
23660The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23661&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23662directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23663message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23664empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23665
23666The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23667by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23668passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23669transport is run as a consequence of a
23670&%mail%&
23671or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23672supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23673that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23674case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23675is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23676&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23677
23678&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23679command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23680gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23681&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23682
23683There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23684that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23685&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23686address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23687separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23688the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23689message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23690
23691Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23692message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23693immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23694the transport defers.
23695Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23696controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23697
23698If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23699&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23700of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23701&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23702
23703.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23704If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23705the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23706as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23707is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23708problems. They are just discarded.
23709
23710
23711
23712.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23713.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23714
23715.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23716This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23717message when the message is specified by the transport.
23718
23719
23720.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23721This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23722when the message is specified by the transport.
23723
23724
23725.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23726The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23727is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23728string comes first.
23729
23730
23731.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23732If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23733subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23734
23735
23736.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23737If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23738option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23739
23740
23741.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23742This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23743specified by the transport.
23744
23745
23746.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23747This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23748when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23749&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23750
23751
23752.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23753This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23754the message is specified by the transport.
23755
23756
23757.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23758If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23759used.
23760
23761
23762.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23763If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23764item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23765discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23766generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23767
23768
23769
23770.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23771This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23772recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23773This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23774
23775If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23776By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23777is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23778However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23779message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23780this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23781prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23782infinity.
23783
23784If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23785and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23786greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23787Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23788regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23789
23790In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23791which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23792be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23793means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23794unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23795file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23796
23797
23798.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23799See &%once%& above.
23800
23801
23802.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23803See &%once%& above.
23804After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23805
23806
23807.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23808This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23809specified by the transport.
23810
23811
23812.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23813If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23814message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23815configuration option.
23816
23817
23818.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23819This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23820specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23821automatic responses. For example:
23822.code
23823subject = Re: $h_subject:
23824.endd
23825There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23826subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23827bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23828non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23829small.
23830
23831
23832
23833.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23834This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23835message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23836the text comes first.
23837
23838
23839.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23840This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23841when the message is specified by the transport.
23842.ecindex IIDauttra1
23843.ecindex IIDauttra2
23844
23845
23846
23847
23848. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23849. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23850
23851.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23852.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23853.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23854.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23855.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23856The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23857specified command
23858or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23859This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23860transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23861implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23862to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23863has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23864.code
23865TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23866.endd
23867.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23868is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23869included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23870as follows:
23871
23872.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23873See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23874
23875
23876.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23877This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23878Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23879good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23880batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23881
23882
23883.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23884This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23885is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23886arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23887number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23888is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23889LMTP protocol.
23890
23891.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23892.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23893If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23894commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23895in its response to the LHLO command.
23896
23897.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23898This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23899be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23900delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23901
23902
23903.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23904The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23905respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23906is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23907LMTP transport:
23908.code
23909lmtp:
23910 driver = lmtp
23911 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23912 batch_max = 20
23913 user = exim
23914.endd
23915This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23916necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23917
23918
23919
23920. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23921. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23922
23923.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23924.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23925.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23926The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23927running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23928pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23929(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23930their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23931following ways:
23932
23933.ilist
23934.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23935A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23936transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23937contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23938is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23939.next
23940.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23941If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23942transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23943more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23944(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23945(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23946that are routed to the transport.
23947.next
23948.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23949A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23950alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23951pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23952&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23953(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23954this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23955.endlist
23956
23957
23958The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23959deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23960implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23961
23962In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23963&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23964other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23965transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23966directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23967details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23968for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23969
23970.new
23971.cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
23972.cindex pipe "tainted data"
23973Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
23974.wen
23975
23976
23977.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23978If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23979delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23980any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23981write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23982Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23983of "1" to enforce serialization.
23984
23985
23986
23987
23988.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23989.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23990If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23991have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23992the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23993in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23994later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23995logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23996&"local delivery failed"&.
23997
23998If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23999the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24000will be sent as normal.
24001
24002If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24003script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24004value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24005apply in this case.
24006
24007If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24008return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24009asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24010a non-existent command may be the problem.
24011
24012The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24013set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24014error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24015return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24016included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24017similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24018failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24019&%temp_errors%&.
24020
24021
24022
24023.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24024.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24025The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24026by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24027&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24028run.
24029
24030.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24031Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24032double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24033way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24034
24035String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24036traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24037expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24038For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24039quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24040.code
24041command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24042.endd
24043will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24044arguments. You have to write
24045.code
24046command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24047.endd
24048to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24049argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24050result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24051interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24052generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24053expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24054example:
24055.code
24056command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24057.endd
24058
24059.cindex "transport" "filter"
24060.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24061.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24062Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24063&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24064This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24065place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24066transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24067inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24068avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24069&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24070
24071If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24072for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24073is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24074argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24075&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24076the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24077should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24078run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24079
24080After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24081in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24082message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24083standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24084read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24085may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24086control what is done with it.
24087
24088Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24089in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24090taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24091explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24092where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24093under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24094an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24095works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24096as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24097&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24098with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24099
24100
24101
24102.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24103.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24104.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24105The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24106This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24107the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24108environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24109to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24110.display
24111&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24112&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24113&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24114&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24115&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24116&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24117&`LOGNAME `& see below
24118&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24119&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24120&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24121&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24122&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24123&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24124&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24125&`USER `& see below
24126.endd
24127When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24128router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24129called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24130the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24131removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24132LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24133same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24134
24135.cindex "HOST"
24136HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24137associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24138pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24139the router.
24140
24141.cindex "HOME"
24142If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24143for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24144by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24145user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24146
24147
24148.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24149.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24150
24151
24152
24153.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24154.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24155The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24156permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24157permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24158paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24159&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24160in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24161the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24162&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24163otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24164example, if
24165.code
24166allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24167.endd
24168and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24169&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24170&%use_shell%& is set.
24171
24172
24173.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24174See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24175
24176
24177.option batch_max pipe integer 1
24178This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24179See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24180
24181
24182.option check_string pipe string unset
24183As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24184&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24185by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24186&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24187any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24188of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24189the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24190ignored.
24191
24192
24193.option command pipe string&!! unset
24194This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24195obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24196set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24197the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24198Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24199&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24200
24201
24202.option environment pipe string&!! unset
24203.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24204.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24205This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24206command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24207a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24208environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24209
24210
24211.option escape_string pipe string unset
24212See &%check_string%& above.
24213
24214
24215.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24216.cindex "exec failure"
24217.cindex "failure of exec"
24218.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24219Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24220any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24221is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24222frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24223
24224
24225.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24226.cindex "signal exit"
24227.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24228Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24229a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24230frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24231
24232
24233.option force_command pipe boolean false
24234.cindex "force command"
24235.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24236Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24237the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24238is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24239useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24240command. For example:
24241.code
24242command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24243force_command
24244.endd
24245
24246Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24247&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24248separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24249
24250
24251.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24252If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24253run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24254Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24255from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24256&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24257
24258&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24259See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24260
24261
24262.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24263.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24264If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24265one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24266and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24267written to the main log.
24268
24269
24270.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24271If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24272stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24273the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24274failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24275option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24276be set.
24277
24278
24279.option log_output pipe boolean false
24280If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24281stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24282the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24283exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24284
24285
24286.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24287This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24288standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24289process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24290catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24291the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24292&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24293exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24294
24295
24296.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24297The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24298The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24299.code
24300message_prefix = \
24301 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24302 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24303.endd
24304.cindex "Cyrus"
24305.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24306.cindex "&""From""& line"
24307This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24308However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24309or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24310setting
24311.code
24312message_prefix =
24313.endd
24314&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24315&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24316
24317
24318.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24319The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24320The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24321The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24322.code
24323message_suffix =
24324.endd
24325&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24326&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24327
24328
24329.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24330This option is expanded and
24331specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24332variable of the subprocess.
24333If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24334sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24335apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24336
24337
24338.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24339Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24340a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24341during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24342It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24343for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24344resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24345installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24346of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24347
24348
24349.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24350.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24351If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24352process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24353to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24354&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24355accept the message is used.
24356
24357
24358.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24359When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24360contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24361in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24362command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24363handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24364
24365
24366.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24367If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24368return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24369is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24370However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24371message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24372&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24373
24374
24375
24376.option return_output pipe boolean false
24377If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24378deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24379is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24380However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24381output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24382option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24383of them may be set.
24384
24385
24386
24387.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24388.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24389This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24390asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24391and &%return_output%& is not set,
24392and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24393temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24394numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24395codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24396defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24397compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24398and 73, respectively.
24399
24400
24401.option timeout pipe time 1h
24402If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24403causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24404specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24405command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24406and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24407if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24408
24409.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24410A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24411runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24412treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24413is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24414delivery to be deferred.
24415
24416.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24417This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24418
24419
24420.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24421.cindex "envelope sender"
24422If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24423SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24424commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24425you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24426&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24427
24428.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24429.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24430This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24431BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24432resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24433limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24434class database.
24435
24436
24437.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24438.cindex "carriage return"
24439.cindex "linefeed"
24440This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24441(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24442of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24443of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24444
24445The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24446written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24447are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24448&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24449values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24450
24451
24452.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24453.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24454If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24455instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24456&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24457where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24458modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24459&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24460command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24461its &%-c%& option.
24462
24463
24464
24465.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24466.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24467.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24468.cindex "external local delivery"
24469.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24470.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24471The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24472delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24473this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24474uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24475by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24476necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24477appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24478configuration for &%procmail%&:
24479.code
24480# transport
24481procmail_pipe:
24482 driver = pipe
24483 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24484 return_path_add
24485 delivery_date_add
24486 envelope_to_add
24487 check_string = "From "
24488 escape_string = ">From "
24489 umask = 077
24490 user = $local_part
24491 group = mail
24492
24493# router
24494procmail:
24495 driver = accept
24496 check_local_user
24497 transport = procmail_pipe
24498.endd
24499In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24500&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24501or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24502user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24503&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24504home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24505
24506&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24507.code
24508IFS=" "
24509.endd
24510as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24511use a shell to run pipe commands.
24512
24513.cindex "Cyrus"
24514The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24515deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24516.code
24517# transport
24518local_delivery_cyrus:
24519 driver = pipe
24520 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24521 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24522 user = cyrus
24523 group = mail
24524 return_output
24525 log_output
24526 message_prefix =
24527 message_suffix =
24528
24529# router
24530local_user_cyrus:
24531 driver = accept
24532 check_local_user
24533 local_part_suffix = .*
24534 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24535.endd
24536Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24537&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24538sender.
24539.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24540.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24541
24542
24543. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24544. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24545
24546.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24547.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24548.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24549The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24550or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24551that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24552explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24553&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24554
24555
24556.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24557The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24558two ways:
24559
24560.ilist
24561If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24562routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24563that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24564the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24565does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24566value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24567section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24568.next
24569.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24570When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24571looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24572connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24573for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24574process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24575process.
24576.endlist
24577
24578
24579For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24580incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24581no further messages are sent over that connection.
24582
24583
24584
24585.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24586.vindex "&$host$&"
24587.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24588At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24589&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24590passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24591specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24592&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24593that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24594&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24595
24596
24597.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24598.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24599.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24600.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24601.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24602At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24603&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24604are the values that were set when the message was received.
24605These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24606SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24607variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24608appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24609are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24610&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24611
24612These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24613and will be removed in a future release.
24614
24615
24616.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24617.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24618The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24619
24620
24621.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24622.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24623When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24624is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24625runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24626reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24627setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24628problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24629
24630.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24631.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24632.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24633When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24634to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24635deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24636the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24637configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24638configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24639
24640
24641.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24642.cindex "Cyrus"
24643When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24644is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24645overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24646forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24647to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24648ignored.
24649
24650The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24651started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24652&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24653particular connection.
24654
24655If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24656&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24657deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24658unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24659
24660This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24661deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24662&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24663.code
24664authenticated_sender = $local_part
24665.endd
24666This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24667allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24668
24669Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24670domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24671value.
24672
24673
24674.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24675If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24676is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24677authenticated as a client.
24678
24679
24680.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24681This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24682sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24683remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24684
24685
24686.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24687This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24688to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24689several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24690less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24691systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24692option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24693
24694
24695.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24696.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24697.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24698.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24699This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24700over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24701For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24702option.
24703
24704
24705.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24706.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24707.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24708.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24709This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24710where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24711If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24712Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24713configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24714been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24715TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24716counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24717If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24718be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24719
24720
24721.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24722This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24723the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24724of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24725
24726
24727.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24728DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24729.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24730DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24731.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24732DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24733.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24734DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24735.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24736DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24737.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24738DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24739.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24740DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24741.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24742DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24743.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24744DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24745
24746
24747.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24748.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24749.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24750This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24751domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24752cutoff times.
24753
24754In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24755them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24756Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24757retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24758a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24759unhappy at this prospect, so...
24760
24761If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24762addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24763IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24764none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24765delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24766addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24767continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24768&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24769to them.
24770
24771
24772.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24773If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24774and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24775the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24776in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24777
24778
24779.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24780If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24781&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24782See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24783details.
24784
24785
24786.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24787.cindex "MX record" "security"
24788.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24789.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24790.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24791DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24792the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24793transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24794router option.
24795
24796
24797
24798.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24799.cindex "MX record" "security"
24800.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24801.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24802.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24803DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24804the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24805useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24806&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24807
24808
24809
24810.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24811.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24812This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24813of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24814The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24815Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24816&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24817
24818The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24819(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24820that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24821equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24822Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24823
24824
24825.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24826.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24827String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24828colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24829port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24830&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24831item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24832in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24833
24834Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24835addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24836&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24837not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24838&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24839However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24840
24841If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24842the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24843transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24844address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24845list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24846
24847Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24848re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24849addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24850copy of the message is sent.
24851
24852The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24853&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24854both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24855from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24856fails"& facility.
24857
24858
24859.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24860This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24861line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24862zero.
24863
24864.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24865If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24866being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24867(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24868instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24869it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24870
24871.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24872This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24873server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24874implementations of TLS.
24875
24876.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24877.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24878.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24879.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24880The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24881been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24882command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24883option is:
24884.code
24885$primary_hostname
24886.endd
24887During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24888the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24889&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24890used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24891servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24892that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24893interface address, you could use this:
24894.code
24895helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24896 {$primary_hostname}}
24897.endd
24898The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24899callouts.
24900
24901.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24902Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24903finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24904&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24905email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24906all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24907
24908The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24909processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24910&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24911&%hosts_override%& is set.
24912
24913The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24914list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24915separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24916&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24917item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24918in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24919of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24920
24921If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24922the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24923well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24924address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24925&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24926&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24927that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24928address are used.
24929
24930During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24931unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24932
24933
24934.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24935.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24936.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24937.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24938.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24939This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24940example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24941matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24942start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24943facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24944
24945
24946.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24947.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24948Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24949that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24950
24951.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24952.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24953.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24954If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24955this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24956and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24957
24958The retry hints database is used for the record,
24959and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24960When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24961It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24962so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24963
24964See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24965
24966Note:
24967When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24968will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24969is filled in.
24970A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24971presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24972can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24973You have been warned.
24974
24975
24976.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24977.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24978Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24979matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24980
24981.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24982.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24983Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24984or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24985to any host that matches this list.
24986
24987
24988.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24989.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24990.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24991.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24992.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24993This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24994delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24995&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24996
24997
24998.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24999This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25000tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25001why it exists.
25002
25003
25004
25005.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25006.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25007.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25008.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25009For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25010been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25011message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25012explanation of when this might be needed.
25013
25014.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25015.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25016.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25017.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25018For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25019been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25020message on the same session.
25021
25022The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25023process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25024sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25025instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25026the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25027The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25028logging.
25029
25030
25031
25032.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25033If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25034attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25035&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25036&%fallback_hosts%&.
25037
25038
25039.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25040.cindex "randomized host list"
25041.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25042.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25043If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25044&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25045were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25046router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25047is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25048list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25049
25050When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25051order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25052behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25053&`+`& in the host list. For example:
25054.code
25055hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25056.endd
25057The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25058randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25059If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25060
25061.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25062.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25063This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25064before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25065servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25066authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25067temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25068hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25069&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25070
25071
25072.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
25073.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25074Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25075TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25076&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25077
25078.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25079.cindex DANE "transport options"
25080.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25081If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25082TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25083and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25084the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25085There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25086See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25087
25088.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25089.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25090Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25091TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25092&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25093
25094.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25095.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25096Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25097matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25098&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25099incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25100
25101.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25102.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25103This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25104authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25105connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
25106unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
25107&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25108
25109.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25110.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25111.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25112.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25113This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25114CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25115.new
25116Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25117.wen
25118BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25119
25120.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25121.cindex DANE "transport options"
25122.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25123If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25124TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25125and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25126the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25127There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25128See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25129
25130.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25131.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25132.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25133.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25134This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25135the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25136perform a TCP Fast Open.
25137No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25138supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25139the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25140
25141The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25142as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25143
25144On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25145in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25146There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25147it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25148such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25149
25150.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25151.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25152This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25153PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25154for multi-recipient messages.
25155The option can usually be left as default.
25156
25157.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25158.cindex "bind IP address"
25159.cindex "IP address" "binding"
25160.vindex "&$host$&"
25161.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25162This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25163call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25164&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25165message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25166&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25167outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25168interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25169unknown.
25170
25171During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25172&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25173during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25174string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25175string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25176separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25177For example:
25178.code
25179interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25180.endd
25181The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25182connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25183&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25184interface to use if the host has more than one.
25185
25186
25187.option keepalive smtp boolean true
25188.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25189This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25190connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25191periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25192of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25193or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25194that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25195that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25196TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25197unreachable hosts.
25198
25199
25200.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25201.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25202If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25203string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25204has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25205
25206.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25207.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25208This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25209SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25210so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25211permits this.
25212
25213
25214.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25215.vindex "&$domain$&"
25216When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25217addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25218to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25219handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25220&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25221is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25222
25223It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25224&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25225&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25226
25227.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25228.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25229.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25230This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25231&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25232received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25233The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25234variable that contains an outgoing port.
25235
25236If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25237otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25238normally &"smtp"&,
25239but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25240and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25241If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25242is deferred.
25243
25244Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25245to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25246
25247
25248
25249.option protocol smtp string smtp
25250.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25251.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25252.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25253.vindex "&$port$&"
25254If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25255the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25256protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25257deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25258over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25259
25260If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25261changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25262connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25263The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25264but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25265(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25266
25267
25268.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25269Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25270constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25271means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25272tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25273addresses is not affected.
25274
25275However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25276each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25277the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25278Exim to use only the host name.
25279Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25280
25281
25282.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25283.cindex "serializing connections"
25284.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25285Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25286host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25287the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25288slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25289Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25290&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25291
25292.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25293Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25294written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25295is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25296records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25297guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25298
25299If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25300relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25301start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25302may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25303are used for ETRN serialization.
25304
25305See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25306
25307
25308.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25309.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25310.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25311.cindex "size" "of message"
25312.cindex "transport" "filter"
25313.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25314If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25315MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25316an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25317sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25318configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25319this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25320
25321Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25322the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25323
25324
25325.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25326.cindex proxy SOCKS
25327This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25328transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25329
25330
25331.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25332.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25333.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25334.vindex "&$host$&"
25335.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25336The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25337client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25338connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25339address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25340details of TLS.
25341
25342&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25343certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25344name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25345assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25346client.
25347
25348
25349.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25350.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25351.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25352This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25353be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25354
25355
25356.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25357.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25358When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25359key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25360for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25361If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25362will fail.
25363
25364Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25365
25366
25367.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25368.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25369.vindex "&$host$&"
25370.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25371The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25372client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25373connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25374&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25375expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25376result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25377the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25378
25379
25380.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25381.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25382.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25383.vindex "&$host$&"
25384.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25385The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25386when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25387the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25388&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25389expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25390is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25391&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25392ciphers is a preference order.
25393
25394
25395
25396.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25397.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25398.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25399If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25400TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25401the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25402certificate and private key for the session.
25403
25404See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25405
25406Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25407TLS extensions.
25408
25409
25410
25411
25412.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25413.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25414When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25415setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25416to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25417current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25418option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25419response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25420TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25421unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25422in clear.
25423
25424
25425.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25426.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25427.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25428This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25429certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25430The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25431Note that unless the host is in this list
25432TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25433when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25434The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25435certificate verification succeeds.
25436
25437
25438.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25439.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25440.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25441This option give a list of hosts for which,
25442while verifying the server certificate,
25443checks will be included on the host name
25444(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25445versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25446limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25447
25448There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25449
25450
25451.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25452.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25453.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25454.vindex "&$host$&"
25455.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25456The value of this option must be either the
25457word "system"
25458or the absolute path to
25459a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25460for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25461
25462The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25463This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25464is taken as empty and an explicit location
25465must be specified.
25466
25467The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25468preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25469
25470With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25471explicitly
25472either by file or directory
25473are added to those given by the system default location.
25474
25475The values of &$host$& and
25476&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25477expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25478
25479For back-compatibility,
25480if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25481(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25482and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25483
25484
25485.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25486.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25487.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25488This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25489certificate verification must succeed.
25490The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25491If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25492operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25493
25494.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25495.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25496.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25497If built with internationalization support,
25498this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25499to a-label form.
25500For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25501
25502
25503
25504
25505.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25506 "SECTvalhosmax"
25507.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25508.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25509There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25510tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25511&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25512
25513
25514The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25515for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25516option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25517multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25518retrying.
25519
25520Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25521multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25522created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25523
25524Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25525several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25526problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25527&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25528delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25529
25530Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25531arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25532limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25533some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25534&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25535that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25536see below for an exception).
25537
25538Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25539list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25540If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25541but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25542that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25543
25544Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25545higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25546hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25547which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25548tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25549reached their retry times.
25550
25551However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25552large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25553Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25554of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25555time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25556without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25557all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25558there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25559the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25560every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25561reached.
25562
25563The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25564particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25565out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25566reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25567been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25568take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25569
25570The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25571Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25572and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25573possible IP addresses have been tried.
25574.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25575.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25576
25577
25578
25579
25580
25581. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25582. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25583
25584.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25585.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25586There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25587addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25588(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25589abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25590
25591Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25592messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25593&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25594appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25595locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25596unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25597lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25598
25599One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25600when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25601such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25602do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25603
25604
25605.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25606This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25607main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25608&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25609
25610Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25611Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25612facility; you do not have to use it.
25613
25614The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25615configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25616addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25617address to which it applies.
25618
25619Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25620the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25621rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25622those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25623by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25624are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25625rules.
25626
25627Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25628applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25629well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25630headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25631
25632
25633In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25634legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25635in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25636used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25637Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25638discouraged.
25639
25640There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25641illustrated by these examples:
25642
25643.ilist
25644The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25645exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25646gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25647&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25648.next
25649A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25650&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25651.endlist
25652
25653
25654
25655.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25656.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25657.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25658Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25659message's processing.
25660
25661.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25662At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25663by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25664ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25665is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25666rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25667rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25668RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25669rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25670
25671.vindex "&$domain$&"
25672.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25673Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25674may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25675rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25676from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25677for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25678value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25679as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25680SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25681
25682As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25683recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25684the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25685any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25686.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25687before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25688
25689When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25690rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25691redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25692
25693.cindex "envelope from"
25694.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25695.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25696.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25697At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25698specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25699This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25700section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25701header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25702applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25703
25704The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25705transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25706transport time.
25707
25708
25709
25710
25711.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25712.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25713.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25714Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25715configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25716&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
257172822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25718transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25719appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25720envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25721.code
25722exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25723.endd
25724might produce the output
25725.code
25726sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25727from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25728to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25729cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25730bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25731reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25732env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25733env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25734.endd
25735which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25736the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25737present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25738set for a particular transport.
25739
25740
25741.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25742.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25743The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25744rules in the form
25745.display
25746<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25747.endd
25748Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25749transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25750takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25751any colons must be doubled, of course).
25752
25753The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25754Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25755case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25756characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25757ignored.
25758
25759For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25760order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25761replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25762
25763The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25764releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25765received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25766lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25767address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25768(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25769that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25770
25771.vindex "&$domain$&"
25772.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25773The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25774string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25775rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25776.code
25777*@* ${lookup ...
25778.endd
25779where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25780refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25781
25782
25783.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25784.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25785.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25786The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25787address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25788single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25789against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25790you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25791facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25792
25793Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25794case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25795can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25796
25797.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25798After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25799depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25800replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25801refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25802numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25803of pattern they are set as follows:
25804
25805.ilist
25806If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25807refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25808the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25809pattern
25810.code
25811*queen@*.fict.example
25812.endd
25813is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25814.code
25815$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25816$1 = hearts-
25817$2 = wonderland
25818.endd
25819Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25820does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25821
25822.next
25823If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25824of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25825for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25826rewriting rule of the form
25827.display
25828&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25829.endd
25830and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25831.code
25832$1 = foo
25833$2 = bar
25834$3 = baz.example
25835.endd
25836If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25837wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25838&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25839partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25840whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25841.endlist
25842
25843
25844.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25845.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25846If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25847match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25848rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25849.code
25850hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25851.endd
25852specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25853&'From:'& headers.
25854
25855.vindex "&$domain$&"
25856.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25857If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25858yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25859&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25860Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25861cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25862matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25863the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25864current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25865expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25866entry written to the panic log.
25867
25868
25869
25870.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25871There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25872
25873.ilist
25874Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25875c, f, h, r, s, t.
25876.next
25877A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25878.next
25879Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25880.endlist
25881
25882For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25883E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25884
25885
25886
25887.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25888 "SECID154"
25889.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25890If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25891&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25892and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25893transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25894rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25895.display
25896&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25897&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25898&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25899&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25900&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25901&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25902&`h`& rewrite all headers
25903&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25904&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25905&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25906.endd
25907"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25908individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25909other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25910
25911You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25912restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25913
25914
25915.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25916.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25917.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25918.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25919The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25920SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25921before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25922required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25923data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25924
25925.vindex "&$domain$&"
25926.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25927This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25928compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25929input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25930the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25931expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25932original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25933
25934
25935.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25936There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25937take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25938correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25939
25940.ilist
25941If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25942unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25943absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25944.next
25945If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25946even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25947expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25948(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25949.next
25950The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25951address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25952rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25953.next
25954.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25955When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25956to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25957left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25958.code
25959From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25960.endd
25961into
25962.code
25963From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25964.endd
25965.cindex "RFC 2047"
25966Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25967done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25968causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25969replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
259702822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25971brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25972(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25973is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25974
25975When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25976rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25977.endlist
25978
25979
25980.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25981Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25982.code
25983*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25984*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25985 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25986.endd
25987Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25988the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25989has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25990consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25991present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25992explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25993at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25994error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25995
25996The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25997domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25998.code
25999root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26000.endd
26001were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26002local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26003
26004Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26005&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26006messages that originate outside the local host:
26007.code
26008*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26009 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26010.endd
26011The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26012space.
26013
26014.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26015.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26016Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26017an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26018the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26019remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26020sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26021components. For example, the rule
26022.code
26023\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26024.endd
26025rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26026&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26027a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26028method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26029to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26030use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26031can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26032.ecindex IIDaddrew
26033
26034
26035
26036
26037
26038. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26039. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26040
26041.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26042.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26043.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26044The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26045retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26046be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26047empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26048errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26049general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26050line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26051address, domain and error.
26052
26053The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26054host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26055Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26056address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26057been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26058tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26059log selector is set, the message
26060.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26061&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26062skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26063the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26064
26065Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26066in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26067actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26068failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26069the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26070added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26071same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26072domain are maintained independently.
26073
26074When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26075receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26076always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26077behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26078quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26079suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26080subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26081the local address is reached.
26082
26083.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26084If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26085whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26086files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26087always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26088
26089The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26090rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26091record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26092timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26093and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26094messages that it should now be retaining.
26095
26096
26097
26098.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26099.cindex "retry" "rules"
26100Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26101separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26102addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26103enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26104in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26105present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26106message's sender, respectively.
26107
26108
26109The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26110&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26111which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26112has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26113list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26114which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26115example,
26116.code
26117lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26118.endd
26119provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26120whereas
26121.code
26122alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26123.endd
26124applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26125In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26126part.
26127
26128.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26129&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26130must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26131expressions work in address lists.
26132.display
26133&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26134&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26135.endd
26136
26137
26138.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26139When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26140example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26141against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26142router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26143regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26144A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26145&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26146&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26147
26148Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26149failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26150configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26151&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26152local transports).
26153
26154.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26155However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26156suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26157whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26158rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26159failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26160recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26161reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26162&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26163lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26164commands.
26165
26166
26167
26168.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26169 "SECID160"
26170For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26171example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26172twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26173&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26174the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26175suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26176.code
26177a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26178 MX 6 p.q.r.example
26179 MX 7 m.n.o.example
26180.endd
26181and the retry rules are
26182.code
26183p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26184a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26185.endd
26186and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26187first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26188rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26189to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26190tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26191first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26192
26193In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26194first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26195&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26196routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26197
26198&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26199However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26200host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26201.code
26202route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26203.endd
26204then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26205textual form of the IP address.
26206
26207.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26208.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26209The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26210asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26211
26212.vlist
26213.vitem &%auth_failed%&
26214Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26215&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26216
26217.vitem &%data_4xx%&
26218A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26219after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26220
26221.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26222A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26223
26224.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26225A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26226.endlist
26227
26228For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26229as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26230recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26231and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26232retry rule of this form:
26233.code
26234the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26235.endd
26236These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26237LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26238
26239.vlist
26240.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26241A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26242legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26243for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26244
26245.vitem &%lookup%&
26246A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26247Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26248its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26249Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26250its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26251
26252.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26253A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26254
26255.vitem &%refused_A%&
26256A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26257
26258.vitem &%refused%&
26259A connection was refused.
26260
26261.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26262A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26263
26264.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26265A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26266
26267.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26268A connection attempt timed out.
26269
26270.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26271There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26272obtained from an MX record.
26273
26274.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26275There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26276obtained from an MX record.
26277
26278.vitem &%timeout%&
26279There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26280
26281.vitem &%tls_required%&
26282The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26283&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26284to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26285
26286.vitem &%quota%&
26287A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26288transport.
26289
26290.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26291.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26292.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26293A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26294transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26295&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26296for four days.
26297.endlist
26298
26299.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26300The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26301timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26302it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26303However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26304heuristic rules:
26305
26306.ilist
26307If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26308used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26309quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26310.next
26311.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26312For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26313subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26314the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26315change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26316MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26317time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26318.next
26319For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26320obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26321.endlist
26322
26323The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26324mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26325when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26326error).
26327
26328
26329
26330.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26331.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26332You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26333specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26334apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26335form:
26336.display
26337&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26338.endd
26339The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26340.code
26341* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26342.endd
26343matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26344host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26345For example:
26346.code
26347a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26348.endd
26349&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26350(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26351only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26352its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26353all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26354
26355When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26356&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26357.code
26358exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26359.endd
26360If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26361list is never matched.
26362
26363
26364
26365
26366
26367.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26368.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26369The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26370sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26371.display
26372<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26373.endd
26374The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26375time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26376arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26377time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26378relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26379
26380.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26381.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26382.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26383.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26384The available algorithms are:
26385
26386.ilist
26387&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26388the interval.
26389.next
26390&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26391specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26392is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26393.next
26394&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26395retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26396maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26397the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26398rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26399members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26400queue processing times.
26401.endlist
26402
26403When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26404order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26405used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26406case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26407current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26408computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26409interval is found. The main configuration variable
26410.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26411.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26412.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26413&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26414cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26415
26416A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26417host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26418basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26419for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26420generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26421time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26422time.
26423
26424.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26425Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26426run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26427starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26428new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26429If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26430occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26431messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26432processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26433your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26434number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26435sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26436
26437The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26438&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26439&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26440&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26441are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26442deliveries that have been deferred.
26443
26444
26445.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26446Here are some example retry rules:
26447.code
26448alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26449wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26450wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26451lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26452* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26453* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26454.endd
26455The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26456&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26457mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26458hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26459parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26460effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26461fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26462days.
26463
26464The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26465happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26466intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26467first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26468so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26469
26470The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26471They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26472all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26473were not obtained from an MX record.
26474
26475The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26476first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26477not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26478hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
264791.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26480
26481
26482
26483.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26484.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26485.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26486.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26487.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26488Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26489consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26490set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26491been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26492arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26493failing for the first time.
26494
26495This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26496backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26497Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26498down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26499
26500If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26501every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26502message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26503
26504
26505
26506
26507.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26508.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26509.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26510Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26511that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26512default retry rule:
26513.code
26514* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26515.endd
26516the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26517long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26518failure for the recipient address that counts.
26519
26520When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26521addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26522causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26523In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26524time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26525
26526For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26527messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26528post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26529
26530.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26531.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26532If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26533.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26534&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26535default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26536as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26537reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26538attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26539those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26540the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26541
26542In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26543for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26544times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26545behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26546to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26547notice.
26548
26549If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26550addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26551addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26552no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26553words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26554addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26555If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26556&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26557deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26558true.
26559
26560.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26561.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26562Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26563intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26564its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26565because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26566host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26567failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26568reached.
26569
26570Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26571applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26572Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26573examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26574commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26575time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26576is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26577time out the address.
26578
26579The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26580the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26581given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26582time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26583not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26584considered immediately.
26585.ecindex IIDretconf1
26586.ecindex IIDregconf2
26587
26588
26589
26590
26591
26592
26593. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26594. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26595
26596.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26597.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26598.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26599The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26600with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26601described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26602to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26603permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26604transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26605other.
26606
26607.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26608Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26609
26610.ilist
26611The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26612the client's EHLO command.
26613.next
26614The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26615may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26616.next
26617The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26618appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26619just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26620any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26621with the AUTH command.
26622.next
26623The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26624.next
26625If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26626option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26627mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26628connection.
26629.next
26630If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26631authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26632unauthenticated connection.
26633.endlist
26634
26635If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26636mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26637SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26638includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26639.display
26640&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26641&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26642&`Connected to server.example.`&
26643&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26644&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26645&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26646&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26647&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26648&`250-PIPELINING`&
26649&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26650&`250 HELP`&
26651.endd
26652The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26653authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26654mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26655routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26656controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26657included by setting
26658.code
26659AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26660AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26661AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26662AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26663AUTH_GSASL=yes
26664AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26665AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26666AUTH_SPA=yes
26667AUTH_TLS=yes
26668.endd
26669in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26670authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26671the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26672The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26673work via a socket interface.
26674The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26675as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26676The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26677provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26678The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26679supporting setting a server keytab.
26680The seventh can be configured to support
26681the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26682not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26683The eighth authenticator
26684supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26685The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26686instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26687
26688The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26689section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26690authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26691authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26692is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26693messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26694options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26695
26696To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26697&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26698either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26699functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26700to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26701both sets of options, is required. For example:
26702.code
26703cram:
26704 driver = cram_md5
26705 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26706 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26707 client_name = ph10
26708 client_secret = secret2
26709.endd
26710The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26711&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26712
26713Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26714The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26715authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26716in Exim.
26717
26718&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26719per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26720account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26721authenticating data.
26722
26723Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26724&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26725and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26726Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26727used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26728second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26729user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26730configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26731&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26732as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26733choose to honour.
26734
26735A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26736to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26737mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26738typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26739
26740
26741
26742.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26743.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26744.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26745
26746.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26747When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26748&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26749used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26750encrypted by a setting such as:
26751.code
26752client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26753.endd
26754
26755
26756.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26757When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26758result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26759Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26760
26761
26762.option driver authenticators string unset
26763This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26764authenticators is to be used.
26765
26766
26767.option public_name authenticators string unset
26768This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26769implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26770contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26771but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26772defaults to the driver's instance name.
26773
26774
26775.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26776When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26777is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26778mechanism is not advertised.
26779If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26780forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26781See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26782
26783
26784.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26785This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26786is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26787for details.
26788
26789For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26790mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26791
26792For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26793authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26794authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26795authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26796to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26797error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26798string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26799expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26800other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26801the error text.
26802
26803
26804.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26805If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26806command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26807output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26808out the values of variables.
26809If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26810output, and Exim carries on processing.
26811
26812
26813.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26814.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26815.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26816When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26817expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26818messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26819lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26820configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26821refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26822On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26823the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26824If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26825
26826
26827.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26828This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26829as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26830driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26831as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26832remembered for later use.
26833How it is used is described in the following section.
26834
26835
26836
26837
26838
26839.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26840.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26841.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26842When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26843the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26844message:
26845
26846.ilist
26847If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26848than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26849.next
26850If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26851.next
26852.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26853If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26854running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26855from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26856&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26857return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26858given for the MAIL command.
26859.next
26860If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26861is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26862authenticated.
26863.next
26864If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26865the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26866&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26867valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26868fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26869&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26870the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26871message.
26872.endlist
26873
26874
26875When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26876hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26877&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26878process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26879
26880.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26881Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26882MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26883therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26884value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26885ACL is run.
26886
26887
26888
26889.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26890.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26891When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26892authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26893conditions:
26894
26895.ilist
26896The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26897.next
26898It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26899yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26900.endlist
26901
26902The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26903the mechanisms are advertised.
26904
26905Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26906provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26907even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26908set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26909You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26910For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26911that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26912.code
26913auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26914.endd
26915so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26916
26917The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26918authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26919advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26920such as:
26921.code
26922server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26923.endd
26924.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26925If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26926yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26927
26928When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26929immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26930command. This is the case if
26931
26932.ilist
26933The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26934.next
26935No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26936.next
26937Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26938server authenticators.
26939.endlist
26940
26941
26942Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26943to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26944AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26945
26946If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26947server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26948that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26949the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26950fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26951rejected with a 504 error.
26952
26953.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26954.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26955When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26956&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26957or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26958public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26959client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26960no successful authentication.
26961
26962.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26963Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26964&%authresults%& expansion item.
26965
26966
26967
26968
26969.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26970.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26971.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26972.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26973Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26974configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26975encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26976script:
26977.code
26978use MIME::Base64;
26979printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26980.endd
26981.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26982This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26983interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26984some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26985command line to run this script on such data might be
26986.code
26987encode '\0user\0password'
26988.endd
26989Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26990backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26991whose code value is zero.
26992
26993&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26994digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26995you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26996interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26997
26998&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26999specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27000example, a command such as
27001.code
27002encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27003.endd
27004gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27005
27006If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
27007base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27008.code
27009echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27010.endd
27011The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27012in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27013output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27014should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27015
27016
27017
27018.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27019.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27020The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27021&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27022announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27023of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27024
27025.ilist
27026For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27027they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27028mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27029of the authenticator.
27030.next
27031.vindex "&$host$&"
27032.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27033When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27034variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27035that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27036any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27037Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27038delivery to be deferred.
27039.next
27040If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27041Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27042try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27043usual way.
27044.next
27045If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27046carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27047possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27048no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27049what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27050&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27051delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27052turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27053deliver the message unauthenticated.
27054.endlist
27055
27056Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27057confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27058upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27059router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27060the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27061running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27062check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27063No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27064
27065For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27066
27067.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27068When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27069parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27070the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27071is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27072incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27073allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27074to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27075&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27076&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27077the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27078.ecindex IIDauthconf1
27079.ecindex IIDauthconf2
27080
27081
27082
27083
27084
27085
27086. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27087. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27088
27089.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27090.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27091.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27092The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27093LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27094plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27095security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27096(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27097use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27098connections as you do for login accounts.
27099
27100.section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27101The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27102TLS is not being used:
27103.code
27104 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27105 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27106.endd
27107
27108&*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27109but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27110(including their names) have been properly verified.
27111
27112.section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27113.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27114When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27115
27116.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27117This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27118configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27119
27120.option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27121The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27122prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27123given.
27124
27125.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27126.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27127.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27128.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27129 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27130.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27131.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27132
27133When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27134expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27135response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27136values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27137a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27138are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27139(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27140
27141For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27142the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27143variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27144string expansions that also use them for other things.
27145
27146If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27147supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27148data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27149
27150.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27151Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27152&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27153authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27154to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27155&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27156expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27157generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27158For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27159string as the error text.
27160
27161&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27162password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27163There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27164
27165
27166
27167.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27168.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27169.cindex authentication PLAIN
27170.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27171The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27172sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27173separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27174subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27175
27176The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27177Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27178configured as follows:
27179.code
27180fixed_plain:
27181 driver = plaintext
27182 public_name = PLAIN
27183 server_prompts = :
27184 server_condition = \
27185 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27186 server_set_id = $auth2
27187.endd
27188Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27189are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27190password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27191or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27192
27193The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27194the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27195AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27196authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27197.code
27198250-AUTH PLAIN
27199.endd
27200and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27201.code
27202AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27203.endd
27204As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27205data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27206.code
27207AUTH PLAIN
27208.endd
27209to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27210prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27211
27212The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27213when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27214represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27215is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27216second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27217
27218Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27219realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27220authenticating clients it could make sense.
27221
27222A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27223&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27224comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27225this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27226This is an incorrect example:
27227.code
27228server_condition = \
27229 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27230.endd
27231The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27232which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27233incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27234non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27235strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27236the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27237name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27238.code
27239server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27240 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27241.endd
27242In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27243fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27244used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27245always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27246writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27247
27248
27249.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27250.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27251.cindex authentication LOGIN
27252The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27253in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27254user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27255plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27256.code
27257fixed_login:
27258 driver = plaintext
27259 public_name = LOGIN
27260 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27261 server_condition = \
27262 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27263 server_set_id = $auth1
27264.endd
27265Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27266with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27267if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27268strings are used to obtain two data items.
27269
27270Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27271example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27272&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27273strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27274name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27275.code
27276login:
27277 driver = plaintext
27278 public_name = LOGIN
27279 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27280 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27281 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27282 ldapauth{\
27283 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27284 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27285 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27286 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27287.endd
27288We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27289does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27290operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27291&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27292correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27293the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27294uninterpreted string.
27295
27296
27297.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27298A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27299interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27300traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27301Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27302&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27303
27304
27305
27306
27307.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27308.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27309The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27310
27311.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27312If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27313authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27314the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27315usual.
27316
27317.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27318The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27319string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27320string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27321to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27322most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27323with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27324way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27325(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27326so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27327&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27328&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27329
27330&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27331splitting takes priority and happens first.
27332
27333Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27334the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27335there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27336NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27337the string.
27338
27339This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27340authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27341.code
27342fixed_plain:
27343 driver = plaintext
27344 public_name = PLAIN
27345 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27346.endd
27347The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27348command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27349that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27350.code
27351fixed_login:
27352 driver = plaintext
27353 public_name = LOGIN
27354 client_send = : username : mysecret
27355.endd
27356The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27357the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27358prompts.
27359.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27360.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27361
27362
27363
27364
27365. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27366. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27367
27368.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27369.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27370.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27371.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27372.cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27373The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27374sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27375name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27376string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27377is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27378secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27379available in plain text at either end.
27380
27381
27382.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27383.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27384This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27385authenticator as a server:
27386
27387.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27388.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27389When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27390the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27391obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27392that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27393string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27394fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27395returned to the client.
27396
27397For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27398in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27399deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27400numeric variables for other things.
27401
27402For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27403client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27404user name, authentication fails.
27405.code
27406fixed_cram:
27407 driver = cram_md5
27408 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27409 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27410 server_set_id = $auth1
27411.endd
27412.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27413If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27414name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27415secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27416.code
27417lookup_cram:
27418 driver = cram_md5
27419 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27420 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27421 {$value}fail}
27422 server_set_id = $auth1
27423.endd
27424Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27425because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27426
27427As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27428using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27429lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27430realm, with:
27431.code
27432cyrusless_crammd5:
27433 driver = cram_md5
27434 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27435 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27436 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27437 server_set_id = $auth1
27438.endd
27439
27440.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27441.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27442When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27443
27444
27445
27446.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27447This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27448computing the response to the server's challenge.
27449
27450
27451.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27452This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27453expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27454
27455
27456.vindex "&$host$&"
27457.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27458Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27459to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27460expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27461prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27462authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27463send the message to the current server.
27464
27465A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27466strings, is:
27467.code
27468fixed_cram:
27469 driver = cram_md5
27470 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27471 client_name = ph10
27472 client_secret = secret
27473.endd
27474.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27475.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27476
27477
27478
27479. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27480. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27481
27482.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27483.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27484.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27485.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27486.cindex "Kerberos"
27487The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27488at A L Digital Ltd.
27489
27490The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27491library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27492Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27493including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27494directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27495
27496The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27497the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27498then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27499name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27500
27501Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27502or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27503user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27504by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27505depending on the driver you are using.
27506
27507The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27508be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27509Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27510changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27511layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27512implementation.
27513
27514For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27515may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27516variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27517Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27518With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27519environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27520is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27521the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27522
27523
27524.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27525The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27526(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27527previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27528use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27529confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27530things.
27531
27532
27533.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27534This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27535library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27536SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27537
27538
27539.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27540This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27541default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27542you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27543example:
27544.code
27545sasl:
27546 driver = cyrus_sasl
27547 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27548 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27549 server_set_id = $auth1
27550.endd
27551
27552.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27553This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27554
27555
27556.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27557This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27558
27559
27560For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27561private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27562the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27563PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27564.code
27565sasl_cram_md5:
27566 driver = cyrus_sasl
27567 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27568 server_set_id = $auth1
27569
27570sasl_plain:
27571 driver = cyrus_sasl
27572 public_name = PLAIN
27573 server_set_id = $auth2
27574.endd
27575Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27576not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27577but it is present in many binary distributions.
27578.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27579.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27580
27581
27582
27583
27584. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27585. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27586.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27587.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27588.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27589This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27590Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27591Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27592If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27593to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27594authenticator only. There is only one option:
27595
27596.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27597
27598This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27599authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27600mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27601authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27602.code
27603dovecot_plain:
27604 driver = dovecot
27605 public_name = PLAIN
27606 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27607 server_set_id = $auth1
27608
27609dovecot_ntlm:
27610 driver = dovecot
27611 public_name = NTLM
27612 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27613 server_set_id = $auth1
27614.endd
27615If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27616&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27617option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27618connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27619option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27620who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27621
27622.new
27623The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27624something like:
27625.code
27626conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27627
27628service auth {
27629...
27630#SASL
27631 unix_listener auth-client {
27632 mode = 0660
27633 user = mail
27634 }
27635...
27636}
27637
27638conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27639
27640auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27641.endd
27642.wen
27643
27644.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27645.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27646
27647
27648. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27649. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27650.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27651.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27652.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27653.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27654.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27655.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27656.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27657.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27658.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27659.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27660.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27661.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
27662The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27663library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27664and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27665scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27666made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27667without code changes in Exim.
27668
27669.new
27670The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27671realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27672The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27673when this happens.
27674
27675
27676.option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27677This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27678which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27679by &%client_username%& option.
27680If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27681which is the common case.
27682
27683.option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27684See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27685
27686.option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27687This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27688the password to be used, in clear.
27689
27690.option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27691This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27692the account name to be used.
27693.wen
27694
27695.new
27696.option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
27697If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
27698it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
27699The value after expansion should be
27700a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
27701with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
27702Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
27703supplied by the server.
27704.wen
27705
27706
27707
27708.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27709Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27710without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27711
27712Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27713of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27714authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27715ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27716context.
27717
27718This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27719non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27720server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27721
27722.new
27723This is
27724only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27725writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27726When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27727.wen
27728
27729This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27730this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27731of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27732
27733However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27734Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27735with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27736
27737
27738.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27739This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27740library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27741Some mechanisms will use this data.
27742
27743
27744.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27745This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27746default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27747you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27748example:
27749.code
27750sasl:
27751 driver = gsasl
27752 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27753 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27754 server_set_id = $auth1
27755.endd
27756
27757
27758.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27759Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27760that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27761the password itself.
27762
27763The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27764In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27765The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27766if available, else the empty string.
27767The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27768else the empty string.
27769
27770A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27771
27772If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27773option to be simply "true".
27774
27775
27776.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27777This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27778Some mechanisms will use this data.
27779
27780
27781.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27782This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27783.new
27784The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27785when this option is expanded.
27786
27787The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27788and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27789a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27790(if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27791either the iteration count or the salt).
27792A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27793for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
27794.wen
27795
27796.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27797This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27798.new
27799The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27800when this option is expanded.
27801The value should be a base64-encoded string,
27802of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
27803If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27804protocol conversation.
27805.wen
27806
27807
27808.new
27809.option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
27810.option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
27811These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
27812to provide stored information related to a password,
27813the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
27814
27815&%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
27816&%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
27817
27818They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
27819When this is so, the macros
27820_OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
27821and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
27822will be defined.
27823
27824The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
27825
27826If set, the results of expansion should for each
27827should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
27828of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
27829&%server_password%& option.
27830If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
27831
27832The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
27833to generate these values.
27834.wen
27835
27836
27837.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27838This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27839Some mechanisms will use this data.
27840
27841
27842.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27843.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27844These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27845They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27846
27847Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27848meanings for these variables:
27849
27850.ilist
27851.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27852&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27853.next
27854.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27855&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27856.next
27857.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27858&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27859.endlist
27860
27861On a per-mechanism basis:
27862
27863.ilist
27864.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27865EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27866the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27867.next
27868.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27869ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27870the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27871.next
27872.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27873GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27874&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27875the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27876.endlist
27877
27878An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27879identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27880email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27881
27882
27883An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27884and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27885.code
27886gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27887 driver = gsasl
27888 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27889 server_realm = imap.example.org
27890 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27891 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27892 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27893 server_condition = yes
27894.endd
27895
27896
27897. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27898. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27899
27900.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27901.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27902.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27903.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27904.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27905The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27906Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27907reliably.
27908
27909.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27910This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27911for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27912identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27913
27914.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27915If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27916&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27917The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27918
27919.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27920This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27921&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27922from the keytab.
27923
27924
27925.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27926Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27927to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27928not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27929
27930The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27931Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27932Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27933role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27934
27935.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27936.ilist
27937.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27938&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27939.next
27940.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27941&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27942authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27943GSS Display Name.
27944.endlist
27945
27946
27947. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27948. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27949
27950.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27951.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27952.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27953.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27954.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27955.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27956.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27957The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27958Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27959which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27960this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27961taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27962server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27963follows:
27964
27965.ilist
27966After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27967authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27968.next
27969The server sends back a challenge.
27970.next
27971The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27972and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27973.endlist
27974
27975Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27976
27977
27978
27979.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27980.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27981The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27982
27983.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27984.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27985This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27986authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27987compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27988&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27989it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27990for other things. For example:
27991.code
27992spa:
27993 driver = spa
27994 public_name = NTLM
27995 server_password = \
27996 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27997.endd
27998If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27999failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28000
28001
28002
28003
28004
28005.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28006.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28007The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28008
28009
28010
28011.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28012This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28013
28014
28015.option client_password spa string&!! unset
28016This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28017
28018
28019.option client_username spa string&!! unset
28020This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28021configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28022&'msn.com'&:
28023.code
28024msn:
28025 driver = spa
28026 public_name = MSN
28027 client_username = msn/msn_username
28028 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28029 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28030.endd
28031.ecindex IIDspaauth1
28032.ecindex IIDspaauth2
28033
28034
28035
28036
28037
28038. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28039. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28040
28041.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28042.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28043.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28044.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28045.cindex "authentication" "X509"
28046.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28047The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28048authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28049The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28050(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28051It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28052the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28053by the server configuration.
28054
28055The client presents an identity in-clear.
28056It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28057and for clients to only attempt,
28058this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28059
28060One possible use, compatible with the
28061K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28062is for using X509 client certificates.
28063
28064It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28065(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28066but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28067rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28068client certificates only.
28069
28070The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28071client-certificate authentication is being done.
28072
28073The client must present a certificate,
28074for which it must have been requested via the
28075&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28076(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28077For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28078verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28079
28080.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28081.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28082The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28083
28084.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28085.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28086.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28087These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28088and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28089If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28090failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28091
28092They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28093
28094.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28095.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28096.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28097 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28098.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28099.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28100
28101When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28102expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28103response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28104values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28105an identity for authentication and
28106placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28107
28108For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28109the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28110variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28111string expansions that also use them for other things.
28112
28113.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28114Once an identity has been received,
28115&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28116authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28117to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28118&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28119expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28120generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28121For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28122string as the error text.
28123
28124Example:
28125.code
28126ext_ccert_san_mail:
28127 driver = external
28128 public_name = EXTERNAL
28129
28130 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28131 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28132 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28133 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28134 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28135 server_set_id = $auth1
28136.endd
28137This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28138of your configured trust-anchors
28139(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28140and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28141
28142&*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28143The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28144TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28145in this way.
28146
28147
28148.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28149.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28150The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28151
28152.option client_send external string&!! unset
28153This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28154identity being asserted.
28155
28156Example:
28157.code
28158ext_ccert:
28159 driver = external
28160 public_name = EXTERNAL
28161
28162 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28163 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28164.endd
28165
28166
28167.ecindex IIDexternauth1
28168.ecindex IIDexternauth2
28169
28170
28171
28172
28173
28174. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28175. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28176
28177.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28178.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28179.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28180.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28181.cindex "authentication" "X509"
28182.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28183The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28184authentication based on client certificates.
28185
28186It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28187advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28188It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28189the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28190by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28191the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28192
28193The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28194for which it must have been requested via the
28195&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28196(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28197
28198If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28199run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28200and can authenticate the connection.
28201If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28202
28203A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28204
28205
28206.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28207The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28208
28209.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28210.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28211This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28212the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28213If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28214failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28215
28216.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28217.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28218As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28219
28220&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28221
28222
28223Example:
28224.code
28225tls:
28226 driver = tls
28227 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28228 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28229 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28230 {forany {$auth1} \
28231 {!= {0} \
28232 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28233 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28234 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28235 } } } }}}
28236 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28237.endd
28238This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28239of your configured trust-anchors
28240(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28241and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28242
28243Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28244The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28245TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28246in this way.
28247Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28248
28249. An alternative might use
28250. .code
28251. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28252. .endd
28253. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28254. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28255. This would help for per-device use.
28256.
28257. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28258. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28259
28260.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28261.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28262
28263
28264Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28265the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28266a connect- or helo-ACL.
28267
28268
28269
28270. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28271. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28272
28273.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28274 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28275.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28276.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28277.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28278.cindex "OpenSSL"
28279.cindex "GnuTLS"
28280Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28281Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28282GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28283cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28284order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28285version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28286You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28287level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28288certificates are used.
28289
28290RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28291connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28292server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28293mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28294between them is encrypted.
28295
28296Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28297and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28298certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28299possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28300encryption state.
28301
28302&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28303disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28304in order to get TLS to work.
28305
28306
28307
28308.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28309 "SECID284"
28310.cindex "submissions protocol"
28311.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28312.cindex "smtps protocol"
28313.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28314.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28315.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28316The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28317contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28318allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28319instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28320by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28321
28322The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28323clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28324Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28325
28326This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28327standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28328reassigned for other use.
28329Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28330this port.
28331In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28332not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28333Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28334
28335Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28336global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28337the most common use is expected to be:
28338.code
28339tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28340.endd
28341The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28342via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28343the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28344the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28345an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28346defined elsewhere.
28347
28348There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28349&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28350
28351
28352
28353
28354
28355
28356.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28357.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28358TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28359To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28360.code
28361USE_OPENSSL=yes
28362.endd
28363in Local/Makefile.
28364
28365To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28366.code
28367USE_GNUTLS=yes
28368.endd
28369in Local/Makefile.
28370
28371You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28372include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28373
28374There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28375
28376.ilist
28377The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28378cannot be the path of a directory
28379for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28380(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28381.next
28382The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28383.next
28384.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28385.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28386Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28387separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28388affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28389.next
28390OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28391DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28392RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28393in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28394for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28395to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28396&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28397option).
28398.next
28399The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28400sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28401.next
28402The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28403When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28404(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28405let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28406.next
28407With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28408main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28409.next
28410Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28411This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28412explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28413implementation, then patches are welcome.
28414.endlist
28415
28416
28417.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28418This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28419an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28420but not the chosen filename.
28421By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28422See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28423
28424GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28425to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28426Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28427&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28428of bits requested.
28429The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28430its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28431parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28432that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28433renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28434this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28435place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28436
28437For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28438recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28439If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28440are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28441not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28442
28443Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28444values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28445parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28446If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28447until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28448a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28449
28450The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28451in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28452generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28453
28454To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28455and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28456&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28457renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28458.code
28459# ls
28460[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28461# rm -f new-params
28462# touch new-params
28463# chown exim:exim new-params
28464# chmod 0600 new-params
28465# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28466# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28467[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28468 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28469 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28470# chmod 0400 new-params
28471# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28472.endd
28473If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28474stalling is removed.
28475
28476The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28477Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28478the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28479a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28480and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28481failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28482of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28483which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28484GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28485to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28486limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28487
28488The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28489value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28490&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
284912432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28492
28493In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28494increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28495bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28496procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28497the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28498
28499
28500.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28501.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28502.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28503There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28504suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28505are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28506The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28507DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28508directly to this function call.
28509Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28510&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28511The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28512documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28513
28514.ilist
28515It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28516.next
28517It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28518or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28519ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28520SSL v3 algorithms.
28521.next
28522Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28523the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28524SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28525algorithms.
28526.endlist
28527
28528Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28529&`-`& or &`+`&.
28530.ilist
28531If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28532ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28533stated.
28534.next
28535If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28536of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28537.next
28538If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28539option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28540.endlist
28541
28542If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28543a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28544includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28545not be moved to the end of the list.
28546.endlist
28547
28548The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28549string:
28550.code
28551# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28552$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28553.endd
28554
28555This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28556there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28557submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28558choice of clients used:
28559.code
28560# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28561tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28562 {DEFAULT}\
28563 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28564.endd
28565
28566This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28567.code
28568tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28569.endd
28570
28571For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28572and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28573The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28574TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28575
28576As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28577.code
28578TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28579.endd
28580
28581
28582.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28583 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28584.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28585.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28586.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28587.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28588.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28589.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28590.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28591The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28592as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28593ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28594
28595The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28596and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28597
28598The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28599controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28600&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28601the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28602the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28603aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28604
28605Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28606"Priority strings". This is online as
28607&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28608but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28609installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28610then the example code
28611&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28612on that site can be used to test a given string.
28613
28614For example:
28615.code
28616# Disable older versions of protocols
28617tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28618.endd
28619
28620Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28621additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28622"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28623
28624This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28625there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28626by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28627where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28628used:
28629.code
28630# GnuTLS variant
28631tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28632 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28633 {SECURE128}}
28634.endd
28635
28636
28637.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28638.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28639When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28640the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28641but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28642that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28643this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28644
28645If STARTTLS is to be used you
28646need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28647
28648If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28649problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28650persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28651with the error
28652.code
28653554 Security failure
28654.endd
28655If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28656rejected with a 554 error code.
28657
28658To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28659must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28660
28661If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28662meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28663You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28664from someone able to intercept the communication.
28665
28666Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28667
28668To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28669.code
28670tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28671tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28672.endd
28673These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28674the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28675contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28676that goes with it. These files need to be
28677PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28678always be given as full path names.
28679The key must not be password-protected.
28680They can be the same file if both the
28681certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28682set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28683is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28684certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28685the server's certificate.
28686
28687For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28688colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28689algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28690public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28691client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28692ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28693
28694If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28695source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28696few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28697
28698&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28699they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28700Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28701transport.
28702
28703With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28704require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28705this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28706.code
28707tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28708.endd
28709is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28710with the parameters contained in the file.
28711Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28712available:
28713.code
28714tls_dhparam = none
28715.endd
28716This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28717DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28718used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28719documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28720
28721See the command
28722.code
28723openssl dhparam
28724.endd
28725for a way of generating file data.
28726
28727The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28728host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28729for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28730in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28731forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28732
28733.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28734.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28735.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28736The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28737an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28738incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28739also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28740&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28741condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28742
28743Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28744can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28745cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28746example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28747contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28748documentation for more details.
28749
28750For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28751(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28752
28753
28754.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28755.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28756.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28757If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28758session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28759&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28760apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28761Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28762contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28763expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28764These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28765an explicit file or,
28766depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28767&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28768
28769A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28770directory is used
28771(OpenSSL only),
28772each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28773of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28774certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28775.code
28776openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28777.endd
28778where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28779
28780There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28781Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28782
28783The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28784what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28785does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28786&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28787attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28788dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28789session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28790fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28791example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28792relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28793
28794.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28795When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28796the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28797&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28798
28799.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28800Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28801&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28802&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28803&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28804certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28805
28806
28807.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28808.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28809.cindex "revocation list"
28810.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28811.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28812Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28813certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28814server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28815an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28816of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28817CRL in PEM format.
28818The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28819file from every certificate authority they know of.
28820
28821The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28822Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28823against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28824usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28825private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28826is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28827
28828The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28829comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28830connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28831re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28832
28833The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28834issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28835the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28836negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28837CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28838resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28839starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28840proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28841
28842Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28843or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28844support for OCSP stapling is included.
28845
28846There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28847The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28848an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28849option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28850contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28851
28852Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28853proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28854Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28855contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28856on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28857next connection.
28858
28859When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28860in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28861ignored.
28862
28863For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28864also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28865certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28866of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28867intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28868file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28869
28870Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28871not any of the chain from CA to it.
28872
28873There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28874
28875.code
28876 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28877 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28878 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28879
28880 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28881 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28882 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28883.endd
28884
28885
28886
28887
28888.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28889.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28890.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28891.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28892.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28893The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28894deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28895server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28896within the &(smtp)& transport.
28897
28898It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28899transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28900server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28901this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28902transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28903
28904If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28905to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28906&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28907those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28908set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28909usual way.
28910
28911When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28912the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28913a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28914session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28915&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28916delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28917it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28918STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28919negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28920unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28921unencrypted.
28922
28923The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28924transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28925if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28926&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28927
28928&*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28929for client use (they are usable for server use).
28930As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28931in failed connections.
28932
28933If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28934specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28935These may be
28936the system default set (depending on library version),
28937a file,
28938or (depending on library version) a directory.
28939The client verifies the server's certificate
28940against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28941in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28942Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28943&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28944
28945The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28946certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28947or need not succeed respectively.
28948
28949The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28950checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28951is valid for the certificate.
28952The option defaults to always checking.
28953
28954The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28955&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28956is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28957value is empty.
28958&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28959a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28960value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28961otherwise.
28962
28963The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28964&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28965for OCSP to be relevant.
28966
28967If
28968&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28969list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28970the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28971alternative hosts, if any.
28972
28973 &*Note*&:
28974These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28975is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28976by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28977client.
28978
28979.vindex "&$host$&"
28980.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28981All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28982&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28983which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28984behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28985
28986.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28987.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28988.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28989.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28990Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28991&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28992variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28993that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28994successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28995outgoing connection.
28996
28997
28998
28999.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29000.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29001.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29002.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29003With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29004information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29005extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29006&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29007client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29008within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29009for this session.
29010
29011This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29012which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29013address.
29014
29015With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29016against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29017provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29018be of limited use in that environment.
29019
29020With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29021connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29022choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29023wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29024different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29025
29026The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29027if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29028nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29029only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29030for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29031
29032Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29033received from a client.
29034It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29035
29036If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29037option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29038during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29039
29040.ilist
29041&%tls_certificate%&
29042.next
29043&%tls_crl%&
29044.next
29045&%tls_privatekey%&
29046.next
29047&%tls_verify_certificates%&
29048.next
29049&%tls_ocsp_file%&
29050.endlist
29051
29052Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29053attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29054can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29055arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29056Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29057an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29058when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29059
29060The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29061are re-expanded.
29062
29063When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29064for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29065enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29066see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29067
29068When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
290690.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29070built, then you have SNI support).
29071
29072
29073
29074.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29075 "SECTmulmessam"
29076.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29077.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29078Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29079an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29080one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29081of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29082connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29083to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29084starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29085unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29086
29087An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29088&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29089this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29090shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29091before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29092try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29093if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29094
29095The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29096after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29097just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29098reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29099successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29100SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29101should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29102subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29103and delay other deliveries to that host.
29104
29105To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29106closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29107closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29108information is recorded.
29109
29110There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29111&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29112connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29113
29114
29115
29116
29117.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29118.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29119In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29120certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29121This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29122reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29123
29124The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29125documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29126document is currently at
29127.display
29128&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29129.endd
29130and their FAQ is at
29131.display
29132&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29133.endd
29134
29135Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
291360-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29137descriptions.
29138More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29139published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29140Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29141&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29142
29143
29144.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29145The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29146certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29147sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29148not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29149First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29150certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29151intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29152certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29153The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29154validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29155root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29156install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29157
29158Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29159even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29160server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29161diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29162
29163
29164
29165.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29166.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29167You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29168with OpenSSL, like this:
29169. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29170. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29171.code
29172openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29173 -days 9999 -nodes
29174.endd
29175&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29176delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29177specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29178important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29179that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29180prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29181this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29182
29183. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29184. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29185. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29186. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29187. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29188. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29189. ==== -pdp, 2012
29190NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29191epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29192the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29193the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29194of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29195writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29196progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29197be a sensible resolution).
29198
29199A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29200may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29201encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29202
29203However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29204user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29205certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29206must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29207authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29208signed with that self-signed certificate.
29209
29210For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29211user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29212Open-source PKI book, available online at
29213&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29214.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29215.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29216
29217
29218
29219.section DANE "SECDANE"
29220.cindex DANE
29221DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29222it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29223operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29224you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29225Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29226certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29227
29228What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29229that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29230by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29231
29232It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29233fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29234
29235DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29236for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29237client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29238
29239DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29240that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29241to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29242DNSSEC.
292432) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
292443) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29245
29246There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29247Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29248in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29249If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29250
29251A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29252"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29253For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29254&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29255
29256The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29257These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29258The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29259(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29260this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29261DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29262well-known one.
29263A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29264attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29265does require careful arrangement.
29266With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29267the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29268DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29269all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29270DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29271
29272Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29273because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29274your certificate.
29275You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29276"MTA-STS", described below.
29277
29278When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29279outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29280connections to you.
29281If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29282technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29283In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29284operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29285Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29286because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29287
29288When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29289and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29290than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29291random serial numbers.
29292The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29293If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29294requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29295CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29296
29297The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29298a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29299
29300For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29301
29302.code
29303 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29304 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29305 | openssl sha512 \
29306 | awk '{print $2}'
29307.endd
29308
29309are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29310
29311An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29312
29313.code
29314 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29315.endd
29316
29317At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29318is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29319
29320
29321For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29322
29323The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29324issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29325Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29326re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29327libraries.
29328This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29329interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29330
29331The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29332be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29333default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29334
29335.code
29336 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29337 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29338 {*}{}}
29339.endd
29340
29341The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29342The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29343found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29344string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29345control the OCSP request.
29346
29347This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29348those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29349
29350
29351For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29352and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29353The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29354DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29355the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29356
29357DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29358
29359A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29360If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29361will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29362be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29363
29364If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29365prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29366back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29367This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29368crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29369which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29370limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29371
29372If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29373.code
29374 hosts_require_tls
29375 tls_verify_hosts
29376 tls_try_verify_hosts
29377 tls_verify_certificates
29378 tls_crl
29379 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29380.endd
29381
29382If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29383verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29384
29385The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29386set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29387
29388If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29389
29390There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29391verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29392in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29393and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29394
29395.cindex DANE reporting
29396An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29397to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29398required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29399&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29400The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29401Section 4.3 of that document.
29402
29403Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29404
29405DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29406selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29407to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29408instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29409time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29410Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29411can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29412MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29413information.
29414
29415The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29416which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29417That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29418
29419The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29420&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29421renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29422records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29423information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29424domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29425incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29426
29427
29428
29429. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29430. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29431
29432.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29433.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29434.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29435.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29436.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29437Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29438configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29439name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29440one very small ACL:
29441.code
29442begin acl
29443small_acl:
29444 accept hosts = one.host.only
29445.endd
29446You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29447which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29448
29449The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29450certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29451when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29452option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29453in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29454local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29455a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29456&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29457
29458
29459.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29460The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29461configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29462
29463
29464.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29465.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29466In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29467options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29468.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29469.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29470.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29471.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29472.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29473.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29474.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29475.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29476.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29477.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29478.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29479.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29480.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29481.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29482.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29483.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29484
29485.table2 140pt
29486.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29487.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29488.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29489.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29490.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29491.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29492.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29493.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29494.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29495.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29496.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29497.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29498.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29499.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29500.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29501.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29502.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29503.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29504.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29505.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29506.endtable
29507
29508For example, if you set
29509.code
29510acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29511.endd
29512the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29513in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29514done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29515sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29516command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29517trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29518testing as possible at RCPT time.
29519
29520
29521.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29522.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29523The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29524apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29525really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29526the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29527relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29528are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29529&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29530&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29531in any of these ACLs.
29532
29533The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29534non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29535analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29536batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29537result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29538really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29539on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29540controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29541.code
29542control = suppress_local_fixups
29543.endd
29544This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29545run, it is too late.
29546
29547The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29548content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29549
29550The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29551kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29552temporary error for these kinds of message.
29553
29554
29555.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29556.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29557.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29558The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29559session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29560an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29561accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29562the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29563&%smtp_banner%& option.
29564
29565
29566.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29567.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29568.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29569The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29570EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29571&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29572Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29573session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29574setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29575
29576Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29577mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29578&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29579
29580If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29581modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29582at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29583affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29584an EHLO response.
29585
29586
29587.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29588.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29589Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29590command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29591When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29592is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29593the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29594response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29595added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29596are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29597
29598You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29599in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29600tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29601received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29602the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29603associated with the DATA command.
29604
29605.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29606.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29607.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29608If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29609the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29610. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29611The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29612the data specified is received.
29613
29614For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29615error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29616MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29617before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29618and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29619your resources.
29620
29621The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29622the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29623the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29624and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29625
29626.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29627The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29628enabled (which is the default).
29629
29630The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29631received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29632otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29633
29634This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29635
29636For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29637
29638
29639.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29640The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29641content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29642
29643This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29644
29645
29646.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29647.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29648.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29649The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29650with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29651It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29652client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29653has been accepted.
29654
29655The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29656has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29657with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29658The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29659The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29660can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29661for some or all recipients.
29662
29663PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29664one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29665content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29666.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29667for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29668is &"yes"&.
29669Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29670ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29671will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29672
29673See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29674and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29675
29676This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29677If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29678the feature was not requested by the client.
29679
29680.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29681.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29682The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29683does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29684does not in fact control any access.
29685For this reason, it may only accept
29686or warn as its final result.
29687
29688This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29689session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29690messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29691more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29692
29693&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29694the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29695
29696You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29697&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29698response to QUIT.
29699
29700This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29701failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29702because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29703client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29704connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29705
29706
29707.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29708.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29709The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29710an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29711trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29712because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29713situation even worse.
29714
29715Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29716logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29717modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29718and &%warn%&.
29719
29720.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29721When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29722to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29723connection. The possible values are:
29724.table2
29725.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29726.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29727.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29728.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29729.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29730.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29731.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29732.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29733.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29734.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29735.endtable
29736In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29737Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29738With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29739overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29740&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29741used.
29742
29743
29744.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29745.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29746The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29747you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29748.code
29749acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29750 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29751.endd
29752In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29753providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29754an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29755expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29756more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29757
29758The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29759configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29760string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29761
29762.ilist
29763If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29764contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29765Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29766lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29767If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29768causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29769.code
29770acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29771 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29772 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29773.endd
29774This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29775back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29776file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29777can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29778.next
29779If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29780Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29781matches the string.
29782.next
29783If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29784the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29785want to have something like
29786.code
29787acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29788.endd
29789in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29790newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29791.endlist
29792
29793
29794
29795
29796.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29797.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29798Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29799section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29800&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29801database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29802return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29803&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29804This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29805
29806For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29807&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29808submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29809
29810
29811ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29812has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29813individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29814blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29815
29816If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29817ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29818RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29819recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29820run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29821remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29822&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29823
29824If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29825is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29826
29827
29828.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29829The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29830recipients; it may create new recipients.
29831
29832
29833
29834.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29835.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29836The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29837all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29838not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29839reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29840
29841For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29842these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29843used to accept or reject anything.
29844
29845For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29846&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29847&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29848when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29849
29850For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29851&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29852This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29853messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29854configuration file.
29855
29856
29857
29858
29859.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29860.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29861.vindex &$domain$&
29862.vindex &$local_part$&
29863.vindex &$sender_address$&
29864.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29865.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29866When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29867that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29868&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29869statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29870&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29871is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29872
29873When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29874contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29875set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29876how it is used.
29877
29878.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29879The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29880the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29881that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29882the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29883received).
29884
29885.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29886.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29887The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29888The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29889accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29890of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29891&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29892&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29893
29894
29895
29896
29897
29898.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29899.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29900.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29901.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29902When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29903the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29904and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29905These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29906here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29907encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29908does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29909unencrypted connections.
29910.code
29911acl_check_auth:
29912 accept encrypted = *
29913 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29914 {CRAM-MD5}}
29915 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29916.endd
29917(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29918that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29919encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29920option to do this.)
29921
29922
29923
29924.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29925.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29926.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29927An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29928with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29929Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29930set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29931
29932If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29933used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29934provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29935example:
29936.code
29937deny dnslists = list1.example
29938 dnslists = list2.example
29939.endd
29940If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29941the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29942happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29943all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29944test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29945
29946
29947.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29948The ACL verbs are as follows:
29949
29950.ilist
29951.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29952&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29953of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29954appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29955is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29956after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29957check a RCPT command:
29958.code
29959accept domains = +local_domains
29960 endpass
29961 verify = recipient
29962.endd
29963If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29964passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29965the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29966fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29967&%endpass%&.
29968
29969The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29970use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29971that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29972configuration.
29973
29974.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29975If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29976depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29977(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29978statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29979SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29980.display
29981&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29982&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29983.endd
29984You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29985response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29986same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29987
29988If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29989an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29990for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29991of &%endpass%&.
29992
29993
29994.next
29995.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29996&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29997an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29998&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29999temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
30000&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
30001be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
30002
30003
30004.next
30005.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
30006&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
30007the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
30008example,
30009.code
30010deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30011.endd
30012rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
30013
30014
30015.next
30016.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
30017&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
30018&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
30019that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
30020the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
30021recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
30022recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
30023message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
30024do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
30025
30026If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
30027its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
30028The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
30029
30030
30031.next
30032.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
30033&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
30034forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
30035.code
30036drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
30037 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
30038.endd
30039There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30040The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30041
30042.next
30043.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30044&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30045statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30046example, when checking a RCPT command,
30047.code
30048require message = Sender did not verify
30049 verify = sender
30050.endd
30051passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30052verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30053&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30054discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30055
30056.next
30057.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30058&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30059&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30060to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30061written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30062message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30063duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30064
30065If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30066and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30067&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30068first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30069&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30070
30071If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30072some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30073This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30074is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30075conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30076is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
30077onwards.
30078
30079
30080.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30081When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
30082text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
30083want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
30084.code
30085warn !verify = sender
30086 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
30087.endd
30088.endlist
30089
30090At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
30091
30092As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
30093written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
30094subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
30095continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
30096mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
30097
30098
30099
30100.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
30101.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
30102There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
30103can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
30104of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
30105transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
30106variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
30107an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
30108alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
30109the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
30110.ilist
30111The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
30112throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
30113while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
30114on the same SMTP connection.
30115.next
30116The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
30117while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
30118reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
30119.endlist
30120
30121When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30122preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30123time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30124.code
30125accept hosts = whatever
30126 set acl_m4 = some value
30127accept authenticated = *
30128 set acl_c_auth = yes
30129.endd
30130&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30131be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30132&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30133
30134.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30135What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30136referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30137false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30138error is generated.
30139
30140Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30141their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30142
30143
30144.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30145.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30146.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30147An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30148.code
30149deny domains = *.dom.example
30150 !verify = recipient
30151.endd
30152causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30153&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30154negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30155two statements are equivalent:
30156.code
30157deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30158deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30159.endd
30160However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30161side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30162
30163The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30164of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30165condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30166.code
30167accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30168 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30169accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30170 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30171.endd
30172Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30173the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30174different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30175condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30176therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30177the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30178and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30179
30180ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30181specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30182others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30183warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30184message is handled.
30185
30186The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30187processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30188modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30189consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30190.code
30191require message = Can't verify sender
30192 verify = sender
30193 message = Can't verify recipient
30194 verify = recipient
30195 message = This message cannot be used
30196.endd
30197If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30198&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30199so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30200recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30201verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30202because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30203
30204For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30205modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30206happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30207the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30208.code
30209deny hosts = ...
30210 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30211 message = Invalid sender from client host
30212.endd
30213The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30214by which time Exim has set up the message.
30215
30216
30217
30218.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30219.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30220The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30221
30222.vlist
30223.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30224This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30225incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30226accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30227
30228.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30229.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30230.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30231This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30232continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30233the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30234update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30235write rather ugly lines like this:
30236.display
30237&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30238.endd
30239Instead, all you need is
30240.display
30241&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30242.endd
30243
30244.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30245.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30246This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30247incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30248lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30249lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30250controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30251even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30252
30253As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30254separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30255in several different ways. For example:
30256
30257. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30258. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30259. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30260. ==== way.
30261
30262.ilist
30263It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30264.code
30265 accept ...some conditions
30266 control = queue
30267.endd
30268In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30269other words, when the conditions are all true.
30270
30271.next
30272It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30273.code
30274 accept ...some conditions...
30275 control = queue
30276 ...some more conditions...
30277.endd
30278If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30279statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30280In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30281to be relevant.
30282
30283.next
30284It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30285decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30286example:
30287.code
30288 warn ...some conditions...
30289 control = freeze
30290 accept ...
30291.endd
30292This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30293&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30294log entry.
30295
30296.next
30297If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30298&%require%& verb. For example:
30299.code
30300 require control = no_multiline_responses
30301.endd
30302.endlist
30303
30304.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30305.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30306.oindex "&%-bh%&"
30307This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30308the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30309&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30310output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30311happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30312output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30313
30314Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30315example:
30316.code
30317deny ...some conditions...
30318 delay = 30s
30319.endd
30320The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30321&"deny"&. Compare this with:
30322.code
30323deny delay = 30s
30324 ...some conditions...
30325.endd
30326which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30327can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30328.code
30329warn ...some conditions...
30330 delay = 2m
30331 control = freeze
30332accept ...
30333.endd
30334
30335If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30336responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30337they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30338delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30339appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30340unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30341using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30342
30343
30344.vitem &*endpass*&
30345.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30346This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30347&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30348failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30349failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30350confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30351&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30352
30353
30354.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30355.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30356This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30357ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30358.code
30359require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30360 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30361.endd
30362&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30363example:
30364.display
30365&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30366&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30367.endd
30368When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30369that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30370recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30371message.
30372
30373The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30374the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30375denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30376available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30377variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30378&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30379ignored.
30380
30381.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30382If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30383verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30384error message.
30385
30386If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30387the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30388more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30389actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30390of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30391is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30392
30393If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30394example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30395the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30396logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30397both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30398logging rejections.
30399
30400
30401.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30402.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30403.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30404This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30405about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30406be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30407may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30408ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30409.display
30410&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30411&` log_reject_target =`&
30412.endd
30413This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30414permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30415current ACL.
30416
30417
30418.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30419.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30420.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30421This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30422processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30423&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30424access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30425ACLs. For example:
30426.display
30427&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30428&` control = freeze`&
30429&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30430.endd
30431By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30432with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30433another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30434example:
30435.code
30436logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30437logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30438.endd
30439
30440
30441.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30442.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30443This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30444message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30445or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30446there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30447&%accept%& for details.)
30448
30449The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30450to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30451generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30452&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30453the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30454.code
30455require message = Host not recognized
30456 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30457.endd
30458(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30459processed.)
30460
30461.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30462.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30463For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30464of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30465is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30466is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30467overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30468accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30469truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30470EHLO options.
30471
30472When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30473consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30474of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30475.code
30476deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30477 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30478.endd
30479The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30480by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30481access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
304822&'xx'&.
30483
30484Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30485the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30486
30487The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30488literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30489anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30490response.
30491
30492.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30493For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30494stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30495
30496If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30497specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30498However, the original message is available in the variable
30499&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30500wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30501routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30502use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30503
30504For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30505is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30506modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30507all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30508&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30509&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30510effect.
30511
30512
30513.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30514.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30515.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30516This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30517for the message.
30518It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30519the DATA ACL).
30520This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30521of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30522Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30523If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30524
30525
30526.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30527This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30528 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30529the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30530
30531
30532.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30533.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30534This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30535&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30536
30537
30538.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30539.cindex "UDP communications"
30540This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30541collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30542the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30543of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30544server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30545separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30546example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30547when:
30548.code
30549udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30550 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30551.endd
30552.endlist
30553
30554
30555
30556
30557.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30558.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30559The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30560
30561.vlist
30562.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30563This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30564has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30565apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30566HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30567really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30568not work without it. For example:
30569.code
30570warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30571 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30572.endd
30573Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30574the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30575matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30576mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30577by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30578
30579
30580.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30581 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30582.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30583.cindex "case of local parts"
30584.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30585These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30586(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30587are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30588any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30589for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30590is encountered.
30591
30592These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30593local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30594in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30595handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30596configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30597
30598This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30599containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30600spam score:
30601.code
30602warn control = caseful_local_part
30603 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30604 $acl_m4 + \
30605 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30606 }
30607 control = caselower_local_part
30608.endd
30609Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30610is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30611
30612
30613.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30614.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30615.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30616This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30617
30618The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30619If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30620and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30621is used for all recipients of the message,
30622then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30623and data is copied from one to the other.
30624
30625An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30626for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30627If a recipient-verify callout
30628(with use_sender)
30629connection is subsequently
30630requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30631any subsequent recipients and the data,
30632otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30633
30634Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30635and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30636Note also that headers cannot be
30637modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30638Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30639The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30640rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30641this will affect the timestamp.
30642
30643All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30644rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30645the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30646Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30647message body.
30648
30649Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30650of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30651before the entire message has been received from the source.
30652It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30653or CHUNKING
30654options in use.
30655
30656Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30657a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30658If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30659the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30660before the acceptance "<=" line.
30661
30662If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30663usual fashion.
30664This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30665to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30666&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30667and does not queue the message.
30668Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30669
30670Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30671(possibly faked)
30672sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30673
30674
30675.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30676.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30677.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30678This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30679with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30680by default called &'debuglog'&.
30681The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30682may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30683the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30684option.
30685Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30686with the &'kill'& option.
30687Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30688contexts):
30689.code
30690 control = debug
30691 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30692 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30693 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30694 control = debug/kill
30695.endd
30696
30697
30698.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30699.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30700.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30701This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30702the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30703
30704
30705.vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30706.cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30707.cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30708This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30709the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30710
30711
30712.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30713.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30714.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30715This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30716connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30717strings or to numeric value.
30718The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30719Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30720&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30721
30722The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30723(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30724that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30725equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30726Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30727
30728
30729.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30730 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30731.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30732.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30733These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30734is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30735state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30736in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30737
30738The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30739connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30740messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30741&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30742before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30743synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30744work with.
30745
30746
30747.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30748.cindex "fake defer"
30749.cindex "defer, fake"
30750This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30751except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30752550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30753messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30754use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30755
30756.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30757.cindex "fake rejection"
30758.cindex "rejection, fake"
30759This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30760words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30761message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30762However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30763only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30764the same SMTP connection.
30765
30766The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30767message is supplied, the following is used:
30768.code
30769550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30770550-kept for evaluation.
30771550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30772550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30773.endd
30774This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30775
30776.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30777.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30778This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30779other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30780it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30781current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30782SMTP connection.
30783
30784This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30785&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30786is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30787are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30788
30789.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30790.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30791Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30792avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30793use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30794disables such output flushing.
30795
30796.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30797.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30798Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30799avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30800use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30801that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30802
30803.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30804This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30805extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30806of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30807or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30808needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30809only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30810the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30811to be useful in production.
30812
30813.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30814.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30815This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30816It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30817SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30818
30819If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30820suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30821one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30822(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30823responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30824sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30825
30826.ilist
30827Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30828sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30829verification failed"&) is sent.
30830.next
30831If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30832line is output.
30833.endlist
30834
30835The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30836calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30837
30838.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30839.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30840This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30841the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30842response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30843controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30844&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30845
30846.new
30847.vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
30848 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30849.oindex "&%queue%&"
30850.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30851.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30852.cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
30853.cindex "first pass routing"
30854This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30855other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30856it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30857runner.
30858If used with no options set,
30859no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30860effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
30861
30862If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
30863the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
30864a delivery process is started which stops short of making
30865any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
30866the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
30867able to send all such messages on a single connection.
30868
30869The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
30870 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30871.wen
30872
30873.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30874.cindex "message" "submission"
30875.cindex "submission mode"
30876This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30877latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30878the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30879operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30880necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30881This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30882late (the message has already been created).
30883
30884Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30885messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30886submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30887The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30888that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30889
30890.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30891.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30892This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30893complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30894normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30895
30896.ilist
30897Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30898dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30899.next
30900No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30901.next
30902There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30903.endlist ilist
30904
30905This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30906passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30907used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30908and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30909data is read.
30910
30911&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30912that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30913
30914.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30915This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30916to a-label form.
30917For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30918.endlist vlist
30919
30920
30921.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30922All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30923
30924.ilist
30925Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30926.next
30927Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30928&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30929.next
30930Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30931.next
30932Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30933.endlist
30934
30935
30936
30937.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30938.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30939.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30940.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30941The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30942to an incoming message, as in this example:
30943.code
30944warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30945 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30946 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30947.endd
30948The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30949MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30950receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30951&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30952any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30953RCPT ACL).
30954
30955Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30956DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30957
30958Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30959the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30960contains one or more newlines that
30961are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30962lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30963front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30964
30965Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30966They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30967However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30968is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30969during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30970with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30971lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30972In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30973non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30974message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30975are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30976
30977.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30978Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30979of message headers
30980until they are added to the
30981message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30982ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30983header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30984ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30985passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30986this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30987&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30988
30989The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30990
30991The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30992processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30993.display
30994&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30995&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30996
30997&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30998&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30999.endd
31000In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
31001condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
31002condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
31003ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
31004honoured.
31005
31006.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31007For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
31008&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
31009effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
31010them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
31011usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
31012are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
31013specifications.
31014
31015By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
31016header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
31017be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
31018after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
31019that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
31020
31021This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
31022&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
31023header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
31024to be a header name first.) For example:
31025.code
31026warn add_header = \
31027 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
31028.endd
31029If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
31030each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
31031you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
31032up in reverse order.
31033
31034&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31035added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
31036system filter or in a router or transport.
31037
31038
31039
31040.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31041.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31042.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31043.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31044The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31045from an incoming message, as in this example:
31046.code
31047warn message = Remove internal headers
31048 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31049.endd
31050The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31051MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31052receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31053&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
31054with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
31055any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
31056
31057Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
31058DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31059
31060More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
31061list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
31062not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
31063create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
31064are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
31065.code
31066warn hosts = +internal_hosts
31067 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31068warn message = Remove internal headers
31069 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
31070.endd
31071Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31072Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31073If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
31074There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
31075a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
31076during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
31077if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
31078accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
31079all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
31080ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
31081would have been removed.
31082
31083.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
31084Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
31085is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
31086not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
31087removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
31088this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
31089passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
31090you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
31091&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31092
31093The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31094processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31095.display
31096&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
31097&` `&<&'some condition'&>
31098
31099&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31100&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
31101.endd
31102In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
31103condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
31104condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
31105same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
31106are honoured.
31107
31108&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31109present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
31110in a system filter or in a router or transport.
31111
31112
31113
31114
31115.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
31116.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
31117Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
31118compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
31119for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31120content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31121
31122Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31123senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31124result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31125done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31126can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31127same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31128The conditions are as follows:
31129
31130
31131.vlist
31132.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31133.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31134.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31135.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31136.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31137The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31138&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31139&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31140false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31141condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31142condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31143ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31144
31145If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31146can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31147and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31148Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31149The name and values are expanded separately.
31150Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31151will act as argument separators.
31152
31153If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31154the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31155&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31156conditions are tested.
31157
31158ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31159loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31160circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31161for different local users or different local domains.
31162
31163.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31164.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31165.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31166.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31167If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31168the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31169authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31170.code
31171authenticated = *
31172.endd
31173
31174.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31175.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31176.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31177.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31178.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31179This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31180expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31181&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31182number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31183any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31184&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31185ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31186negative.
31187
31188.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31189.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31190This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31191content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31192&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31193If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31194problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31195chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31196
31197.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31198.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31199.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31200.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31201.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31202This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31203&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31204use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31205different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31206&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31207
31208.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31209.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31210.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31211.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31212.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31213This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31214of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31215enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31216lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31217&%domains%& test.
31218
31219&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31220use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31221
31222
31223.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31224.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31225.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31226.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31227If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31228name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31229encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
31230.code
31231encrypted = *
31232.endd
31233
31234
31235.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
31236.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
31237.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
31238.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
31239This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
31240name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
31241you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
31242.code
31243accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31244.endd
31245The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31246the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31247and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31248
31249The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31250Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31251but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31252find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31253opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31254found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31255
31256If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31257address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31258.code
31259accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31260accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31261.endd
31262The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31263is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31264statement can then check the IP address.
31265
31266.vindex "&$host_data$&"
31267If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31268of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31269allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31270.code
31271deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31272message = $host_data
31273.endd
31274which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31275
31276.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31277.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31278.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31279.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31280.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31281This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31282part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31283enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31284result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31285the next &%local_parts%& test.
31286
31287.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31288.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31289.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31290.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31291This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31292content-scanning extension
31293and only after a DATA command.
31294It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31295viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31296
31297.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31298.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31299.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31300This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31301content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31302&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31303with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31304&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31305
31306.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31307.cindex "rate limiting"
31308This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31309messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31310
31311.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31312.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31313.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31314.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31315This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31316recipient address against a list of recipients.
31317
31318.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31319.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31320.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31321This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31322content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31323non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31324any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31325
31326.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31327.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31328.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31329.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31330.vindex "&$domain$&"
31331.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31332This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31333domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31334&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31335of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31336lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31337RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31338influence the sender checking.
31339
31340&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31341relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31342
31343.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31344.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31345.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31346.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31347This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31348for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31349.code
31350senders = :
31351.endd
31352&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31353relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31354
31355.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31356.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31357.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31358This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31359content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31360SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31361
31362.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31363.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31364.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31365.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31366.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31367.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31368This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31369certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31370server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31371or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31372
31373.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31374.cindex "CSA verification"
31375This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31376send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31377&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31378
31379.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31380.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31381.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31382.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31383.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31384This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31385received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31386&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31387there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31388allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31389
31390Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31391problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31392detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31393
31394.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31395.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31396.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31397.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31398.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31399.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31400This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31401received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31402&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31403of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31404is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31405However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31406that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31407to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31408might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31409
31410Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31411section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31412&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31413condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31414.code
31415deny senders = :
31416 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31417 !verify = header_sender
31418.endd
31419
31420.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31421.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31422.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31423.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31424.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31425This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31426received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31427&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31428lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31429and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31430Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31431permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31432&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31433appropriate.
31434
31435Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31436ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31437.code
31438To: @
31439.endd
31440and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31441common as they used to be.
31442
31443.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31444.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31445.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31446.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31447.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31448.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31449.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31450This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31451client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31452attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31453condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31454&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31455independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31456
31457For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31458option), this condition is always true.
31459
31460
31461.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31462.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31463.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31464This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31465Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31466&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31467case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31468&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31469used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31470
31471There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31472local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31473
31474There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31475recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31476
31477
31478.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31479.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31480.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31481.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31482.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31483.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31484This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31485recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31486&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31487of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31488This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31489verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31490address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31491value for the child address.
31492
31493.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31494.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31495.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31496.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31497This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31498address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31499was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31500Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31501one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31502original IP address.
31503
31504There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31505DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31506
31507If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31508is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31509
31510.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31511.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31512.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31513.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31514.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31515This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31516message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31517the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31518condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31519
31520.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31521.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31522If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31523value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31524value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31525statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31526want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31527
31528Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31529&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31530to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31531
31532.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31533.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31534This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31535verified as a sender.
31536
31537Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31538(eg. is generated from the received message)
31539they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31540.code
31541verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31542.endd
31543.endlist
31544
31545
31546
31547.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31548.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31549.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31550.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31551In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31552is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31553address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31554domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31555special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31556address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31557.code
31558deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31559 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31560.endd
31561the following records are looked up:
31562.code
3156343.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3156443.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31565.endd
31566As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31567Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31568to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31569use two separate conditions:
31570.code
31571deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31572 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31573.endd
31574If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31575behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31576record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31577processed.
31578
31579This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31580(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31581blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31582following special items in the list:
31583.display
31584&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31585&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31586&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31587.endd
31588.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31589.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31590.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31591Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31592.code
31593deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31594.endd
31595Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31596warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31597.code
31598deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31599warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31600 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31601.endd
31602.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31603.cindex DNS TTL
31604DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31605(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31606so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31607connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31608Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31609connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31610
31611There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31612or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31613&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31614
31615
31616
31617.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31618.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31619By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31620of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31621after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31622.code
31623deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31624.endd
31625This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31626use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31627MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31628&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31629
31630
31631
31632
31633.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31634.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31635There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31636addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31637&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31638with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31639listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31640.code
31641deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31642 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31643.endd
31644This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31645RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31646example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31647up by this example is
31648.code
31649tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31650.endd
31651A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31652addresses. For example:
31653.code
31654deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31655 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31656.endd
31657The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31658name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31659
31660
31661
31662
31663.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31664.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31665The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31666names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31667name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31668As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31669this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31670either to double the separators like this:
31671.code
31672dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31673.endd
31674or to change the separator character, like this:
31675.code
31676dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31677.endd
31678If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31679blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31680occurs. Consider this condition:
31681.code
31682dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31683.endd
31684The DNS lookups that occur are:
31685.code
316862.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31687a.domain.black.list.tld
31688.endd
31689Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31690address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31691are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31692or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31693only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31694successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31695error for a previous item.
31696
31697The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31698syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31699.code
31700dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31701dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31702.endd
31703However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31704is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31705.code
31706deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31707 $sender_address_domain \
31708 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31709 see $dnslist_text.
31710 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31711 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31712 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31713.endd
31714Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31715multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31716and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31717of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31718.code
31719dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31720.endd
31721Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31722domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31723
31724The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31725&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31726
31727
31728
31729
31730.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31731.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31732DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31733just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31734RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31735The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31736.display
31737127.1.0.1 RBL
31738127.1.0.2 DUL
31739127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31740127.1.0.4 RSS
31741127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31742127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31743127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31744.endd
31745Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31746different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31747see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31748
31749
31750.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31751.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31752.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31753.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31754.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31755.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31756.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31757When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31758the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31759&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31760(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31761the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31762&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31763cases, for example:
31764.code
31765deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31766.endd
31767the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31768&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31769For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31770might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31771.code
31772deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31773.endd
31774If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31775&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31776
31777If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31778addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31779The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31780record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31781very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31782information.
31783
31784You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31785&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31786expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31787.code
31788deny hosts = !+local_networks
31789 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31790 at $dnslist_domain
31791 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31792.endd
31793
31794
31795
31796.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31797.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31798You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31799in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31800For example,
31801.code
31802deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31803.endd
31804rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31805any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31806that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31807describes how multiple records are handled.
31808
31809More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31810separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31811&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31812.code
31813deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31814.endd
31815If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31816addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31817first. For example:
31818.code
31819deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31820 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31821.endd
31822
31823If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31824listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31825In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31826true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31827tested. For example:
31828.code
31829dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31830.endd
31831matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31832want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31833being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31834.code
31835dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31836.endd
31837matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31838an odd number.
31839
31840
31841
31842.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31843You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31844condition. Whereas
31845.code
31846deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31847.endd
31848means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31849IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31850.code
31851deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31852.endd
31853means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31854IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31855words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31856the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31857
31858&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31859host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31860
31861If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31862previous example is precisely equivalent to
31863.code
31864deny dnslists = a.b.c
31865 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31866.endd
31867However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31868Consider this example:
31869.code
31870deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31871 list.dsbl.org : \
31872 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31873 relays.ordb.org
31874.endd
31875Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31876.code
31877deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31878 list.dsbl.org
31879deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31880 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31881deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31882.endd
31883which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31884
31885
31886
31887
31888.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31889A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31890thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31891is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31892the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31893the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31894.code
31895dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31896.endd
31897What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31898127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31899condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31900because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31901affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31902additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31903
31904.ilist
31905If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31906IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31907condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31908.next
31909If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31910looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31911changed to:
31912.code
31913dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31914.endd
31915and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31916false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31917.code
31918dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31919.endd
31920for the condition to be true.
31921.endlist
31922
31923When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31924the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31925.ilist
31926If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31927addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31928.code
31929dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31930.endd
31931If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31932false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31933.next
31934If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31935looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31936.code
31937dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31938.endd
31939If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31940true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31941.code
31942dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31943.endd
31944for the condition to be false.
31945.endlist
31946When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31947between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31948
31949
31950
31951
31952.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31953.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31954When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31955the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31956the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31957address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31958only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31959can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31960in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31961lists.
31962
31963A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31964two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31965do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31966If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31967restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31968a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31969domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31970.code
31971deny message = \
31972 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31973 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31974 dnslists = \
31975 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31976 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31977.endd
31978For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31979&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31980match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31981value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31982record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31983The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31984
31985If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31986given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31987the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31988.code
31989deny dnslists = \
31990 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31991 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31992 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31993 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31994.endd
31995In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31996values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31997done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31998
31999
32000
32001.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
32002.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
32003.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
32004If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
32005nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
320063ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
32007.code
320081.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
32009 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32010.endd
32011(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
32012lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
32013IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
32014.code
32015*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
32016.endd
32017is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
32018Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
32019
32020You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
32021&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
32022.code
32023deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
32024 dnslists = some.list.example
32025.endd
32026
32027If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
32028address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
32029(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
32030.code
32031 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
32032.endd
32033
32034.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
32035.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
32036.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
32037.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
32038The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
32039which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
32040&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
32041commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
32042works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
32043host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
32044.display
32045&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
32046.endd
32047If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
32048period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
32049
32050As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
32051&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
32052configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
32053of &'p'&.
32054
32055The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
32056time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
32057means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
32058parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
32059send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
32060in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
32061constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
32062changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
32063both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
32064
32065There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
32066log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
32067when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
32068instructions when it is run with no arguments.
32069
32070The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
32071sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
32072retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
32073which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
32074By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
32075of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
32076user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
32077&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
32078example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
32079authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
32080
32081The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
32082rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
32083&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
32084ACL.
32085
32086Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
32087specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
32088or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
32089&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
32090using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
32091separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
32092
32093Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
32094any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
32095stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
32096remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
32097remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
32098behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
32099the &%count=%& option.
32100
32101
32102.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
32103.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
32104The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
32105normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
32106&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
32107
32108The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
32109the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
32110&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
32111&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32112
32113The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
32114the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
32115in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
32116used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
32117in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
32118follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
32119in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32120
32121The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32122accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32123&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
32124&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32125ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32126in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32127recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32128
32129The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32130number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32131last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32132recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32133&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
32134
32135The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32136condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32137command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32138multiple different commands.
32139
32140The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32141measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32142&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32143increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32144other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32145
32146The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32147
32148
32149.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32150.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32151You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32152control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32153mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32154
32155If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32156previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32157
32158For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32159it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32160can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32161in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32162new rate.
32163.code
32164acl_check_connect:
32165 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32166 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32167 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32168# ...
32169acl_check_mail:
32170 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32171 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32172 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32173.endd
32174
32175If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32176processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32177it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32178in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32179same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32180multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32181checks.
32182
32183The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32184use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32185update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32186&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32187next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32188
32189
32190.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32191.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32192If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32193engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32194&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32195counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32196rest of the ACL.
32197
32198The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32199updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32200client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32201up to the given limit.
32202This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32203consists of refusing the message, and
32204is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32205If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32206likely not what is wanted.
32207
32208The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32209updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32210of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32211actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32212counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32213pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32214again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32215attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32216.code
32217 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
32218.endd
32219
32220
32221.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
32222.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
32223The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
32224rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
32225mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
32226sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
32227&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
32228measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
32229options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
32230
32231For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
32232has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
32233rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
32234per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
32235go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
32236recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
32237
32238When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
32239&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
32240rate.
32241
32242The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
32243other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
32244unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32245required increases with larger limits.
32246
32247The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32248will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32249the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32250the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32251events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32252times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32253throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32254limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32255are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32256as intended.
32257
32258
32259.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32260Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32261when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32262(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32263policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32264message. For example:
32265.code
32266# Log all senders' rates
32267warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32268 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32269
32270# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32271# at the decimal point.
32272warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32273 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32274 $sender_rate_limit }s
32275
32276# Keep authenticated users under control
32277deny authenticated = *
32278 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32279
32280# System-wide rate limit
32281defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32282 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32283
32284# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32285# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32286defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32287 messages per $sender_rate_period
32288 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32289 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32290 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32291.endd
32292&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32293especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32294bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32295making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32296RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32297this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32298hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32299
32300
32301
32302.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32303.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32304.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32305Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32306&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32307&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32308The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32309verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32310other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32311.code
32312verify = sender/callout
32313verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32314.endd
32315The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32316address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32317difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32318be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32319(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32320The available options are as follows:
32321
32322.ilist
32323If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32324remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32325check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32326.next
32327If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32328normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32329options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32330verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32331.next
32332The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32333discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32334.next
32335The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32336immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32337generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32338discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32339.endlist
32340
32341.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32342.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32343.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32344.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32345After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32346error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32347coding like this:
32348.code
32349warn !verify = sender
32350 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32351.endd
32352If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32353denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32354verification failure.
32355
32356In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32357appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32358
32359.ilist
32360&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32361was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32362.next
32363&%route%&: Routing failed.
32364.next
32365&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32366occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32367connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32368.next
32369&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32370.next
32371&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32372.endlist
32373
32374The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32375rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32376
32377The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32378address verification to:
32379
32380.ilist
32381&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32382.endlist
32383
32384
32385
32386
32387.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32388.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32389.cindex "callout" "verification"
32390.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32391For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32392checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32393the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32394&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32395a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32396address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32397sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32398deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32399sender's domain.
32400
32401Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32402request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32403described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32404lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32405cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32406caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32407
32408Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32409the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32410callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32411callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32412on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32413
32414If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32415second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32416one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32417&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32418router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32419&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32420&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32421supplies a host list.
32422Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32423
32424The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32425remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32426specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32427specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32428specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32429the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32430&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32431
32432For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32433test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32434following SMTP commands are sent:
32435.display
32436&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32437&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32438&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32439&`QUIT`&
32440.endd
32441LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32442set to &"lmtp"&.
32443
32444The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32445settings.
32446
32447A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32448for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32449the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32450that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32451do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32452&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32453
32454If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32455succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32456Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32457hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32458&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32459
32460.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32461A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32462output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32463clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32464disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32465
32466
32467
32468
32469.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32470.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32471The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32472optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32473.code
32474verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32475.endd
32476The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32477separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32478deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32479
32480
32481.vlist
32482.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32483.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32484This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32485For example:
32486.code
32487verify = sender/callout=5s
32488.endd
32489The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32490remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32491the &%connect%& parameter.
32492
32493
32494.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32495.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32496This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32497for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32498.code
32499verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32500.endd
32501If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32502
32503.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32504.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32505When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32506of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32507updated in this circumstance.
32508
32509.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32510.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32511This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32512&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32513accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32514unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32515
32516
32517.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32518.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32519When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32520verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32521sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32522whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32523MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32524as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32525(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32526address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32527.code
32528require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32529.endd
32530This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32531
32532
32533.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32534.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32535This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32536For example:
32537.code
32538verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32539.endd
32540This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32541commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32542be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32543very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32544(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32545
32546
32547.vitem &*no_cache*&
32548.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32549.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32550When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32551
32552.vitem &*postmaster*&
32553.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32554When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32555check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32556rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32557the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32558used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32559made, until the cache record expires.
32560
32561.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32562The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32563You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32564For example:
32565.code
32566require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32567.endd
32568If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32569one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32570.code
32571require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32572.endd
32573&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32574account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32575a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32576postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32577
32578
32579.vitem &*random*&
32580.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32581When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32582check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32583really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32584&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32585.code
32586$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32587.endd
32588The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32589parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32590specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32591a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32592succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32593
32594.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32595.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32596This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32597.code
32598deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32599.endd
32600.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32601It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32602performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32603that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32604domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32605
32606.vitem &*use_sender*&
32607This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32608.code
32609require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32610.endd
32611It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32612command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32613need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32614sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32615usefulness of callout caching.
32616
32617.vitem &*hold*&
32618This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32619.code
32620require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32621.endd
32622It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32623and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32624Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32625when that is used for the connections.
32626The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32627(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32628if the use_sender option is used,
32629if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32630and if no other callouts intervene.
32631.endlist
32632
32633If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32634command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32635&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32636usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32637that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32638Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32639these circumstances.
32640
32641However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32642host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32643callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32644sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32645callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32646own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32647is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32648
32649Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32650caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32651by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32652actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32653
32654
32655
32656
32657.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32658.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32659.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32660.cindex "caching" "callout"
32661Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32662used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32663option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32664different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32665a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32666entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32667
32668When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32669the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32670is not available.
32671
32672The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32673independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32674(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32675
32676If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32677commands up to and including
32678.code
32679MAIL FROM:<>
32680.endd
32681(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32682any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32683domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32684making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32685separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32686&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32687&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32688
32689Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32690cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32691Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32692ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32693will eventually be noticed.
32694
32695The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32696being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32697behaviour will be the same.
32698
32699
32700
32701.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32702.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32703See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32704verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32705failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32706relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32707you might see:
32708.code
32709MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32710250 OK
32711RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32712550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32713550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32714550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32715550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32716550 Sender verification failed
32717.endd
32718If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32719only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32720out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32721&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32722example:
32723.code
32724verify = sender/no_details
32725.endd
32726
32727.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32728.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32729.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32730A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32731during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32732or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32733it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32734
32735.ilist
32736When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32737continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32738verification also fails.
32739.next
32740When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32741verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32742.endlist
32743
32744This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32745way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32746example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32747.code
32748A.Wol: aw123
32749aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32750.endd
32751work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32752redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32753mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32754verification to succeed.
32755
32756It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32757redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32758generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32759option. For example:
32760.code
32761require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32762.endd
32763In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32764the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32765
32766When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32767redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32768also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32769address and a report is output for each of them.
32770
32771
32772
32773.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32774.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32775Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32776which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32777special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32778domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32779Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32780.code
32781verify = csa
32782.endd
32783This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32784valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32785succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32786&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32787&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32788be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32789
32790The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32791detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32792looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32793address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32794
32795.ilist
32796The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32797.next
32798The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32799.next
32800The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32801(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32802.next
32803The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32804that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32805.endlist
32806
32807The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32808use for the DNS query. The default is:
32809.code
32810verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32811.endd
32812This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32813is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32814address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32815the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32816meaningful to say:
32817.code
32818verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32819.endd
32820In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32821This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32822&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32823
32824If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32825is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32826making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32827using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32828default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32829default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32830(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32831of legitimate HELO domains.
32832
32833The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32834direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32835search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32836addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32837lookup such as:
32838.code
32839${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32840.endd
32841has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32842The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32843authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32844
32845
32846
32847
32848.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32849.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32850Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32851of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32852Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32853recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32854bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32855spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32856
32857There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32858&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32859the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32860address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32861item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32862The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32863&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32864The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32865
32866As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32867database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32868like this:
32869.code
32870PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32871 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32872 }{$value}}
32873.endd
32874Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32875list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32876use this:
32877.code
32878# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32879deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32880 senders = :
32881 recipients = +batv_senders
32882
32883# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32884deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32885 senders = :
32886 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32887 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32888 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32889.endd
32890The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32891to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32892send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32893recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32894the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32895
32896A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32897&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32898prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32899the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32900the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32901timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32902of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32903
32904There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32905you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32906deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32907router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32908.code
32909batv_redirect:
32910 driver = redirect
32911 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32912.endd
32913This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32914of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32915address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32916local addresses.
32917
32918To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32919can be used:
32920.code
32921external_smtp_batv:
32922 driver = smtp
32923 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32924 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32925 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32926 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32927 {$value}fail}}}
32928.endd
32929If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32930
32931
32932
32933.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32934.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32935.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32936.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32937An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32938delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32939within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32940passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32941.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32942but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32943
32944Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32945A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32946relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32947a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32948with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32949same host is fulfilling both functions,
32950. ///
32951. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32952. ///
32953but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32954not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32955system to arbitrary domains.
32956
32957
32958You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32959runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32960Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32961example, suppose you want to do the following:
32962
32963.ilist
32964Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32965locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32966&'my.dom2.example'&.
32967.next
32968Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32969These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32970.next
32971Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32972Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32973.endlist
32974
32975
32976In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32977.code
32978domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32979domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32980hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32981.endd
32982Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32983command:
32984.code
32985acl_check_rcpt:
32986 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32987 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32988.endd
32989The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32990the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32991statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32992hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32993than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32994default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32995in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32996
32997
32998
32999.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
33000.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
33001You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
33002that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
33003the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
33004.ecindex IIDacl
33005
33006
33007
33008. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33009. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33010
33011.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
33012.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
33013The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
33014as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
33015was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
33016maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
33017specification.
33018
33019It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
33020&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
33021scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
33022messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
33023chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
33024
33025If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
33026Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
33027&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
33028
33029.ilist
33030Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
33031for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
33032.next
33033Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
33034&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
33035run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
33036.next
33037An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
33038of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
33039.next
33040Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
33041conditions.
33042.next
33043Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
33044.endlist
33045
33046Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
33047added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
33048changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
33049EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
33050this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
33051&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
33052
33053All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
33054temporarily created in a file called:
33055.display
33056<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
33057.endd
33058The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
33059expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
33060first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
33061scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
33062removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
33063.code
33064control = no_mbox_unspool
33065.endd
33066has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
33067same directory by default.
33068
33069
33070
33071.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
33072.cindex "virus scanning"
33073.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
33074.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
33075The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
33076It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
33077specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
33078in memory and thus are much faster.
33079
33080Since message data needs to have arrived,
33081the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
33082&%acl_smtp_data%&,
33083&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
33084&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
33085&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
33086
33087A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
33088if it expires then a defer action is taken.
33089
33090.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
33091You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
33092to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
33093are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
33094.display
33095&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
33096.endd
33097If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
33098.code
33099av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
33100.endd
33101If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
33102before use.
33103The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
33104The following scanner types are supported in this release,
33105though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
33106
33107.vlist
33108.vitem &%avast%&
33109.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
33110This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
33111Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
33112You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
33113at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
33114This scanner type takes one option,
33115which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33116or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33117The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33118single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33119A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33120Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33121the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33122
33123.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33124If &`pass_unscanned`&
33125is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33126decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33127care.
33128
33129For example:
33130.code
33131av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33132av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33133av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33134.endd
33135If you omit the argument, the default path
33136&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33137is used.
33138If you use a remote host,
33139you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33140as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33141For information about available commands and their options you may use
33142.code
33143$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33144 FLAGS
33145 SENSITIVITY
33146 PACK
33147.endd
33148
33149If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33150permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33151written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33152
33153.vitem &%aveserver%&
33154.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33155This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33156at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33157which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33158example:
33159.code
33160av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33161.endd
33162
33163
33164.vitem &%clamd%&
33165.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33166This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33167&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33168unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33169in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33170
33171The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33172a UNIX socket specification,
33173a TCP socket specification,
33174or a (global) option.
33175
33176A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
33177For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
33178for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
33179and the second a port number,
33180Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
33181These per-server options are supported:
33182.code
33183retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33184.endd
33185
33186The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33187a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
33188
33189If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
33190
33191Examples:
33192.code
33193av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
33194av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
33195av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
33196av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
33197av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
33198.endd
33199If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
33200&`local`&
33201option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
33202to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
33203more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
33204Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
33205
33206The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
33207randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
33208that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
33209socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
33210unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
33211When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
33212not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
33213selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
33214email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
33215.code
332162013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
33217 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
33218 (Connection refused)
33219.endd
33220
33221If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
33222contributing the code for this scanner.
33223
33224.vitem &%cmdline%&
33225.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
33226This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
33227used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
33228type takes 3 mandatory options:
33229
33230.olist
33231The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
33232and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
33233
33234.next
33235A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
33236virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
33237absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
33238the &"trigger"& expression.
33239
33240.next
33241Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
33242match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
33243&"name"& expression.
33244.endlist olist
33245
33246For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33247.code
33248Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33249.endd
33250For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33251name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33252for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33253configuration setting:
33254.code
33255av_scanner = cmdline:\
33256 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33257 found in file:'(.+)'
33258.endd
33259.vitem &%drweb%&
33260.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33261The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33262takes one option,
33263either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33264or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33265The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33266single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33267For example:
33268.code
33269av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33270av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33271.endd
33272If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33273is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33274
33275.vitem &%f-protd%&
33276.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33277The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33278One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33279(or port-range).
33280For example:
33281.code
33282av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33283.endd
33284If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33285
33286.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33287.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33288The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33289One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33290For example:
33291.code
33292av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33293.endd
33294If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33295
33296.vitem &%fsecure%&
33297.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33298The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33299argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33300.code
33301av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33302.endd
33303If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33304Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33305
33306.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33307.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33308This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33309Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33310scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33311For example:
33312.code
33313av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33314.endd
33315The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33316
33317.vitem &%mksd%&
33318.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33319This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33320though some documentation was available in English.
33321The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33322and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33323we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33324to integrate.
33325The only option for this scanner type is
33326the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33327provided that mksd has
33328been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33329.code
33330av_scanner = mksd:2
33331.endd
33332You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33333
33334.vitem &%sock%&
33335.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33336This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33337running on the local machine.
33338There are four options:
33339an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33340a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33341the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33342an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33343and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33344For example:
33345.code
33346av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33347.endd
33348Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33349there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33350The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33351Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33352specify an empty element to get this.
33353
33354.vitem &%sophie%&
33355.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33356Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33357You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33358for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33359client communication. For example:
33360.code
33361av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33362.endd
33363The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33364the option.
33365.endlist
33366
33367When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33368the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33369ACL.
33370
33371The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33372makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33373The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33374for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33375However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33376which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33377message.
33378
33379The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33380use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33381The first element can then be one of
33382
33383.ilist
33384&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33385The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33386recommended usage.
33387.next
33388&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33389the condition fails immediately.
33390.next
33391A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33392condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33393expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33394Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33395unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33396.endlist
33397
33398You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33399messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33400Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33401
33402You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33403specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33404For example:
33405.code
33406malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33407.endd
33408A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33409
33410.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33411When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33412is set to record the actual address used.
33413
33414.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33415When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33416&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33417&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33418logging data.
33419
33420Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33421imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33422
33423Here is a very simple scanning example:
33424.code
33425deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33426 malware = *
33427.endd
33428The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33429.code
33430deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33431 malware = */defer_ok
33432.endd
33433The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33434aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33435.code
33436av_scanner = $acl_m0
33437.endd
33438in the main Exim configuration.
33439.code
33440deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33441 set acl_m0 = sophie
33442 malware = *
33443
33444deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33445 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33446 malware = *
33447.endd
33448
33449
33450.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33451.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33452.cindex "spam scanning"
33453.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33454.cindex "Rspamd"
33455The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33456score and a report for the message.
33457Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33458
33459For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33460Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33461&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33462
33463SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33464.code
33465perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33466.endd
33467SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33468documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33469nicely, however.
33470
33471.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33472By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33473intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33474&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33475you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33476configuration as follows (example):
33477.code
33478spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33479.endd
33480The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33481If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33482iptables firewall, consider setting
33483&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33484timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33485server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33486connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33487soon.
33488
33489
33490To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33491on TCP port 11333)
33492you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33493.code
33494spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33495.endd
33496
33497As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33498sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33499filename instead of an address/port pair:
33500.code
33501spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33502.endd
33503You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33504reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33505&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33506option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33507.code
33508spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33509 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33510 192.168.2.12 783
33511.endd
33512Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33513When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33514servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33515condition defers.
33516
33517Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33518Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33519and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33520take care to not double the separator.
33521
33522For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33523subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33524and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33525In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33526
33527Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33528are options.
33529The supported options are:
33530.code
33531pri=<priority> Selection priority
33532weight=<value> Selection bias
33533time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33534retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33535tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33536variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33537.endd
33538
33539The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33540higher values being tried first.
33541The default priority is 1.
33542
33543The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33544Within a priority set
33545servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33546The default value for selection bias is 1.
33547
33548Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33549in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33550Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33551characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33552
33553Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33554are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33555
33556The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33557The default value is two minutes.
33558
33559The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33560a failed connect is made.
33561The default is to not retry.
33562
33563The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33564a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33565used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33566expansion.
33567
33568.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33569When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33570is set to record the actual address used.
33571
33572.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33573Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33574.code
33575deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33576 spam = joe
33577.endd
33578The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33579relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33580to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33581default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33582Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33583right-hand side.
33584
33585The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33586principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33587have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33588&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33589read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33590are not set.
33591Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33592(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33593after the first),
33594or the use of PRDR,
33595.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33596are needed to use this feature.
33597
33598The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33599you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33600&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33601
33602
33603Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33604large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33605are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33606example:
33607.code
33608deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33609 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33610 spam = nobody
33611.endd
33612
33613The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33614SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33615&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33616it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33617
33618.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33619When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33620variables.
33621Except for &$spam_report$&,
33622these variables are saved with the received message so are
33623available for use at delivery time.
33624
33625.vlist
33626.vitem &$spam_score$&
33627The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33628for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33629
33630.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33631The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33632example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33633because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33634The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33635
33636.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33637A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33638integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33639&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33640headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33641spam bar is 50 characters.
33642
33643.vitem &$spam_report$&
33644A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33645message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33646This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33647Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33648when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33649unencoded in headers.
33650
33651.vitem &$spam_action$&
33652For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33653spam score versus threshold.
33654For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33655
33656.endlist
33657
33658The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33659spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33660does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33661
33662The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33663the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33664failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33665statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33666spam condition, like this:
33667.code
33668deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33669 spam = joe/defer_ok
33670.endd
33671This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33672
33673Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33674condition:
33675.code
33676# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33677warn spam = nobody:true
33678 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33679 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33680
33681# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33682# is over threshold
33683warn spam = nobody
33684 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33685
33686# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33687deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33688 spam = nobody:true
33689 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33690.endd
33691
33692
33693
33694.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33695.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33696.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33697.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33698.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33699The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33700each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33701of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33702specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33703options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33704cases.
33705
33706These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33707ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33708the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33709message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33710ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33711result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33712&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33713
33714You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33715only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33716condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33717&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33718&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33719
33720At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33721information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33722of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33723parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33724part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33725syntax is:
33726.display
33727&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33728.endd
33729The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33730the value can be:
33731
33732.olist
33733&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33734.next
33735The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33736&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33737a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33738full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33739.next
33740A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33741directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33742is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33743the full path and filename.
33744.next
33745If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33746filename, and the default path is then used.
33747.endlist
33748The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33749errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33750a file with its original, proposed filename using
33751.code
33752decode = $mime_filename
33753.endd
33754However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33755anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33756automatically unlinked.
33757
33758For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33759content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33760as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33761variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33762before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33763
33764The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33765used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33766respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33767
33768.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33769The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33770available in the MIME ACL:
33771
33772.vlist
33773.vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
33774 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33775.vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
33776.vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33777If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
33778the detected issue.
33779
33780.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33781.vindex &$mime_boundary$&
33782If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
33783have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33784has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33785contains the empty string.
33786
33787.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33788.vindex &$mime_charset$&
33789This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33790&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33791.code
33792us-ascii
33793gb2312 (Chinese)
33794iso-8859-1
33795.endd
33796Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33797case-insensitively.
33798
33799.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33800.vindex &$mime_content_description$&
33801This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33802header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33803implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33804only used for display purposes.
33805
33806.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33807.vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
33808This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33809header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33810
33811.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33812.vindex &$mime_content_id$&
33813This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33814This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33815
33816.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33817.vindex &$mime_content_size$&
33818This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33819successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33820size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33821has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33822
33823.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33824.vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33825This variable contains the normalized content of the
33826&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33827type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33828
33829.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33830.vindex &$mime_content_type$&
33831If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33832value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33833are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33834.code
33835text/plain
33836text/html
33837application/octet-stream
33838image/jpeg
33839audio/midi
33840.endd
33841If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33842empty string.
33843
33844.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33845.vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33846This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33847successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33848containing the decoded data.
33849.endlist
33850
33851.cindex "RFC 2047"
33852.vlist
33853.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33854.vindex &$mime_filename$&
33855This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33856proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33857&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33858RFC2047
33859or RFC2231
33860decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33861 If no filename was
33862found, this variable contains the empty string.
33863
33864.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33865.vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33866This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33867attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33868content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33869
33870The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33871cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33872follows:
33873
33874.olist
33875The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33876
33877.next
33878If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33879so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33880
33881.next
33882If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33883and the rest are attachments.
33884
33885.next
33886All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33887.endlist olist
33888
33889As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33890alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33891coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33892.code
33893deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33894!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33895condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33896condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33897.endd
33898
33899.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33900.vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
33901This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33902&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33903Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33904want to carry out specific actions on them.
33905
33906.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33907.vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33908This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33909checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33910decoding is fully recursive.
33911
33912.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33913.vindex &$mime_part_count$&
33914This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33915starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33916counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33917&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33918complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33919parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33920.endlist
33921
33922
33923
33924.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33925.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33926.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33927You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33928the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33929
33930The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33931matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33932MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33933linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33934have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33935
33936The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33937to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33938part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33939is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33940and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3394132K characters are checked.
33942
33943The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33944literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33945expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33946with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33947Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33948.code
33949deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33950 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33951.endd
33952The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33953&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33954matching regular expression.
33955The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33956are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33957
33958&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33959CPU-intensive.
33960
33961.ecindex IIDcosca
33962
33963
33964
33965
33966. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33967. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33968
33969.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33970 "Local scan function"
33971.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33972.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33973.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33974In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33975want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33976
33977The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33978passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33979a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33980condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33981non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33982
33983To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33984possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33985in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33986can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33987
33988The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33989when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33990It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33991well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33992
33993Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33994option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33995Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33996Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33997before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33998are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33999incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
34000For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
34001code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
34002
34003
34004
34005.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
34006.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
34007To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
34008function is before building Exim, by setting
34009both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
34010LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
34011&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
34012directory, so you might set
34013.code
34014HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
34015LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
34016.endd
34017for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
34018.new
34019the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
34020and then #include "local_scan.h".
34021.wen
34022It is called by
34023Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
34024be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
34025function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
34026commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
34027_src/local_scan.c_.
34028
34029If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
34030for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
34031.code
34032LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34033.endd
34034in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
34035
34036
34037
34038
34039.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
34040.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
34041.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
34042You must include this line near the start of your code:
34043.code
34044#define LOCAL_SCAN
34045#include "local_scan.h"
34046.endd
34047This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
34048prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
34049almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
34050for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
34051It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
34052strings and pointers to character strings:
34053.code
34054#define CS (char *)
34055#define CCS (const char *)
34056#define CSS (char **)
34057#define US (unsigned char *)
34058#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
34059#define USS (unsigned char **)
34060.endd
34061The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
34062.code
34063extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
34064.endd
34065The arguments are as follows:
34066
34067.ilist
34068&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
34069(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
34070recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
34071
34072The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
34073character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
34074id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
34075macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
34076case this changes in some future version.
34077.next
34078&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
34079string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
34080.endlist
34081
34082The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
34083
34084.vlist
34085.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
34086.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
34087The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
34088the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
34089newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
34090maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
34091
34092.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
34093This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34094queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
34095
34096.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
34097This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34098queued without immediate delivery.
34099
34100.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
34101The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
34102passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
34103they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
34104&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
34105used.
34106
34107.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
34108The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
34109message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
34110problem"& is used.
34111
34112.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34113This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
34114message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
34115&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
34116&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
34117&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
34118same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34119
34120.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34121This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
34122LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34123.endlist
34124
34125If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
34126reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
34127&%-oe%& command line options.
34128
34129
34130
34131.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
34132.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
34133It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
34134that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
34135want to do this, you must have the line
34136.code
34137LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34138.endd
34139in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
34140&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
34141file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
34142to define them.
34143
34144The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34145&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34146and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34147alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34148variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34149entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34150.code
34151static int my_integer_option = 42;
34152static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34153
34154optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34155 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34156 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34157};
34158
34159int local_scan_options_count =
34160 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34161.endd
34162The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34163configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34164.code
34165begin local_scan
34166my_integer = 99
34167my_string = some string of text...
34168.endd
34169The available types of option data are as follows:
34170
34171.vlist
34172.vitem &*opt_bool*&
34173This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34174variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34175that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
34176whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
34177TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
34178values.)
34179
34180.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
34181This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
34182The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
34183multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
34184
34185.vitem &*opt_int*&
34186This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
34187&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
34188Exim.
34189
34190.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
34191This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
34192&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
34193printed with the suffix K or M.
34194
34195.vitem &*opt_octint*&
34196This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
34197octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
34198always output in octal.
34199
34200.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
34201This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
34202variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
34203
34204.vitem &*opt_time*&
34205This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
34206type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
34207.endlist
34208
34209If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
34210out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
34211
34212
34213
34214.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
34215.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
34216The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
34217are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
34218Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
34219including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
34220C variables are as follows:
34221
34222.vlist
34223.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
34224This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
34225It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34226
34227.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
34228This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
34229It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34230
34231.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
34232This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
34233is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
34234&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
34235
34236.ilist
34237The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
34238testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
34239other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
34240
34241.next
34242The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
34243by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
34244of debugging bits.
34245.endlist ilist
34246
34247Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
34248selected, you should use code like this:
34249.code
34250if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34251 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34252.endd
34253.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
34254After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
34255variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
34256
34257.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
34258A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
34259discussed below.
34260
34261.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
34262A pointer to the last of the header lines.
34263
34264.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
34265The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
34266
34267.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34268This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34269&%-bh%& command line option.
34270
34271.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34272The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34273is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34274
34275.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34276The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34277command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34278specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34279
34280.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34281This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34282&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34283
34284.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34285The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34286
34287.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34288The number of accepted recipients.
34289
34290.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34291.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34292.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34293The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34294&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34295can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34296below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34297adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34298&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34299value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34300blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34301and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34302
34303.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34304The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34305
34306.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34307The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34308locally-submitted messages.
34309
34310.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34311The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34312was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34313
34314.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34315The name of the sending host, if known.
34316
34317.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34318The port on the sending host.
34319
34320.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34321This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34322
34323.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34324This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34325
34326.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34327The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34328requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34329.endlist
34330
34331
34332.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34333The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34334You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34335(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34336their type to *.
34337
34338
34339.vlist
34340.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34341A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34342
34343.vitem &*int&~type*&
34344A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34345characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34346Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34347with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34348rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34349lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34350
34351.vitem &*int&~slen*&
34352The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34353internal newlines.
34354
34355.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34356A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34357a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34358.endlist
34359
34360
34361
34362.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34363The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34364
34365.vlist
34366.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34367This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34368
34369.vitem &*int&~pno*&
34370This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34371the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34372and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34373
34374.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34375If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34376recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34377envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34378router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34379an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34380&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34381is NULL for all recipients.
34382.endlist
34383
34384
34385
34386.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34387.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34388The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34389These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34390release:
34391
34392.vlist
34393.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34394 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34395
34396This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34397&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34398be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34399for the process in &%newumask%&.
34400
34401Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34402and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34403standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34404descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34405argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34406
34407The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34408
34409.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34410This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34411seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34412return value is as follows:
34413
34414.ilist
34415>= 0
34416
34417The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34418ending status.
34419
34420.next
34421< 0 and > &--256
34422
34423The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34424signal number.
34425
34426.next
34427&--256
34428
34429The process timed out.
34430.next
34431&--257
34432
34433The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34434.endlist
34435
34436.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34437This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34438Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34439want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34440forks a subprocess that is running
34441.code
34442exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34443.endd
34444and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34445that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34446of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34447recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34448
34449When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34450finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34451fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34452addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34453
34454
34455.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34456 *sender_authentication)*&
34457This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34458that it runs is:
34459.display
34460&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34461.endd
34462The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34463
34464
34465.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34466This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34467output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34468calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34469conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34470.code
34471if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34472 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34473.endd
34474
34475.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34476This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34477expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34478The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34479expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34480the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34481block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34482&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34483
34484.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34485This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34486existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34487character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34488substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34489if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34490
34491.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34492 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34493This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34494chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34495
34496If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34497&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34498NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34499matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34500&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34501found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34502marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34503option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34504top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34505headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34506.code
34507header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34508 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34509.endd
34510Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34511there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34512
34513
34514.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34515This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34516occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34517particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34518match the specification, the function does nothing.
34519
34520
34521.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34522 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34523This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34524a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34525colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34526&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34527.code
34528if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34529.endd
34530.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34531.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34532This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34533The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34534back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34535zero-terminated.
34536
34537.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34538This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34539zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34540to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34541string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34542yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34543easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34544added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34545
34546.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34547This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34548matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34549.display
34550&`OK `& match succeeded
34551&`FAIL `& match failed
34552&`DEFER `& match deferred
34553.endd
34554DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34555inability to contact a database.
34556
34557.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34558 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34559This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34560controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34561&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34562
34563.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34564 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34565This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34566controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34567matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34568
34569.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34570 uschar&~*list)*&"
34571This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34572expected to be
34573.code
34574lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34575.endd
34576.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34577An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34578is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34579looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34580values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34581returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34582failed.
34583
34584.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34585 *format,&~...)*&"
34586This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34587is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34588&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34589them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34590arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34591contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34592
34593
34594.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34595This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34596is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34597with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34598
34599This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34600described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34601the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34602value afterwards. For example:
34603.code
34604 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34605 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34606 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34607.endd
34608
34609.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34610This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34611recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34612matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34613address.
34614.endlist
34615
34616
34617.cindex "RFC 2047"
34618.vlist
34619.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34620 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34621This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34622these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34623from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34624a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34625made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34626binary string is returned with an error message.
34627
34628The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34629maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34630encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34631
34632.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34633.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34634If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34635contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34636not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34637
34638The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34639&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34640which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34641
34642If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34643argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34644set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34645returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34646with translation.
34647
34648
34649.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34650This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34651below.
34652
34653.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34654The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34655output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34656stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34657SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34658is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34659opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34660test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34661is involved.
34662
34663If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34664output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34665
34666The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34667(when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34668This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34669sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34670
34671The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34672Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34673ABI version number was incremented.
34674
34675Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34676must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34677LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34678LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34679initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34680to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34681that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34682.code
34683smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34684return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34685.endd
34686Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34687the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34688&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34689multiple output lines.
34690
34691The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34692does not
34693guarantee a flush of
34694pending output, and therefore does not test
34695the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34696detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34697you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34698dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34699arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34700is an error.
34701
34702.new
34703.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34704This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34705chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34706The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34707data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34708FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34709Exim bombs out if it ever
34710runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34711.wen
34712
34713.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34714This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34715permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34716
34717.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34718See below.
34719
34720.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34721See below.
34722
34723.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34724These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34725The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34726number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34727and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34728pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34729more discussion.
34730.endlist
34731
34732
34733
34734.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34735.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34736No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34737The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34738recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34739to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34740message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34741terminates.
34742
34743Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34744data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34745connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34746one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34747
34748If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34749in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34750.code
34751store_pool = POOL_PERM
34752.endd
34753before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34754restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34755the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34756set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34757
34758The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34759&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34760There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34761block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34762&%store_pool%&.
34763.ecindex IIDlosca
34764
34765
34766
34767
34768. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34769. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34770
34771.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34772.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34773.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34774.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34775The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34776that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34777also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34778they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34779
34780The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34781is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34782It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34783commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34784The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34785
34786The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34787is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34788the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34789If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34790of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34791prevent it happening on retries.
34792
34793.vindex "&$domain$&"
34794.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34795&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34796specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34797&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34798you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34799independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34800described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34801
34802
34803.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34804.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34805.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34806The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34807setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34808other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34809&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34810.code
34811system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34812system_filter_user = exim
34813.endd
34814If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34815&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34816specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34817&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34818&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34819by the &%reply%& command.
34820
34821
34822.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34823You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34824filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34825are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34826
34827If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34828you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34829
34830
34831
34832.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34833The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34834files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34835mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34836available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34837If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34838they cause errors.
34839
34840.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34841There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34842files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34843is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34844&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34845subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34846manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34847
34848&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34849specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34850succeed, it will not be tried again.
34851If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34852arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34853
34854When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34855&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34856users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34857to which users' filter files can refer.
34858
34859
34860
34861.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34862.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34863The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34864of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34865filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34866
34867
34868
34869.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34870.cindex "freezing messages"
34871.cindex "message" "freezing"
34872.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34873.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34874.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34875.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34876There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34877always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34878filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34879for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34880word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34881.code
34882fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34883.endd
34884The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34885
34886The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34887message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34888and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34889delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34890that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34891run.
34892
34893The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34894not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34895filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34896is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34897
34898.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34899.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34900The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34901well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34902up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34903log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34904two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34905strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34906message. For example:
34907.code
34908fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34909 because it contains attachments that we are \
34910 not prepared to receive."
34911.endd
34912
34913.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34914Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34915the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34916the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34917command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34918Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34919use, for example
34920.code
34921if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34922then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34923.endd
34924though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34925alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34926generated by the filter.
34927
34928The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34929&%defer%&,
34930&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34931set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34932as
34933.code
34934mail ...
34935freeze
34936.endd
34937to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34938failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34939take place.
34940
34941
34942
34943.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34944.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34945.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34946.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34947Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34948.code
34949headers add <string>
34950headers remove <string>
34951.endd
34952The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34953added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34954filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34955space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34956forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34957
34958You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34959continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34960including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34961example:
34962.code
34963headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34964 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34965 X-header-2: ...."
34966.endd
34967Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34968be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34969space after input continuations is ignored.
34970
34971The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34972This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34973those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34974&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34975header with the same name, they are all removed.
34976
34977The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34978of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34979from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34980modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34981Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34982used for all recipients of the message.
34983
34984During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34985header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34986that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34987routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34988routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34989until the message is actually being written (see section
34990&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34991
34992If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34993added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34994present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34995present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34996message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34997conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34998modified more than once.
34999
35000Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
35001use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
35002For example:
35003.code
35004headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
35005headers remove "Subject"
35006headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
35007headers remove "Old-Subject"
35008.endd
35009
35010
35011
35012.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
35013.cindex "envelope from"
35014.cindex "envelope sender"
35015In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
35016.code
35017errors_to <some address>
35018.endd
35019in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
35020delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
35021user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
35022might use
35023.code
35024unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
35025.endd
35026to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
35027address if its delivery failed.
35028
35029
35030
35031.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
35032.vindex "&$domain$&"
35033.vindex "&$local_part$&"
35034In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
35035delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
35036operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
35037such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
35038filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
35039which implements such a filter:
35040.code
35041central_filter:
35042 check_local_user
35043 driver = redirect
35044 domains = +local_domains
35045 file = /central/filters/$local_part
35046 no_verify
35047 allow_filter
35048 allow_freeze
35049.endd
35050The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
35051&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
35052the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
35053use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
35054
35055Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
35056specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
35057its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
35058address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
35059normal way.
35060.ecindex IIDsysfil1
35061.ecindex IIDsysfil2
35062.ecindex IIDsysfil3
35063
35064
35065
35066
35067
35068
35069. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35070. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35071
35072.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
35073.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
35074Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
35075all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
35076these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
35077this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
35078removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
35079before it is placed on Exim's queue.
35080
35081Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
35082&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
35083that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
35084its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
35085set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
35086
35087&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
35088or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
35089loopback interface specially in any way.
35090
35091If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
35092that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
35093
35094
35095
35096
35097.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
35098.cindex "message" "submission"
35099.cindex "submission mode"
35100Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
35101&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
35102received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
35103state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
35104.code
35105control = submission
35106.endd
35107in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
35108&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
35109a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
35110known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
35111example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
35112interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
35113.code
35114warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
35115 control = submission
35116.endd
35117.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
35118There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
35119is used to separate options. For example:
35120.code
35121control = submission/sender_retain
35122.endd
35123Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
35124true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
35125of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
35126the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
35127authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
35128&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
35129attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
35130
35131When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
35132domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
35133example:
35134.code
35135control = submission/domain=some.domain
35136.endd
35137The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
35138&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
35139that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
35140&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
35141.code
35142accept authenticated = *
35143 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35144 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35145 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35146.endd
35147Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35148option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35149the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35150.code
35151bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35152.endd
35153then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35154line would be:
35155.code
35156Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35157.endd
35158.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35159By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35160used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35161specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35162
35163&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35164ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35165untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35166specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35167does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35168spoof another's address.
35169
35170.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35171.cindex "line endings"
35172.cindex "carriage return"
35173.cindex "linefeed"
35174RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35175linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35176SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35177conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
35178use CRLF or just CR.
35179
35180Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
35181using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
35182receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
35183Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
35184MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
35185has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
35186that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
35187other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
35188follows:
35189
35190.ilist
35191LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
35192.next
35193CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
35194is ignored.
35195.next
35196The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
35197nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
35198terminator.
35199.next
35200If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
35201the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
35202is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
35203people trying to play silly games.
35204.next
35205If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
35206bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
35207line.
35208.endlist
35209
35210
35211
35212
35213
35214.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
35215.cindex "unqualified addresses"
35216.cindex "address" "qualification"
35217By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
35218host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
35219SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
35220messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
35221requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
35222
35223Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
35224sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
35225&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
35226cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
35227value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
35228
35229.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
35230.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
35231Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
35232that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
35233line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
35234are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
35235other words, such qualification is also controlled by
35236&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
35237
35238
35239
35240
35241.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
35242.cindex "&""From""& line"
35243.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
35244.cindex "sender" "address"
35245.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
35246.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
35247.cindex "envelope from"
35248.cindex "envelope sender"
35249.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35250Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
35251with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
35252&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
35253.code
35254From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
35255From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
35256.endd
35257This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
35258Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
35259via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
35260such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
35261&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
35262and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
35263regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
35264default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
35265that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
35266
35267.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35268When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35269a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35270contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35271then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35272qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35273the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35274
35275If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35276sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35277that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35278
35279Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35280treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35281as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35282incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35283
35284
35285
35286.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35287.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35288.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35289RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35290&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35291recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35292&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35293&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35294
35295.blockquote
35296&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35297processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35298.endblockquote
35299
35300This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35301address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35302follows:
35303
35304.ilist
35305A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35306is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35307.next
35308If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35309&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35310&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35311.next
35312For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35313also removed.
35314.next
35315For a locally-submitted message,
35316if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35317&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35318the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35319included in log lines in this case.
35320.next
35321The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35322&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35323.endlist
35324
35325
35326
35327
35328.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35329Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35330includes the header line:
35331.code
35332Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35333.endd
35334
35335.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35336.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35337If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35338message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35339extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35340existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35341
35342
35343.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35344.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35345.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35346If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35347Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35348&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35349
35350.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35351.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35352.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35353&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35354set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35355the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35356in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35357set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35358messages.
35359
35360
35361.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35362.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35363.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35364.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35365&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35366Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35367generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35368messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35369(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35370messages.
35371
35372
35373.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35374.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35375.cindex "header lines" "From:"
35376.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35377.cindex "message" "submission"
35378.cindex "submission mode"
35379If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35380adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35381
35382.ilist
35383The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35384message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35385.next
35386.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35387The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35388.olist
35389.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35390If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35391&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35392.next
35393If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35394part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35395.next
35396If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35397&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35398.endlist
35399.endlist
35400
35401A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35402
35403If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35404line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35405containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35406are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35407They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35408&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35409&%qualify_domain%&.
35410
35411For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35412&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35413user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35414name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35415
35416
35417.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35418.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35419.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35420.cindex "message" "submission"
35421.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35422If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35423&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35424&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35425to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35426creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35427message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35428followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35429in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35430&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35431
35432
35433.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35434.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35435.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35436A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35437contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35438Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35439
35440The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35441have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35442line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35443that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35444
35445Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35446changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35447-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35448
35449
35450.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35451.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35452.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35453Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35454header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35455section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35456header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35457responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35458processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35459than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35460incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3546111 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35462
35463
35464
35465.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35466.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35467.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35468.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35469&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35470it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35471transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35472transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35473default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35474
35475
35476
35477.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35478.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35479.cindex "message" "submission"
35480.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35481For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35482existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35483these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35484&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35485control setting.
35486
35487When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35488&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35489control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35490&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35491that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35492&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35493be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35494appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35495line is added to the message.
35496
35497If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35498the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35499&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35500options true at the same time.
35501
35502.cindex "submission mode"
35503By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35504received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35505a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35506not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35507
35508.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35509First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35510authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35511created as follows:
35512
35513.ilist
35514.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35515If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35516&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35517.next
35518If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35519is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35520.next
35521If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35522&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35523.endlist
35524
35525This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35526are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35527added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35528by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35529
35530.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35531&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35532the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35533except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35534
35535
35536
35537.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35538 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35539.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35540.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35541When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35542specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35543process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35544modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35545as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35546
35547In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35548specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35549addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35550changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35551transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35552they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35553
35554&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35555the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35556expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35557
35558For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35559option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35560newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35561.code
35562headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35563 X-added-second: another added header line
35564.endd
35565Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35566
35567Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35568specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35569Each header-line is separately expanded.
35570
35571The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35572list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35573often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35574not part of the names. For example:
35575.code
35576headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35577.endd
35578
35579Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35580specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35581Each item is separately expanded.
35582Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35583form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35584will act as list separators.
35585
35586When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35587items are expanded at routing time,
35588and then associated with all addresses that are
35589accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35590an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35591forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35592
35593.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35594However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35595the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35596&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35597
35598Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35599settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35600dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35601requirements.
35602
35603The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35604with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35605these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35606recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35607consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35608names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35609instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35610
35611After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35612lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35613the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35614header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35615
35616This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35617the following consequences:
35618
35619.ilist
35620The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35621remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35622to it, at all times.
35623.next
35624Header lines that are added by a router's
35625&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35626expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35627.next
35628Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35629in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35630.next
35631Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35632a later router or by a transport.
35633.next
35634An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35635removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35636.code
35637headers_remove = subject
35638headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35639.endd
35640.endlist
35641
35642&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35643for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35644
35645
35646
35647
35648
35649.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35650.cindex "address" "constructed"
35651.cindex "constructed address"
35652When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35653the form
35654.display
35655<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35656.endd
35657For example:
35658.code
35659Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35660.endd
35661The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35662otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35663&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35664ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35665upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35666&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35667The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35668there is no password file entry.
35669
35670.cindex "RFC 2047"
35671In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35672parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35673characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35674including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35675&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35676characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35677&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35678is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35679
35680
35681
35682.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35683.cindex "case of local parts"
35684.cindex "local part" "case of"
35685RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35686be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35687addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35688because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35689routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35690original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35691router option.
35692
35693.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35694If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35695assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35696your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35697correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35698.code
35699correct_case:
35700 driver = redirect
35701 domains = +local_domains
35702 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35703 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35704 @$domain
35705.endd
35706For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35707(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35708up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35709on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35710local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35711
35712
35713
35714.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35715.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35716.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35717RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35718part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35719middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35720empty components for compatibility.
35721
35722
35723
35724.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35725.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35726Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35727happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35728in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35729&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35730
35731Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35732in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35733routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35734example, a header such as
35735.code
35736To: hare@teaparty
35737.endd
35738might get rewritten as
35739.code
35740To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35741.endd
35742Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35743does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35744been routed.
35745
35746Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35747addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35748result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35749deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35750immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35751routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35752.ecindex IIDmesproc
35753
35754
35755
35756. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35757. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35758
35759.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35760.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35761.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35762Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35763LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35764closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35765processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35766
35767.ilist
35768SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35769.next
35770SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35771.next
35772Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35773.endlist
35774
35775For mail delivery, the following are available:
35776
35777.ilist
35778SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35779.next
35780LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35781&"lmtp"&);
35782.next
35783LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35784transport);
35785.next
35786Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35787the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35788.endlist
35789
35790&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35791stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35792used to contain the envelope information.
35793
35794
35795
35796.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35797.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35798.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35799.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35800.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35801.cindex "EHLO"
35802.cindex "HELO"
35803.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35804Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35805The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35806processing is the same in both cases.
35807
35808If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35809parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35810command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35811&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35812such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35813.cindex "transport" "filter"
35814.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35815transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35816suppressed.
35817
35818If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35819pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35820required for the transaction.
35821
35822If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35823was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35824server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35825Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35826is called for verification.
35827
35828If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35829the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35830in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35831
35832.cindex "carriage return"
35833.cindex "linefeed"
35834Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35835LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35836order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35837line terminator.
35838
35839If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35840characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35841same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35842even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35843of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35844they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35845each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35846in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35847significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35848
35849When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35850message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35851records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35852particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35853
35854.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35855Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35856a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35857See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35858
35859.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35860.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35861When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35862looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35863messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35864creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35865a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35866so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35867does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35868turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35869
35870The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35871limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35872
35873.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35874The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35875identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35876square bracket of the IP address.
35877
35878
35879
35880
35881.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35882.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35883.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35884.cindex "host" "error"
35885Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35886message errors, and recipient errors.
35887
35888.vlist
35889.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35890A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35891particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35892
35893.ilist
35894Connection refused or timed out,
35895.next
35896Any error response code on connection,
35897.next
35898Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35899.next
35900Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35901.next
35902I/O errors at any time,
35903.next
35904Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35905the &"."& at the end of the data.
35906.endlist ilist
35907
35908For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35909EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35910error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35911host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35912the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35913alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35914host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35915made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35916
35917.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35918.cindex "message" "error"
35919A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35920particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35921message errors are:
35922
35923.ilist
35924Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35925the data,
35926.next
35927Timeout after MAIL,
35928.next
35929Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35930timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35931connection at any other time.
35932.endlist ilist
35933
35934For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35935to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35936temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35937addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35938a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35939message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35940that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35941time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35942affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35943it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35944
35945If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35946to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35947over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35948response to MAIL.
35949
35950.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35951.cindex "recipient" "error"
35952A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35953recipient errors are:
35954
35955.ilist
35956Any error response to RCPT,
35957.next
35958Timeout after RCPT.
35959.endlist
35960
35961For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35962recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35963sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35964address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35965used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35966routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35967operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35968to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35969if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35970(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35971have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35972the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35973the retry clock is reset.
35974
35975The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35976host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35977other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35978in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35979proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35980than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35981if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35982through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35983recipient's retry time.
35984.endlist
35985
35986In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35987current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35988tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35989own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35990until the next delivery attempt.
35991
35992Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35993MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35994would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35995host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35996What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35997is created.
35998
35999The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
36000these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
36001procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
36002response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
36003it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
36004message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
36005helpful to treat this case as a message error.
36006
36007Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
36008host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
36009or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
36010the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
36011then to be treated as a host error.
36012
36013There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
36014terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
36015reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
36016should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
36017host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
36018
36019
36020
36021
36022.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
36023.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
36024.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
36025.cindex "inetd"
36026.cindex "daemon"
36027Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
36028listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
36029&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
36030.code
36031smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
36032.endd
36033Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
36034agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
36035a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
36036the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
36037with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
36038stream and exits with an error code.
36039
36040By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
36041disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
36042unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
36043&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
36044
36045.cindex "carriage return"
36046.cindex "linefeed"
36047Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36048LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
36049order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36050line terminator.
36051Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
36052sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
36053sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
36054
36055.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
36056.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
36057One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
36058HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
36059commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
36060the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
36061Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
36062match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
36063
36064.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
36065.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
36066The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
36067a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
36068&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
36069false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
36070&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
36071value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
36072message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
36073
36074When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
36075its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
36076logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
36077
36078The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
36079prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
36080number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
36081&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
36082rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
36083
36084The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
36085subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
36086for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
36087things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
36088processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
36089sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
36090it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
36091
36092When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
36093and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
36094high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
36095&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
36096applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
36097
36098Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
36099can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
36100&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
36101number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
36102SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
36103&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
36104subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
36105a delivery process.
36106
36107The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
36108&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
36109started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
36110handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
36111however, available with &'inetd'&.
36112
36113Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
36114are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
36115to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
36116section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
36117
36118Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
36119MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
36120&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
36121
36122
36123
36124.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
36125.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
36126If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
36127commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
36128the error response to the last command. The default value for
36129&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
36130abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
36131circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
36132
36133
36134.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
36135.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
36136.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
36137A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
36138something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
36139address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
36140sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
36141&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
36142drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36143default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36144broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36145
36146
36147
36148.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36149.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36150The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36151DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36152many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36153denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36154client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36155defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36156
36157When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36158allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36159but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36160or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36161starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36162counted.
36163
36164The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36165STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36166RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36167
36168You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36169&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36170&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36171the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36172specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36173
36174
36175
36176
36177.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36178When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36179runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36180appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36181
36182.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36183When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36184setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
36185(with a 252 SMTP response code)
36186in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
36187When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
36188called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
36189SMTP response codes.
36190
36191.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
36192If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
36193When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
36194EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
36195than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
36196as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
36197of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
36198VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
36199RCPT failures.
36200
36201
36202
36203.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
36204.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
36205RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
36206overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
36207disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
36208the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
36209should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
36210
36211The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
36212delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
36213the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
36214text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
36215specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
36216the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
36217argument. For example,
36218.code
36219ETRN #brigadoon
36220.endd
36221runs the command
36222.code
36223exim -R brigadoon
36224.endd
36225which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
36226containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
36227default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
36228for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
36229a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
36230
36231.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
36232Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
36233record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
36234the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
36235the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
36236a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
36237left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
36238Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
36239
36240.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
36241For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
36242used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
36243whatever the form of its argument. For
36244example:
36245.code
36246smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
36247 $sender_host_address
36248.endd
36249.vindex "&$domain$&"
36250The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
36251expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
36252and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
36253wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
36254under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
36255for it to change them before running the command.
36256
36257
36258
36259.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
36260.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
36261Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
36262standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
36263line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
36264&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
36265messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
36266sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
36267an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36268identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36269runs for RCPT commands:
36270.code
36271accept hosts = :
36272.endd
36273This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36274
36275
36276
36277.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36278.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36279.cindex "batched SMTP output"
36280Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36281batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36282be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36283delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36284envelope along with the message.
36285
36286The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36287MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36288the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36289HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36290can be used to specify it.
36291
36292Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36293one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36294to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36295this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36296chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36297
36298.vindex "&$host$&"
36299When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36300sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36301transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36302router:
36303.code
36304begin routers
36305route_append:
36306 driver = manualroute
36307 transport = smtp_appendfile
36308 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36309
36310begin transports
36311smtp_appendfile:
36312 driver = appendfile
36313 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36314 batch_max = 1000
36315 use_bsmtp
36316 user = exim
36317.endd
36318This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36319format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36320message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36321
36322
36323
36324.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36325.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36326.cindex "batched SMTP input"
36327The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36328reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36329is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36330sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36331rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36332and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36333as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36334
36335Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36336ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36337
36338If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36339the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36340standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36341make some use of automatically, for example:
36342.code
36343554 Unexpected end of file
36344Transaction started in line 10
36345Error detected in line 14
36346.endd
36347It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36348file, for example:
36349.code
36350An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36351The error message was:
36352
36353501 '>' missing at end of address
36354
36355The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36356The error was detected in line 12.
36357The SMTP command at fault was:
36358
36359rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36360
363611 previous message was successfully processed.
36362The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36363.endd
36364The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36365messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36366accepted.
36367.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36368.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36369
36370
36371
36372. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36373. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36374
36375.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36376 "Customizing messages"
36377When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36378configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36379to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36380the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36381string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36382
36383The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36384cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36385option. Exim also adds the line
36386.code
36387Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36388.endd
36389to all warning and bounce messages,
36390
36391
36392.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36393.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36394.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36395If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36396message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36397delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36398&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36399
36400When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36401constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36402separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36403opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36404logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36405item.
36406
36407.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36408.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36409Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36410expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36411the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36412&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36413option, rounded to a whole number.
36414
36415The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36416
36417.ilist
36418The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36419&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36420.next
36421The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36422failing addresses with their error messages.
36423.next
36424The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36425returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36426.next
36427The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36428The fields exist for back-compatibility
36429.endlist
36430
36431The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36432following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36433other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36434.code
36435Subject: Mail delivery failed
36436 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36437 {: returning message to sender}}
36438****
36439This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36440
36441A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36442 {that you sent }{sent by
36443
36444<$sender_address>
36445
36446}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36447This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36448****
36449The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36450****
36451------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36452 ------
36453****
36454------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36455 only the first
36456------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36457****
36458.endd
36459.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36460.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36461.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36462The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36463warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36464text sections:
36465
36466.ilist
36467The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36468&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36469.next
36470The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36471the delayed addresses.
36472.next
36473The third item then ends the message.
36474.endlist
36475
36476The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36477have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36478.code
36479Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36480 $warn_message_delay
36481****
36482This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36483
36484A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36485{that you sent }{sent by
36486
36487<$sender_address>
36488
36489}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36490more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36491
36492The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36493The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36494The date of the message is: $h_date
36495
36496The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36497****
36498No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36499continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36500intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36501mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36502the message will be returned to you.
36503.endd
36504.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36505.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36506However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36507appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36508&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36509minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36510of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36511multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36512handled them.
36513
36514
36515
36516
36517. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36518. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36519
36520.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36521This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36522common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36523
36524
36525
36526.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36527.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36528If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36529should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36530routing explicitly:
36531.code
36532send_to_smart_host:
36533 driver = manualroute
36534 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36535 transport = remote_smtp
36536.endd
36537You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36538If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36539receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36540synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36541&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36542
36543
36544
36545
36546.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36547.cindex "mailing lists"
36548Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36549requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36550Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36551
36552The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36553is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36554independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36555lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36556.code
36557lists:
36558 driver = redirect
36559 domains = lists.example
36560 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36561 forbid_pipe
36562 forbid_file
36563 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36564 no_more
36565.endd
36566This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36567in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36568such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36569routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36570
36571The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36572expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36573a mailing list.
36574
36575.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36576The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36577taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36578original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36579the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36580
36581For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36582&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36583&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36584&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36585There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36586the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36587such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36588or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36589&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36590
36591
36592
36593.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36594.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36595If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36596delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36597list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36598list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36599addresses are not rigorously checked.
36600
36601If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36602entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36603&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36604whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36605&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36606
36607
36608
36609.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36610.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36611Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36612in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36613recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36614cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36615delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36616account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36617the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36618message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36619
36620If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36621on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36622router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36623&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36624&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36625subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36626failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36627pre-existing messages.
36628
36629The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36630addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36631addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36632&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36633one level of expansion anyway.
36634
36635
36636
36637.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36638.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36639The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36640send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36641from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36642&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36643
36644The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36645of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36646.code
36647lists_request:
36648 driver = redirect
36649 domains = lists.example
36650 local_part_suffix = -request
36651 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36652 no_more
36653
36654lists_post:
36655 driver = redirect
36656 domains = lists.example
36657 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36658 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36659 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36660 forbid_pipe
36661 forbid_file
36662 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36663 no_more
36664
36665lists_closed:
36666 driver = redirect
36667 domains = lists.example
36668 allow_fail
36669 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36670.endd
36671All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36672they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36673&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36674mailing list.
36675
36676The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36677checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36678checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36679necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36680because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36681not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36682means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36683&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36684&"unrouteable address"& error.
36685
36686The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36687a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36688the address, giving a suitable error message.
36689
36690
36691
36692
36693.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36694.cindex "VERP"
36695.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36696.cindex "envelope from"
36697.cindex "envelope sender"
36698Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36699are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36700address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36701the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36702if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36703original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36704
36705.oindex &%errors_to%&
36706.oindex &%return_path%&
36707Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36708facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36709list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36710these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36711host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36712of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36713of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36714.code
36715verp_smtp:
36716 driver = smtp
36717 max_rcpt = 1
36718 return_path = \
36719 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36720 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36721.endd
36722This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36723SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36724&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36725local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36726example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36727&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36728&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36729rewritten as
36730.code
36731somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36732.endd
36733.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36734For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36735have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36736achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36737might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36738&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36739
36740Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36741probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36742extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36743can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36744.code
36745dnslookup:
36746 driver = dnslookup
36747 domains = ! +local_domains
36748 transport = \
36749 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36750 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36751 no_more
36752.endd
36753If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36754of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36755routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36756errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36757address.
36758
36759On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36760&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36761SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36762and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36763of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36764.code
36765verp_dnslookup:
36766 driver = dnslookup
36767 domains = ! +local_domains
36768 transport = remote_smtp
36769 errors_to = \
36770 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36771 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36772 no_more
36773.endd
36774Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36775configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36776Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36777router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36778them.
36779
36780The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36781message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36782host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36783a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36784a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36785than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36786used).
36787
36788
36789
36790
36791
36792
36793.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36794.cindex "virtual domains"
36795.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36796The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36797meanings:
36798
36799.ilist
36800A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36801aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36802top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36803.next
36804One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36805with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36806have login accounts on that host.
36807.endlist
36808
36809The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36810the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36811aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36812virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36813whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36814to a router of this form:
36815.code
36816virtual:
36817 driver = redirect
36818 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36819 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
36820 no_more
36821.endd
36822.new
36823The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36824is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36825domain that is being processed.
36826The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
36827being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
36828.wen
36829
36830When the router runs, it looks up the local
36831part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36832setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36833string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36834
36835This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36836follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36837can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36838a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36839
36840The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36841way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36842valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36843.code
36844my_domains:
36845 driver = accept
36846 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36847 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36848 transport = my_mailboxes
36849.endd
36850The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36851can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36852file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36853option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36854because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36855follows:
36856.code
36857my_mailboxes:
36858 driver = appendfile
36859 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36860 user = mail
36861.endd
36862This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36863required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36864
36865The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36866requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36867up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36868information about the domains.
36869
36870
36871
36872.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36873.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36874.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36875.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36876.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36877Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36878incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36879allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36880identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36881parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36882&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36883example, consider this router:
36884.code
36885userforward:
36886 driver = redirect
36887 check_local_user
36888 file = $home/.forward
36889 local_part_suffix = -*
36890 local_part_suffix_optional
36891 allow_filter
36892.endd
36893.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36894It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36895&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36896cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36897.code
36898if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36899save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36900endif
36901.endd
36902If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36903fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36904&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36905control over which suffixes are valid.
36906
36907Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36908&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36909another MTA:
36910.code
36911userforward:
36912 driver = redirect
36913 check_local_user
36914 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36915 local_part_suffix = -*
36916 local_part_suffix_optional
36917 allow_filter
36918.endd
36919If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36920example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36921does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36922subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36923&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36924
36925
36926
36927.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36928.cindex "vacation processing"
36929The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36930a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36931(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36932This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36933that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36934
36935.ilist
36936A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36937can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36938alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36939&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36940.code
36941spqr, vacation-spqr
36942.endd
36943.next
36944The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36945vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36946user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36947ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36948to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36949message.
36950.endlist
36951
36952Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36953use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36954
36955
36956
36957.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36958.cindex "message" "copying every"
36959Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36960be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36961command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36962each day's messages.
36963
36964There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36965messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36966delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36967notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36968
36969
36970
36971.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36972.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36973It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36974Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36975arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36976permanently connected.
36977
36978Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36979particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36980Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36981
36982
36983.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36984It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36985host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36986approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36987being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36988some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36989to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36990resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36991
36992A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36993intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36994into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36995format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36996destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36997in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36998if required.
36999
37000On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
37001you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
37002intermittent host. For example:
37003.code
37004cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
37005.endd
37006This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
37007which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
37008online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
37009options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
37010causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
37011connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
37012immediately.
37013
37014If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
37015issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
37016mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
37017used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
37018avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
37019Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
37020arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
37021
37022
37023
37024.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
37025The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
37026increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
37027connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
37028delivered immediately.
37029
37030.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37031.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
37032.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
37033.cindex "first pass routing"
37034Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
37035not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
37036possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
37037each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
37038avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
37039&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
37040first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
37041normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
37042destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
37043single SMTP connection.
37044
37045
37046
37047. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37048. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37049
37050.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
37051 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
37052.cindex "client, non-queueing"
37053.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
37054On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
37055email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
37056configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
37057However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
37058configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
37059&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
37060messages this way.
37061
37062If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
37063run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
37064any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
37065continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
37066email is not desirable.
37067
37068There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
37069&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
37070any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
37071host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
37072informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
37073to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
37074to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
37075
37076There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
37077that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
37078ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
37079before sending a message to the smart host.
37080
37081Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
37082tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
37083overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
37084
37085.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
37086There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
37087Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
37088assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
37089just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
37090compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
37091router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
37092
37093When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
37094following ways:
37095
37096.ilist
37097A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
37098In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
37099.next
37100Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
37101assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
37102&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
37103does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
37104successful, a zero return code is given.
37105.next
37106Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
37107be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
37108the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
37109must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
37110deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
37111are.
37112.next
37113If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
37114failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
37115successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
37116.next
37117Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
37118is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
37119smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
37120the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
37121there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
37122.next
37123If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
37124connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
37125failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
37126.next
37127When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
37128(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
37129value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
37130are ever generated.
37131.next
37132No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
37133.next
37134A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
37135true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
37136&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
37137.endlist
37138
37139The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
37140the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
37141deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
37142privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
37143to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
37144the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
37145
37146
37147
37148
37149. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37150. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37151
37152.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37153.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37154.cindex "log" "types of"
37155Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37156and the panic log:
37157
37158.ilist
37159.cindex "main log"
37160The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37161line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37162down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37163out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37164them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37165they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37166analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37167&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37168.next
37169.cindex "reject log"
37170The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37171of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37172The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37173the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37174is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37175lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37176reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37177host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37178can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37179false.
37180.next
37181.cindex "panic log"
37182.cindex "system log"
37183When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37184error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
37185are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
37186other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
37187therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
37188regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
37189panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
37190is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
37191message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
37192.endlist
37193
37194Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
37195example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
37196In the log file, this would be all on one line:
37197.code
371982001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
37199 by QUIT
37200.endd
37201By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
37202ways of changing this:
37203
37204.ilist
37205You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
37206you set
37207.code
37208timezone = UTC
37209.endd
37210the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
37211.next
37212If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
37213example:
37214.code
372152003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
37216.endd
37217.endlist
37218
37219.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37220.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37221Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
37222request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
37223&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
37224brackets, immediately after the time and date.
37225
37226
37227
37228
37229.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
37230.cindex "log" "destination"
37231.cindex "log" "to file"
37232.cindex "log" "to syslog"
37233.cindex "syslog"
37234The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
37235should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
37236are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
37237arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
37238It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
37239need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
37240Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
37241
37242The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
37243&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
37244configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
37245references to the host name:
37246.code
37247log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
37248.endd
37249It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
37250rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
37251start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
37252before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
37253configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
37254log at all.
37255
37256The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
37257list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
37258facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
37259colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
37260otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
37261point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
37262implying the use of a default path.
37263
37264When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
37265LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
37266&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
37267mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
37268files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
37269equivalent to the setting:
37270.code
37271log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
37272.endd
37273If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
37274or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37275that is where the logs are written.
37276
37277A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37278are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37279
37280Here are some examples of possible settings:
37281.display
37282&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37283&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37284&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37285&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37286.endd
37287If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37288error is logged.
37289
37290
37291
37292.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37293.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37294.cindex "cycling logs"
37295.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37296.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37297Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37298log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37299provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37300main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37301keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37302
37303An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37304and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37305example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37306message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37307that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37308something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37309ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37310&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37311does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37312tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37313for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37314renamed.
37315
37316
37317
37318.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37319.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37320Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37321periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37322for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37323&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37324the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37325point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37326.code
37327log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37328log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37329log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37330log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37331.endd
37332As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37333examples of names generated by the above examples:
37334.code
37335/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37336/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37337/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37338/var/log/exim/main.200212
37339.endd
37340When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37341files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37342will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37343run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37344
37345The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37346is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37347When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37348the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37349non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37350character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37351log names:
37352.code
37353/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37354/var/log/exim-panic.log
37355/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37356/var/log/exim/panic
37357.endd
37358
37359
37360.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37361.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37362The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37363except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37364Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37365that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37366&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37367by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37368&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37369SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37370&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37371LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37372the time and host name to each line.
37373The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37374
37375.ilist
37376&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37377.next
37378&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37379.next
37380&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37381.endlist
37382
37383Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37384written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37385these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37386by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37387
37388Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37389entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37390these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37391calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37392870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37393additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37394replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37395RFC 3164, you should set
37396.code
37397SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37398.endd
37399in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37400lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37401
37402To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37403entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37404where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37405components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37406because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37407delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37408870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37409&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37410name, and pid as added by syslog:
37411.code
37412[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37413[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37414[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37415[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37416[5/5] mple>)
37417.endd
37418The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37419(LOG_NOTICE):
37420.code
37421[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37422[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37423[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37424[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37425[5\18] .example>)
37426[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37427[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37428[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37429[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37430[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37431[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37432[12\18] F From: <>
37433[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37434[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37435[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37436[16\18] le>
37437[17\18] B Bcc:
37438[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37439.endd
37440Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37441without modification.
37442
37443If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37444display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37445the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37446where it is.
37447
37448
37449
37450.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37451One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37452successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37453picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37454timestamp. The flags are:
37455.display
37456&`<=`& message arrival
37457&`(=`& message fakereject
37458&`=>`& normal message delivery
37459&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37460&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37461&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37462&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37463&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37464.endd
37465
37466
37467.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37468.cindex "log" "reception line"
37469The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37470message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37471several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37472.code
374732002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37474 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37475 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37476.endd
37477The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37478bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37479generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37480.code
37481R=<message id>
37482.endd
37483which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37484
37485.cindex "HELO"
37486.cindex "EHLO"
37487For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37488record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37489received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37490host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37491above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37492&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37493by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37494verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37495EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37496name in parentheses.
37497
37498Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37499without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37500the log containing text like these examples:
37501.code
37502H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37503H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37504.endd
37505This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37506on.
37507
37508For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37509the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37510of Exim.
37511
37512.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37513.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37514For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37515message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37516of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37517extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37518session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37519suite that was used.
37520
37521.cindex log protocol
37522The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37523hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37524value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37525there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37526was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37527&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37528authenticator name.
37529
37530.cindex "size" "of message"
37531The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37532received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37533headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37534message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37535other).
37536
37537The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37538data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37539
37540
37541
37542.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37543.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37544The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37545delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37546deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37547to fit it on the page:
37548.code
375492002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37550 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
375512002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37552 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37553 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37554.endd
37555For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37556after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37557intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37558last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37559fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37560
37561If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37562followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37563If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37564option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37565
37566If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37567for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37568.display
37569&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37570.endd
37571If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37572parentheses afterwards.
37573
37574.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37575When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37576SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37577flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37578down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37579lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37580When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37581DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37582will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37583TLS cipher information is still available.
37584
37585.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37586.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37587When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37588line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37589rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37590
37591The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37592&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37593
37594The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37595data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37596
37597
37598.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37599.cindex "discarded messages"
37600.cindex "message" "discarded"
37601.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37602When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37603obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37604.code
376052002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37606 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37607.endd
37608is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37609because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37610.code
376111999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37612 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37613.endd
37614
37615
37616.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37617When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37618.code
376192002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37620 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37621.endd
37622In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37623last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37624written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37625.code
376262002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37627 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37628.endd
37629When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37630a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37631appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37632
37633
37634
37635.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37636.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37637If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37638following form is logged:
37639.code
376401995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37641 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37642.endd
37643If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37644the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37645.code
376462002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37647 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37648 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37649 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37650 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37651.endd
37652The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37653used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37654disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37655flagged with &`**`&.
37656
37657
37658
37659.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37660.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37661If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37662used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37663&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37664
37665
37666
37667.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37668A line of the form
37669.code
376702002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37671.endd
37672is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37673at the end of its processing.
37674
37675
37676
37677
37678.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37679.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37680A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37681the following table:
37682.display
37683&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37684&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37685&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37686&`CV `& certificate verification status
37687&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37688&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37689&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37690&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37691&`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37692&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37693&`H `& host name and IP address
37694&`I `& local interface used
37695&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37696&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37697&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37698&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37699&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37700&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37701&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37702&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37703&`Q `& alternate queue name
37704&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37705&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37706&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37707&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37708&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37709&`S `& size of message in bytes
37710&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37711&`ST `& shadow transport name
37712&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37713&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37714&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37715&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37716&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37717.endd
37718
37719
37720.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37721Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37722self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37723
37724.ilist
37725.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37726&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37727during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37728This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37729during the first delivery attempt.
37730.next
37731&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37732temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37733for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37734.next
37735.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37736&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37737some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37738common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37739&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37740doing.
37741.next
37742.cindex "error" "ignored"
37743&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37744message:
37745.olist
37746Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37747&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37748.next
37749A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37750failed. The delivery was discarded.
37751.next
37752A delivery set up by a router configured with
37753. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37754. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37755.code
37756 errors_to = <>
37757.endd
37758failed. The delivery was discarded.
37759.endlist olist
37760.next
37761.cindex DKIM "log line"
37762&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37763logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37764.endlist ilist
37765
37766
37767
37768
37769
37770.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37771.cindex "log" "selectors"
37772By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37773default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37774&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37775example:
37776.code
37777log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37778.endd
37779The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37780selection marked by asterisks:
37781.display
37782&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37783&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37784&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37785&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37786&` arguments `& command line arguments
37787&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37788&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37789&` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37790&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37791&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37792&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37793&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37794&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37795&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37796&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37797&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37798&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37799&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37800&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37801&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37802&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37803&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37804&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37805&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37806&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37807&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37808&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37809&` pid `& Exim process id
37810&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37811&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37812&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37813&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37814&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37815&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37816&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37817&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37818&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37819&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37820&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37821&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37822&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37823&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37824&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37825&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37826&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37827&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37828&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37829&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37830&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37831&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37832&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37833&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37834&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37835
37836&` all `& all of the above
37837.endd
37838See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37839section &<<SECID99>>&
37840
37841More details on each of these items follows:
37842
37843.ilist
37844.cindex "8BITMIME"
37845.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37846&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37847which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37848that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37849&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37850&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37851.next
37852.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37853&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37854its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37855this log selector is set.
37856.next
37857.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37858.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37859&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37860rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37861such users cannot access the log).
37862.next
37863.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37864&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37865delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37866parentheses between them.
37867.next
37868.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37869.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37870&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37871to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37872feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37873&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37874privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37875that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37876are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37877because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37878only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37879between the caller and Exim.
37880.next
37881.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37882&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37883connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37884.next
37885.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37886.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37887&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37888started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37889messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37890process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37891.next
37892.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37893&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37894perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37895If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37896precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37897.next
37898.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37899.cindex "size" "of message"
37900&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37901the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37902.next
37903.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37904.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37905&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37906verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37907.next
37908.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37909.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37910&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37911.next
37912.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37913.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37914.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37915&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37916DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37917.next
37918.cindex log dnssec
37919.cindex dnssec logging
37920&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37921dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37922For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37923It does not cover helo-name verification.
37924For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37925.next
37926.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37927.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37928&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37929is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37930command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37931selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37932.next
37933.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37934&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37935any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37936log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37937routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37938.next
37939.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37940.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37941&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37942client's ident port times out.
37943.next
37944.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37945.cindex "log" "local interface"
37946.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37947.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37948.cindex "interface" "logging"
37949&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37950to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37951followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37952added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37953rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37954The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37955.next
37956.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37957.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37958.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37959&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37960of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37961on a proxied connection
37962or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37963See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37964.next
37965.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37966.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37967.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37968.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37969.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37970&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37971added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37972in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37973changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37974&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37975important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37976.next
37977.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37978&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37979connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37980.next
37981.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37982.cindex millisecond logging
37983.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37984&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37985appended to the seconds value.
37986.next
37987.cindex "log" "message id"
37988&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37989.next
37990&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37991This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37992(submission mode) without one.
37993The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37994.next
37995.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37996.cindex "log" "local interface"
37997.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37998.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37999.cindex "interface" "logging"
38000&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
38001interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
38002followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
38003off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38004.next
38005.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
38006.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
38007.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
38008&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
38009containing => tags) following the IP address.
38010The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
38011&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
38012This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
38013configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
38014local port is a random ephemeral port.
38015.next
38016.cindex "log" "process ids in"
38017.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38018&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
38019immediately after the time and date.
38020.next
38021.cindex log pipelining
38022.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
38023&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
38024log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
38025The field is a single "L".
38026
38027On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
38028the field has a minus appended.
38029
38030.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
38031If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
38032accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
38033offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
38034Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
38035
38036.next
38037.cindex "log" "queue run"
38038.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
38039&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
38040.next
38041.cindex "log" "queue time"
38042&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
38043local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
38044&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
38045includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
38046This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
38047delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
38048message has been successfully received.
38049If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38050precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
38051.next
38052&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
38053the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
38054example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
38055message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
38056.next
38057.cindex "log" "receive duration"
38058&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
38059perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
38060If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38061precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
38062.next
38063.cindex "log" "recipients"
38064&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
38065as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
38066that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
38067addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
38068has taken place.
38069Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
38070in the list.
38071.next
38072.cindex "log" "sender reception"
38073&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
38074the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
38075&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
38076.next
38077.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
38078&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
38079rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
38080log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
38081rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
38082.next
38083.cindex "log" "retry defer"
38084&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
38085retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
38086message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
38087attempt.
38088.next
38089.cindex "log" "return path"
38090&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
38091the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
38092This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
38093or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
38094.next
38095.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
38096&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
38097and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
38098This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
38099necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
38100.next
38101.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
38102&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
38103gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
38104the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
38105detail is lost.
38106.next
38107.cindex "log" "size rejection"
38108&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
38109it is too big.
38110.next
38111.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
38112.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
38113&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
38114queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
38115it.
38116.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
38117The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
38118.next
38119.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
38120.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
38121.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
38122&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
38123outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
38124A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
38125response.
38126.next
38127.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
38128.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
38129&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
38130established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
38131&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
38132only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
38133processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
38134dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
38135not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
38136of connections unless this selector is enabled.
38137
38138For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
38139included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
38140reset if the daemon is restarted.
38141Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
38142subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
38143whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
38144match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
38145logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
38146.next
38147.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
38148.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38149&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38150RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38151and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38152line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38153.next
38154.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38155.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38156&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38157connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38158the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38159does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38160an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38161already have their own log lines.
38162
38163The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38164way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38165If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38166an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38167DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38168the same logging options.
38169
38170Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38171is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38172.code
38173C=EHLO,QUIT
38174.endd
38175shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
38176than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
38177the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
38178setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
38179have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
38180.next
38181&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
38182colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
38183log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
38184was accepted or used.
38185.next
38186.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
38187.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
38188&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
38189encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
38190because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
38191been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
38192it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
38193received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
38194.next
38195.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
38196.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
38197.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
38198.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
38199.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
38200&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
38201encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
38202external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
38203using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
38204.next
38205.cindex "log" "subject"
38206.cindex "subject, logging"
38207&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
38208preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
38209Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
38210specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
38211unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
38212.next
38213.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
38214.cindex log DANE
38215.cindex DANE logging
38216&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
38217when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
38218verified
38219using a CA trust anchor,
38220&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
38221and &`CV=no`& if not.
38222.next
38223.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
38224.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
38225&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38226connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
38227.next
38228.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
38229.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
38230&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38231connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
38232added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
38233.next
38234.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
38235.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
38236&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
38237the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
38238added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
38239.next
38240.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
38241&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
38242result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
38243.endlist
38244
38245
38246.section "Message log" "SECID260"
38247.cindex "message" "log file for"
38248.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
38249.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
38250.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
38251In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
38252that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
38253they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
38254message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
38255makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
38256to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
38257is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
38258only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
38259
38260On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
38261per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
38262&%message_logs%& option false.
38263.ecindex IIDloggen
38264
38265
38266
38267
38268. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38269. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38270
38271.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
38272.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
38273A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
38274described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38275the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38276
38277.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38278.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38279 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38280.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38281.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38282.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38283.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38284 various criteria"
38285.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38286.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38287 "extract statistics from the log"
38288.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38289 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38290.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38291.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38292.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38293.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38294.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38295.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38296.endtable
38297
38298Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38299&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38300&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38301
38302
38303
38304
38305.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38306.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38307.cindex "process, querying"
38308.cindex "SIGUSR1"
38309On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38310(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38311a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38312Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38313processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38314second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38315order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38316send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38317
38318&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38319use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38320script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38321
38322
38323Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38324varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38325but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38326system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38327it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38328options:
38329.display
38330&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38331&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38332&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38333&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38334.endd
38335An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38336.code
38337164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3833810483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3833910492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38340 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3834110592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3834210628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38343.endd
38344The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38345been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38346
38347
38348
38349.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38350.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38351.cindex "queue" "grepping"
38352This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38353.code
38354exim -bpu
38355.endd
38356or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38357.code
38358exim -bp
38359.endd
38360The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38361contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38362
38363to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38364that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38365
38366.vlist
38367.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38368Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38369tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38370.code
38371exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38372.endd
38373.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38374Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38375tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38376
38377.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38378Match against the size field.
38379
38380.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38381Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38382
38383.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38384Match messages that are older than the given time.
38385
38386.vitem &*-z*&
38387Match only frozen messages.
38388
38389.vitem &*-x*&
38390Match only non-frozen messages.
38391
38392.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38393Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38394.endlist
38395
38396The following options control the format of the output:
38397
38398.vlist
38399.vitem &*-c*&
38400Display only the count of matching messages.
38401
38402.vitem &*-l*&
38403Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38404the default.
38405
38406.vitem &*-i*&
38407Display message ids only.
38408
38409.vitem &*-b*&
38410Brief format &-- one line per message.
38411
38412.vitem &*-R*&
38413Display messages in reverse order.
38414
38415.vitem &*-a*&
38416Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38417.endlist
38418
38419There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38420
38421
38422
38423.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38424.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38425.cindex "queue" "summary"
38426The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38427-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38428running a command such as
38429.code
38430exim -bp | exiqsumm
38431.endd
38432The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38433it, as in the following example:
38434.code
384353 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38436.endd
38437Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38438volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38439been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38440number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38441
38442A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38443domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38444the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38445respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38446domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38447separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38448sender.
38449
38450The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38451this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38452generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38453option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38454level"& addresses).
38455
38456
38457
38458
38459.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38460 "SECTextspeinf"
38461.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38462.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38463The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38464files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38465extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38466match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38467given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38468The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38469If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38470included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38471.display
38472&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38473.endd
38474If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38475
38476The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38477condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38478they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38479
38480By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38481makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38482large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38483option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38484case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38485
38486The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38487pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38488regular expression.
38489
38490The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38491if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38492
38493The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38494that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38495normally.
38496
38497Example of &%-M%&:
38498user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38499&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38500displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38501the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38502when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38503&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38504search term.
38505
38506If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38507ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38508whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38509If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38510autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38511
38512
38513.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38514.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38515John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38516lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38517of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38518the &%--help%& option.
38519
38520
38521.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38522.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38523.cindex "cycling logs"
38524.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38525The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38526&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38527you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38528&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38529for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38530There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38531.ilist
38532&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38533default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38534.next
38535&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38536&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38537overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38538configuration.
38539.endlist
38540
38541Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38542the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38543run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38544&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38545&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38546logs are handled similarly.
38547
38548If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38549&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38550to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38551any existing log files.
38552
38553If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38554the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38555using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38556setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38557root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38558.code
385591 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38560.endd
38561assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38562&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38563
38564
38565
38566.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38567.cindex "statistics"
38568.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38569A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38570information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38571. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38572. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38573
38574The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38575latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38576lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38577various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38578list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38579.code
38580eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38581.endd
38582By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38583messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38584both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38585are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38586addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38587options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38588also produced per user.
38589
38590The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38591histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38592hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38593example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38594as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38595
38596Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38597have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38598messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38599and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38600recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38601an entirely separate message.
38602
38603&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38604of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38605each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38606not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38607least one address that failed.
38608
38609The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38610or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38611transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38612(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38613a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38614senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38615and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38616
38617The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38618came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38619without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38620
38621There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38622outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38623by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38624.code
38625perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38626.endd
38627
38628.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38629.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38630.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38631.cindex "checking access"
38632The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38633debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38634policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38635familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38636sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38637access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38638
38639The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38640two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38641.code
38642exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38643.endd
38644The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38645given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38646connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38647is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38648.code
38649Rejected:
38650550 Relay not permitted
38651.endd
38652When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38653for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38654options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38655that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38656you can use:
38657.code
38658exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38659 -f himself@there.example
38660.endd
38661Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38662mandatory arguments.
38663
38664Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38665while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38666&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38667
38668
38669
38670.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38671.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38672.cindex "building DBM files"
38673.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38674.cindex "lower casing"
38675.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38676The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38677the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38678&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38679names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38680can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38681
38682A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38683the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38684&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38685strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38686files.
38687
38688The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38689single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38690It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38691well.
38692
38693.cindex "USE_DB"
38694If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38695configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38696filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38697create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38698.code
38699exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38700.endd
38701reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38702&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38703
38704In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38705Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38706environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38707&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38708when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38709recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38710
38711If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38712finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38713option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38714this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38715&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38716There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38717&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38718return code is 2.
38719
38720
38721
38722
38723.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38724.cindex "retry" "times"
38725.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38726A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38727fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38728complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38729information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38730is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38731output. For example:
38732.code
38733$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38734kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38735 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38736 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38737 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38738roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38739 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38740 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38741 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38742 past final cutoff time
38743.endd
38744You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38745will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38746A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38747message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38748suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38749&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38750run very often.
38751
38752The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38753of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38754passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38755configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38756file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38757environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38758
38759
38760
38761.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38762.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38763.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38764Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38765uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38766arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38767second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38768
38769.ilist
38770&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38771.next
38772&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38773for remote hosts
38774.next
38775&'callout'&: the callout cache
38776.next
38777&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38778.next
38779&'misc'&: other hints data
38780.endlist
38781
38782The &'misc'& database is used for
38783
38784.ilist
38785Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38786.next
38787Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38788&(smtp)& transport)
38789.next
38790Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38791in a transport)
38792.endlist
38793
38794
38795
38796.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38797.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38798The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38799&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38800spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38801.code
38802exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38803.endd
38804Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38805.code
38806T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3880731-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38808.endd
38809The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38810of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38811transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38812a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38813address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38814transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38815to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38816and a textual description of the error.
38817
38818The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38819the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38820ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38821exceeded.
38822
38823Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38824consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38825waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38826one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38827may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38828may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38829cross-references.
38830
38831
38832
38833.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38834.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38835The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38836database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38837days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38838updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38839since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38840for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38841updated sufficiently often.
38842
38843The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38844followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38845the retry database:
38846.code
38847exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38848.endd
38849Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38850message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38851they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38852are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38853types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38854message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38855queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38856&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38857For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38858removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38859whenever it removes information from the database.
38860
38861Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38862needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38863down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38864first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38865records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38866
38867It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38868hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38869a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38870work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38871but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38872After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38873point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38874tidied.
38875
38876&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38877databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38878
38879
38880
38881
38882.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38883.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38884The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38885Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38886getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38887is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38888key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38889displayed.
38890
38891If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38892except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38893out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38894data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38895by new data, for example:
38896.code
38897> 4 951102:1000
38898.endd
38899resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38900sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38901used as optional separators.
38902
38903
38904
38905
38906.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38907.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38908.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38909.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38910The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38911Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38912&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38913a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38914the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38915argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38916second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38917is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38918is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38919
38920.vlist
38921.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38922Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38923
38924.vitem &%-flock%&
38925Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38926supports it.
38927
38928.vitem &%-interval%&
38929This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38930interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38931
38932.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38933Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38934
38935.vitem &%-mbx%&
38936Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38937
38938.vitem &%-q%&
38939Suppress verification output.
38940
38941.vitem &%-retries%&
38942This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38943the lock (default 10).
38944
38945.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38946This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38947locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38948example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38949subsequently sees.
38950
38951.vitem &%-timeout%&
38952This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38953timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38954default), a non-blocking call is used.
38955
38956.vitem &%-v%&
38957Generate verbose output.
38958.endlist
38959
38960If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38961default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38962mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38963&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38964requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38965file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38966more than 30 minutes old.
38967
38968The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38969&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38970to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38971&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38972number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38973can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38974
38975The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38976&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38977suppresses all output except error messages.
38978
38979A command such as
38980.code
38981exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38982.endd
38983runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38984.display
38985&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38986<&'some commands'&>
38987&`End`&
38988.endd
38989runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38990suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38991such as
38992.code
38993exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38994 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38995.endd
38996Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38997second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38998.ecindex IIDutils
38999
39000
39001. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39002. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39003
39004.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
39005.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
39006.cindex "X-windows"
39007.cindex "&'eximon'&"
39008.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
39009.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
39010The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
39011about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
39012perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
39013such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
39014monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
39015
39016
39017
39018.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
39019The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
39020script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
39021binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
39022be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
39023&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
39024parameters are for.
39025
39026The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
39027a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
39028preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
39029.code
39030EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
39031.endd
39032(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
39033the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
39034overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
39035&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
39036syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
39037
39038X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
39039way. For example, a resource setting of the form
39040.code
39041Eximon*background: gray94
39042.endd
39043changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
39044stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
39045black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
39046data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
39047&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
39048For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
39049reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
39050.code
39051xrdb -merge <<End
39052Eximon*highlight: gray
39053End
39054.endd
39055.cindex "admin user"
39056In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
39057&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
39058
39059The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
39060contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
39061if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
39062binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
39063versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
39064
39065The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
39066more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
39067main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
39068delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
39069different parts of the display.
39070
39071
39072
39073
39074.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
39075.cindex "stripchart"
39076The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
39077be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39078&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
39079configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
39080it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
39081hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
39082received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
39083period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
39084parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39085
39086The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
39087displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
39088title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
39089For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
39090
39091It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
39092a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
39093to a single partition.
39094
39095.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
39096This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
39097the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
39098this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
39099100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
39100SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39101&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39102
39103
39104
39105
39106.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
39107.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
39108.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
39109.cindex "window size"
39110Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
39111to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
39112shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
39113stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
39114the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
39115in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
39116
39117When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
39118currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
39119size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
39120remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
39121
39122The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
39123stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
39124the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
39125The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
39126&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
39127the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39128
39129Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
39130built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
39131START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39132
39133
39134
39135.section "The log display" "SECID267"
39136.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
39137The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
39138the main log is maintained.
39139To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
39140removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
39141The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
39142syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
39143to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
39144
39145The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
39146move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
39147scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
39148LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39149to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39150much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39151a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39152only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39153available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39154normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39155configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39156
39157Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39158and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39159respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39160It cannot go further back up the log.
39161
39162The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
39163normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
39164by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
39165by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
39166back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
39167the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
39168
39169Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
39170There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
39171the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
39172happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
39173&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
39174^C is typed the search is cancelled.
39175
39176The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
39177widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
39178&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
39179eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
39180However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
39181provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
39182come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
39183unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
39184on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
39185window.
39186
39187
39188
39189.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
39190.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
39191The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
39192are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
39193as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
39194parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
39195at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
39196the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
39197there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
39198to force an update of the queue display at any time.
39199
39200When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
39201and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
39202with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
39203pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
39204type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
39205such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
39206of the texts, the message is not displayed.
39207
39208If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
39209are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
39210example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
39211&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
39212has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
39213cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
39214a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
39215
39216While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
39217else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
39218queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
39219pressing the &"Hide"& button.
39220
39221The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
39222time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
39223message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
39224a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
39225recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
39226listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
39227an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
39228not shown.
39229
39230.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
39231If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
39232
39233The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
39234of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
39235The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
39236available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
39237display is updated.
39238
39239
39240
39241.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
39242.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
39243If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
39244pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
39245line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
39246any selected text.
39247
39248If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
39249MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
39250set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
39251value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
39252run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
39253.code
39254EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
39255.endd
39256The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
39257follows:
39258
39259.ilist
39260&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
39261in a new text window.
39262.next
39263&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
39264information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
39265&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
39266.next
39267&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
39268displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
39269amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
39270option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
39271.next
39272&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
39273delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
39274frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39275a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39276up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39277.next
39278&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39279that the message be frozen.
39280.next
39281.cindex "thawing messages"
39282.cindex "unfreezing messages"
39283.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39284&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39285that the message be thawed.
39286.next
39287.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39288&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39289that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39290for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39291.next
39292&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39293that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39294message.
39295.next
39296&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39297be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39298is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39299Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39300causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39301additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39302which case no action is taken.
39303.next
39304&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39305can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39306is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39307Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39308causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39309recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39310case no action is taken.
39311.next
39312&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39313mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39314.next
39315&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39316sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39317&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39318in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39319bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39320not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39321the address is qualified with that domain.
39322.endlist
39323
39324When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39325other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39326particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39327output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39328from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39329&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39330if no output is generated.
39331
39332The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39333thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39334&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39335force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39336
39337In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39338cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39339and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39340.ecindex IIDeximon
39341
39342
39343
39344
39345
39346. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39347. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39348
39349.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39350.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39351This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39352which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39353
39354For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39355Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39356existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39357chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39358security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39359its security as compared with other MTAs.
39360
39361What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39362have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39363absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39364as soon as possible.
39365
39366
39367.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39368.cindex "security" "build-time features"
39369There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39370to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39371Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39372penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39373
39374.ilist
39375ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39376start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39377filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39378the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39379&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39380default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39381
39382If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39383which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39384into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39385configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39386.next
39387
39388If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39389or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39390file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39391the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39392root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39393right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39394reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39395it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39396privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39397separate commands.
39398
39399.next
39400The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39401with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39402CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39403requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39404the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39405but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39406previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39407.next
39408If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39409is disabled.
39410.next
39411FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39412never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39413option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39414to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39415is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39416.endlist
39417
39418
39419
39420.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39421.cindex "setuid"
39422.cindex "root privilege"
39423The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39424privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39425example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39426may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39427discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39428is required for two things:
39429
39430.ilist
39431To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39432the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39433not required.
39434.next
39435To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39436perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39437configuration.
39438.endlist
39439
39440It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39441receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39442obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39443For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39444&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39445group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39446is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39447&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39448
39449Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39450abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39451&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39452
39453After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39454uid and gid in the following cases:
39455
39456.ilist
39457.oindex "&%-C%&"
39458.oindex "&%-D%&"
39459If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39460the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39461calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39462the calling process.
39463However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39464option may not be used at all.
39465If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39466can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39467user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39468.next
39469.oindex "&%-be%&"
39470.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39471.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39472If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39473(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39474calling process.
39475.next
39476If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39477process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39478uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39479runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39480testing address verification
39481.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39482.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39483(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39484option).
39485.next
39486For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39487remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39488.endlist
39489
39490The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39491
39492.ilist
39493A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39494user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39495function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39496will be used during message reception.
39497.next
39498A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39499job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39500.next
39501A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39502but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39503subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39504deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39505remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39506subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39507while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39508generating bounce and warning messages.
39509
39510While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39511process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39512this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39513gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39514.next
39515A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39516the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39517.endlist
39518
39519
39520
39521
39522.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39523.cindex "privilege, running without"
39524.cindex "unprivileged running"
39525.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39526Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39527operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39528by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39529gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39530(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39531routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39532to any other uid.
39533
39534.cindex SIGHUP
39535.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39536Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39537that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39538correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39539
39540An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39541to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39542process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39543when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39544SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39545
39546It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39547stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39548been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39549effect.
39550
39551If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39552set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39553to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39554
39555In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39556those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39557Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39558that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39559discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39560have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39561number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39562address this problem at this time.
39563
39564For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39565is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39566&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39567be used in the most straightforward way.
39568
39569If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39570number of restrictions on what you can do:
39571
39572.ilist
39573You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39574&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39575normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39576work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39577explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39578.next
39579Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39580not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39581.next
39582Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39583the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39584and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39585enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39586.next
39587Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39588some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39589
39590.olist
39591They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39592implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39593mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39594.next
39595You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39596owned by the Exim user.
39597.next
39598You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39599on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39600mailboxes need to be created manually.
39601.endlist olist
39602.endlist ilist
39603
39604
39605These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39606However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39607gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39608gives more security at essentially no cost.
39609
39610If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39611&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39612
39613
39614
39615
39616.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39617Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39618are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39619
39620
39621
39622.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39623.cindex "security" "local commands"
39624.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39625There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39626commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39627configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39628run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39629
39630.ilist
39631Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39632injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39633be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39634allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39635has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39636.next
39637A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39638&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39639&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39640hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39641NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39642forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39643need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39644.next
39645The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39646administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39647Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39648.next
39649Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39650taint checking might apply to their usage.
39651.next
39652Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39653administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39654instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39655.next
39656Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39657Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39658each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39659of opaque strings.
39660The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39661real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39662injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39663Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39664.endlist
39665
39666
39667
39668
39669.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39670.cindex "security" "data sources"
39671.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39672.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39673.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39674If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39675are some issues to be aware of:
39676
39677.ilist
39678Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39679.next
39680Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39681.next
39682Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39683data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39684"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39685expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39686when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39687possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39688data.
39689.next
39690It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39691&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39692items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39693.next
39694Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39695expected to yield one result.
39696.endlist
39697
39698
39699
39700
39701.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39702.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39703.cindex "IP source routing"
39704Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39705some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39706IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39707IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39708
39709
39710
39711.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39712Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39713be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39714
39715
39716
39717
39718.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39719.cindex "trusted users"
39720.cindex "admin user"
39721.cindex "privileged user"
39722.cindex "user" "trusted"
39723.cindex "user" "admin"
39724Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39725able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39726addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39727local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39728permit a remote host to be specified.
39729
39730.oindex "&%-f%&"
39731However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39732in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39733message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39734but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39735permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39736the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39737
39738Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39739other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39740the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39741as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39742group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39743
39744Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39745can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39746them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39747the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39748includes the contents of files on the spool.
39749
39750.oindex "&%-M%&"
39751.oindex "&%-q%&"
39752By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39753delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39754restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39755Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39756queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39757setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39758
39759Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39760the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39761the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39762group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39763the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39764unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39765files.
39766
39767By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39768introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39769setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39770This affects most of the checking options,
39771such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39772
39773
39774.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39775.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39776Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39777set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39778&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39779any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39780
39781
39782
39783.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39784Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39785of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39786with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39787to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39788this.
39789
39790
39791
39792.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39793The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39794are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39795Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39796converted output.
39797
39798
39799
39800.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39801Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39802to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39803does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39804arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39805
39806
39807
39808.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39809Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39810defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39811loading it.
39812
39813
39814.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39815.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39816A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39817&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39818The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39819that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39820conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39821
39822The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39823the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39824string.
39825
39826
39827
39828.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39829Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39830formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39831the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39832
39833
39834
39835.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39836These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39837enough to hold the result.
39838.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39839
39840
39841
39842
39843. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39844. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39845
39846.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39847.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39848.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39849.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39850.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39851A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39852followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39853the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39854kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39855two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39856is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39857themselves are recoverable.
39858
39859The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39860Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39861and should not be used as such.
39862
39863Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39864need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39865on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39866
39867.ilist
39868You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39869fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39870which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39871place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39872lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39873.next
39874.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39875If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39876&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39877cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39878.next
39879If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39880.next
39881If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39882signature.
39883.endlist
39884All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39885
39886Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39887its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39888files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39889the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39890the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39891is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39892file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39893-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39894attempt.
39895
39896Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39897These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39898They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39899relics of crashes and can be removed.
39900
39901.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39902.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39903.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39904The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39905process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39906gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39907message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39908normally the Exim user.
39909
39910The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39911transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39912empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39913in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39914created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39915&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39916leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39917&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39918
39919The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39920was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39921start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39922warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39923
39924There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39925order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39926
39927.vlist
39928.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39929This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39930&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39931recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39932this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39933identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39934the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39935the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39936the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39937newlines.
39938
39939.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39940A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39941defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39942The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39943starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39944character. It may contain internal newlines.
39945
39946.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39947A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39948Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39949length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39950starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39951character. It may contain internal newlines.
39952
39953.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39954This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39955&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39956
39957.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39958This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39959lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39960transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39961messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39962
39963.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39964This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39965(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39966time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39967hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39968
39969.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39970The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39971&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39972
39973.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39974The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39975&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39976
39977.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39978This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39979present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39980
39981.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39982This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39983present if the number is greater than zero.
39984
39985.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39986This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39987file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39988
39989.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39990.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39991The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39992
39993.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39994This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39995command.
39996
39997.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39998This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39999the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
40000messages.
40001
40002.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
40003If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
40004the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
40005&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
40006
40007.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
40008This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
40009address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
40010
40011.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40012.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
40013.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
40014This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
40015if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
40016received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
40017
40018.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
40019For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
40020unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
40021ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
40022supplied by the remote host, if any.
40023
40024.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40025This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
40026which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
40027generated messages.
40028
40029.vitem &%-local%&
40030The message is from a local sender.
40031
40032.vitem &%-localerror%&
40033The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
40034
40035.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
40036This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
40037when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
40038variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
40039
40040.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
40041The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
40042Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
40043
40044.vitem &%-N%&
40045A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
40046actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
40047&%-N%& is assumed.
40048
40049.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
40050This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
40051the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
40052
40053.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
40054The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
40055to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
40056
40057.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
40058If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
40059of &$spam_score_int$&.
40060
40061.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
40062The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
40063rather than Unix-format.
40064The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
40065There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
40066
40067.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
40068A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
40069certificate was verified by the server.
40070
40071.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
40072When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
40073name of the cipher suite that was used.
40074
40075.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
40076When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
40077was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
40078certificate.
40079.endlist
40080
40081Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
40082corresponding data is untrusted.
40083
40084Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
40085is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
40086line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
40087is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
40088the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
40089balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
40090to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
40091original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
40092addresses are complete.
40093
40094If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
40095the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
40096Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
40097tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
40098right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
40099follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
40100.code
40101YY darcy@austen.fict.example
40102NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
40103NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40104.endd
40105After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
40106This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
40107recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
40108delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
40109example:
40110.code
401114
40112editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40113darcy@austen.fict.example
40114rdo@foundation
40115alice@wonderland.fict.example
40116.endd
40117However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
40118result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
40119line is of the following form:
40120.display
40121<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
40122 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
40123.endd
40124The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
40125the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
40126fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
40127original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
40128envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
40129length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
40130characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
40131that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
40132
40133
40134A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
40135which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
40136when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
40137character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
40138embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
40139following:
40140
40141.table2 50pt
40142.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
40143.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
40144.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
40145.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
40146.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
40147.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
40148.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40149.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40150.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40151.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40152.endtable
40153
40154Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40155purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40156typical set of headers:
40157.code
40158111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40159id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40160049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40161038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40162042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
40163049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
40164099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
40165darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40166104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
40167darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40168038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40169.endd
40170The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
40171&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
40172unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
40173.ecindex IIDforspo1
40174.ecindex IIDforspo2
40175.ecindex IIDforspo3
40176
40177.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
40178The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
40179an ASCII newline character.
40180However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
40181can have an alternate format.
40182This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
40183The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
40184suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
40185ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
40186Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
40187There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
40188
40189. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40190. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40191
40192.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
40193 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
40194
40195.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
40196.cindex "DKIM"
40197
40198DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
40199linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
40200be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
40201DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
40202
40203As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
40204by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
40205any original DKIM signature.
40206
40207DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
40208It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40209
40210Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
40211.olist
40212Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
40213It can co-exist with all other Exim features
40214(including transport filters)
40215except cutthrough delivery.
40216.next
40217Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
40218ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
40219different signature contexts.
40220.endlist
40221
40222In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
40223default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
40224Exim's standard controls.
40225
40226Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
40227on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
40228
40229Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
40230When set, for each signature in incoming email,
40231exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
40232signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
40233.code
402342009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
40235 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
40236 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
40237 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
40238.endd
40239
40240You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
40241or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
40242control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
40243where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
40244senders).
40245
40246
40247.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
40248.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
40249
40250For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
40251Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
40252.code
40253rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40254
40255Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40256Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40257.endd
40258
40259Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
40260in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
40261for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
40262(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
40263but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
40264
40265Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
40266These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
40267
40268.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
40269The domain(s) you want to sign with.
40270After expansion, this can be a list.
40271Each element in turn,
40272lowercased,
40273is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
40274while expanding the remaining signing options.
40275If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40276and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40277
40278.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40279This sets the key selector string.
40280After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40281Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40282variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40283option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40284If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40285and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40286
40287.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40288This sets the private key to use.
40289You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40290&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40291The result can either
40292.ilist
40293be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40294.next
40295with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40296be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40297.next
40298start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40299the private key
40300.next
40301be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40302be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40303is set.
40304.endlist
40305
40306To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40307.code
40308openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40309openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40310.endd
40311The result file from the first command should be retained, and
40312this option set to use it.
40313Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40314for the DNS TXT record.
40315See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40316
40317Under GnuTLS:
40318.code
40319certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40320certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40321.endd
40322
40323Note that RFC 8301 says:
40324.code
40325Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40326Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40327.endd
40328
40329EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40330They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40331As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40332(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40333for some transition period.
40334The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40335for EC keys.
40336
40337OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40338.code
40339openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40340certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40341.endd
40342
40343To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40344.code
40345openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40346certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40347.endd
40348
40349Exim also supports an alternate format
40350of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40351of the standard, but not adopted.
40352A future release will probably drop that support.
40353
40354.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40355Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40356.ilist
40357&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40358.next
40359&`sha256`& &-- the default
40360.next
40361&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40362.endlist
40363
40364Note that RFC 8301 says:
40365.code
40366rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40367.endd
40368
40369.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40370If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40371the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40372syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40373local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40374tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40375
40376.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40377This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40378The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40379The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40380only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40381
40382.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40383This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40384should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40385either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40386unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40387variables here.
40388
40389.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40390If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40391list of header names.
40392Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40393in the message signature.
40394When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40395whether or not each header is present in the message.
40396The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40397"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40398
40399If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40400will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40401message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40402
40403A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40404If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40405will be signed.
40406If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40407will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40408name will be appended.
40409
40410.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40411This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40412If not set, no such information will be included.
40413Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40414for the expiry tag
40415(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40416both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40417
40418RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40419
40420
40421.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40422.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40423
40424Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40425messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40426.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40427Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40428the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40429The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40430processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40431
40432.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40433Performing verification sets up information used by the
40434&%authresults%& expansion item.
40435
40436For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40437of this section can be ignored.
40438
40439The results of verification are made available to the
40440&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40441A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40442By default, the ACL is called once for each
40443syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40444If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40445If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40446summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40447
40448To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40449a large number of expansion variables
40450containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40451runtime of the ACL.
40452
40453Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40454more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40455&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40456&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40457
40458The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40459list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40460called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40461the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40462list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40463&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40464it defaults as:
40465.code
40466dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40467.endd
40468This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40469DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40470call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40471.code
40472dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40473.endd
40474This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40475and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40476You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40477.code
40478dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40479.endd
40480
40481If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40482&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40483
40484Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40485(such as the From: header)
40486care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40487and for the domain part if identities.
40488The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40489
40490If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40491for each matching signature.
40492
40493
40494Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40495available (from most to least important):
40496
40497
40498.vlist
40499.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40500The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40501an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40502&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40503
40504.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40505Within the DKIM ACL,
40506a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40507.ilist
40508&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40509identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40510.next
40511&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40512More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40513.next
40514&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40515available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40516.next
40517&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40518.endlist
40519
40520This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40521This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40522hash-method or key-size:
40523.code
40524 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40525 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40526 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40527 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40528 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40529 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40530 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40531.endd
40532
40533So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40534after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40535colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40536This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40537
40538.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40539A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40540"fail" or "invalid". One of
40541.ilist
40542&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40543key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40544.next
40545&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40546record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40547.next
40548&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40549body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40550means that the message body was modified in transit.
40551.next
40552&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40553could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40554re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40555DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40556.endlist
40557
40558This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40559
40560.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40561The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40562an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40563reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40564
40565.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40566The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40567if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40568identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40569
40570.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40571The key record selector string.
40572
40573.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40574The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40575If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40576may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40577The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40578for EC keys.
40579
40580Note that RFC 8301 says:
40581.code
40582rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40583
40584DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40585algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40586.endd
40587
40588To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40589and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40590or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40591processing of such signatures.
40592
40593.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40594The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40595
40596.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40597The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40598
40599.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40600A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40601(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40602Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40603not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40604strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40605
40606.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40607The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40608limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40609that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40610&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40611is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40612A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40613shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40614
40615.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40616UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40617When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40618
40619.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40620UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40621signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40622signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40623integer size comparisons against this value.
40624Note that Exim does not check this value.
40625
40626.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40627A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40628
40629.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40630"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40631
40632.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40633"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40634
40635.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40636Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40637in the key record.
40638
40639.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40640Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40641in the key record.
40642
40643.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40644Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40645
40646.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40647Number of bits in the key.
40648
40649Note that RFC 8301 says:
40650.code
40651Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40652less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40653.endd
40654
40655To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40656and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40657As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40658
40659.endlist
40660
40661In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40662
40663.vlist
40664.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40665ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40666for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40667(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40668verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40669
40670.code
40671# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40672warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40673 sender_domains = gmail.com
40674 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40675 dkim_status = none
40676.endd
40677
40678Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40679for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40680
40681.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40682ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40683results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40684to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40685
40686.code
40687deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40688 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40689 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40690 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40691.endd
40692
40693The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40694see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40695for more information of what they mean.
40696.endlist
40697
40698
40699
40700
40701.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40702.cindex SPF verification
40703
40704SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40705messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40706For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40707the &url(http://openspf.org).
40708. --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40709. --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40710. --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40711. --- discussion.
40712
40713Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40714This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40715
40716SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40717&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40718&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40719There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40720publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40721
40722For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40723.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40724Performing verification sets up information used by the
40725&%authresults%& expansion item.
40726
40727
40728.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40729.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40730The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40731It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40732and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40733Valid strings are:
40734.vlist
40735.vitem &%pass%&
40736The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40737
40738.vitem &%fail%&
40739The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40740domain in the envelope-from address.
40741
40742.vitem &%softfail%&
40743The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40744is a forgery.
40745
40746.vitem &%none%&
40747The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40748
40749.vitem &%neutral%&
40750The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40751published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40752its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40753
40754.vitem &%permerror%&
40755This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40756You may deny messages when this occurs.
40757
40758.vitem &%temperror%&
40759This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40760SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40761.endlist
40762
40763You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40764its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40765"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40766short-circuit fashion.
40767
40768Example:
40769.code
40770deny spf = fail
40771 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40772 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40773 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40774 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40775 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40776 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40777 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40778 ip=$sender_host_address
40779.endd
40780
40781When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40782variables:
40783
40784.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40785.vlist
40786.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40787.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40788 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40789 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40790 it for logging purposes.
40791
40792.vitem &$spf_received$&
40793.vindex &$spf_received$&
40794 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40795 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40796 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40797 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40798
40799 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40800 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40801
40802.vitem &$spf_result$&
40803.vindex &$spf_result$&
40804 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40805 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40806 temperror.
40807
40808.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40809.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40810 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40811 and required in order to obtain a result.
40812
40813.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40814.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40815 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40816 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40817.endlist
40818
40819
40820.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40821.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40822.cindex SPF "best guess"
40823In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40824"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40825SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40826capability.
40827Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40828for a description of what it means.
40829. --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40830
40831To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40832of the spf one. For example:
40833
40834.code
40835deny spf_guess = fail
40836 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40837.endd
40838
40839In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40840should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40841is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40842reject message.
40843
40844When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40845variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40846
40847Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40848what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40849&%spf_guess%& option.
40850For example, the following:
40851
40852.code
40853spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40854.endd
40855
40856would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40857
40858
40859.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40860.cindex lookup spf
40861A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40862address as the key and an IP address
40863(v4 or v6)
40864as the database:
40865
40866.code
40867 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40868.endd
40869
40870The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40871&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40872
40873
40874
40875
40876
40877.section DMARC SECDMARC
40878.cindex DMARC verification
40879
40880DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40881to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40882email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40883should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40884&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40885
40886If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40887the libopendmarc library is used.
40888
40889For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40890&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40891to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40892repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40893SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40894This description assumes
40895that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40896are in /usr/local/lib.
40897
40898. subsection
40899
40900There are three main-configuration options:
40901.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40902
40903The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40904.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40905defines the location of a text file of valid
40906top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40907during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40908the most current version can be downloaded
40909from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
40910See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40911.new
40912The default for the option is unset.
40913If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
40914.wen
40915
40916
40917The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40918.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40919defines the location of a file to log results
40920of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40921contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40922which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40923reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40924directory of this file is writable by the user
40925exim runs as.
40926The default is unset.
40927
40928The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40929.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40930defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40931forensic report detailing alignment failures
40932if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40933and you have configured Exim to send them.
40934If set, this is expanded and used for the
40935From: header line; the address is extracted
40936from it and used for the envelope from.
40937If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40938the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40939envelope from.
40940
40941. I wish we had subsections...
40942
40943.cindex DMARC controls
40944By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40945non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40946status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40947use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40948DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40949DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
40950.code
40951 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40952.endd
40953A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40954exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40955Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40956results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40957be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40958reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40959forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40960exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
40961configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
40962construction might be inadequate.
40963.code
40964 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40965.endd
40966(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40967not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40968your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
40969send them.)
40970
40971There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40972the DATA acl.
40973
40974. subsection
40975
40976DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40977&"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40978call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
40979condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40980for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40981up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40982occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40983
40984The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
40985right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40986on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40987mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40988.display
40989&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40990&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40991&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40992&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40993&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40994&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40995&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40996&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40997.endd
40998You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40999meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
41000"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
41001short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
41002DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
41003strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
41004fails.
41005
41006Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
41007supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
41008result is a list of colon-separated strings.
41009
41010Performing the check sets up information used by the
41011&%authresults%& expansion item.
41012
41013Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
41014processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
41015expansion variables are available:
41016
41017.vlist
41018.vitem &$dmarc_status$&
41019.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
41020.cindex DMARC result
41021A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
41022thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
41023DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
41024(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
41025in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
41026
41027.vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
41028.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
41029Slightly longer, human readable status.
41030
41031.vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41032.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41033The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
41034
41035.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41036.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41037The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
41038are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
41039is any error, including no DMARC record.
41040.endlist
41041
41042. subsection
41043
41044By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
41045non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
41046create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
41047you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
41048DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
41049than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
41050processing or failure delivery issues).
41051
41052In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
41053tools, you need to:
41054.ilist
41055Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
41056.next
41057Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
41058import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
41059.endlist
41060
41061In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
41062.ilist
41063Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41064.next
41065Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
41066enable sending DMARC forensic reports
41067.endlist
41068
41069. subsection
41070
41071Example usage:
41072.code
41073(RCPT ACL)
41074 warn domains = +local_domains
41075 hosts = +local_hosts
41076 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41077
41078 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
41079 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41080
41081 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
41082 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
41083
41084(DATA ACL)
41085 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
41086 !authenticated = *
41087 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
41088
41089 warn dmarc_status = !accept
41090 !authenticated = *
41091 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
41092
41093 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
41094 !authenticated = *
41095 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
41096 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
41097
41098 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
41099 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
41100 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
41101
41102 deny dmarc_status = reject
41103 !authenticated = *
41104 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
41105
41106 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
41107.endd
41108
41109
41110
41111
41112
41113. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41114. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41115
41116.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
41117 "Proxy support"
41118.cindex "proxy support"
41119.cindex "proxy" "access via"
41120
41121A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
41122Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
41123
41124
41125.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
41126.cindex proxy inbound
41127.cindex proxy "server side"
41128.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
41129.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
41130
41131Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
41132that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
41133To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
41134in Local/Makefile.
41135
41136It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
41137&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
41138
41139The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
41140such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
41141to distribute load.
41142Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
41143the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
41144There is no logging if a host passes or
41145fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
41146recorded in an ACL (example is below).
41147
41148Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
41149main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
41150hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
41151Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
41152automatically determines which version is in use.
41153
41154The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
41155and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
41156negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
41157Exim and the proxy server.
41158
41159The following expansion variables are usable
41160(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
41161of the proxy):
41162.display
41163&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
41164&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
41165&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
41166&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
41167&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
41168.endd
41169If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
41170there was a protocol error.
41171The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
41172will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
41173
41174Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
41175per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
41176evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
41177handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
41178With the option set so high, you lose the ability
41179to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
41180In order to prevent your server from overload, you
41181need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
41182A possible solution is:
41183.display
41184 # Set max number of connections per host
41185 LIMIT = 5
41186 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
41187 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
41188
41189 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
41190 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
41191.endd
41192
41193
41194
41195.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
41196.cindex proxy outbound
41197.cindex proxy "client side"
41198.cindex proxy SOCKS
41199.cindex SOCKS proxy
41200Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
41201using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
41202The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
41203Local/Makefile.
41204
41205Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
41206on an smtp transport.
41207The option value is expanded and should then be a list
41208(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
41209Each proxy specifier is a list
41210(space-separated by default) where the initial element
41211is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
41212
41213Options are a string <name>=<value>.
41214The list of options is in the following table:
41215.display
41216&'auth '& authentication method
41217&'name '& authentication username
41218&'pass '& authentication password
41219&'port '& tcp port
41220&'tmo '& connection timeout
41221&'pri '& priority
41222&'weight '& selection bias
41223.endd
41224
41225More details on each of these options follows:
41226
41227.ilist
41228.cindex authentication "to proxy"
41229.cindex proxy authentication
41230&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
41231Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
41232for access to the proxy.
41233Default is &"none"&.
41234.next
41235&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
41236Default is empty.
41237.next
41238&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
41239Default is empty.
41240.next
41241&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
41242Default is 1080.
41243.next
41244&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
41245Default is 5.
41246.next
41247&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
41248higher values being tried first.
41249The default priority is 1.
41250.next
41251&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
41252Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
41253weighted by this value.
41254The default value for selection bias is 1.
41255.endlist
41256
41257Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
41258and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
41259overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
41260
41261.section Logging SECTproxyLog
41262To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
41263add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
41264This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
41265
41266. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41267. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41268
41269.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
41270 "Internationalisation""
41271.cindex internationalisation "email address"
41272.cindex EAI
41273.cindex i18n
41274.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
41275
41276Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41277To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41278Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41279
41280If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41281instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41282requirement, upon libidn2.
41283
41284.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41285.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41286The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41287a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41288accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41289SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41290
41291If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41292international handling for the message is enabled and
41293the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41294
41295The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41296message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41297whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41298when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41299
41300Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41301UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41302require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41303the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41304
41305HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41306components expanded to a-label form,
41307and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41308form of the name.
41309
41310.cindex log protocol
41311.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41312.cindex i18n logging
41313Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41314prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41315
41316The following expansion operators can be used:
41317.code
41318${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41319${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41320${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41321${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41322.endd
41323
41324.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41325.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41326The RCPT ACL
41327may use the following modifier:
41328.display
41329control = utf8_downconvert
41330control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41331.endd
41332This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41333a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41334Message Submission Agent context.
41335If a value is appended it may be:
41336.display
41337&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41338&`0 `& no downconversion
41339&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41340.endd
41341
41342If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41343is initially set to -1.
41344
41345The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41346If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41347and it overrides any previously set value.
41348
41349
41350There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41351Configurations supporting these should inspect
41352&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41353
41354There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41355Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41356for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41357
41358There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41359and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41360
41361
41362
41363.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41364To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41365the following expansion operator can be used:
41366.code
41367${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41368.endd
41369
41370The string is converted from the charset specified by
41371the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41372or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41373to the
41374modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41375with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41376(which has to be a single character)
41377are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41378<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41379
41380The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41381The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41382
41383This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41384by many other IMAP servers.
41385
41386Examples:
41387.display
41388&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41389&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41390&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41391.endd
41392
41393Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41394must be representable in UTF-16.
41395
41396
41397. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41398. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41399
41400.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41401 "Events"
41402.cindex events
41403
41404The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41405of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41406actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41407processing actions.
41408
41409Most installations will never need to use Events.
41410The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41411in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41412
41413There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41414The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41415a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41416
41417Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41418An example might look like:
41419.cindex logging custom
41420.code
41421event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41422{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41423 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41424 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41425 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41426 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41427 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41428 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41429 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41430} {}}
41431.endd
41432
41433Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41434The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41435expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41436
41437.new
41438The current list of events is:
41439.wen
41440.display
41441&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41442&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41443&`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41444&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41445&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41446&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41447&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41448&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41449&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41450&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41451&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41452&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41453&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41454&`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41455.endd
41456New event types may be added in future.
41457
41458The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41459event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41460or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41461
41462The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41463before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41464can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41465
41466The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41467should define the event action.
41468
41469An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41470with the event type:
41471.display
41472&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41473&`msg:defer `& error string
41474&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41475&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41476&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41477&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41478&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41479&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41480&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41481&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41482&`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41483.endd
41484
41485The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41486
41487For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41488however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41489the course of its processing:
41490.ilist
41491variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41492transport call
41493.next
41494acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41495and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41496.endlist
41497Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41498a useful way of writing to the main log.
41499
41500The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41501return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41502following will be forced:
41503.display
41504&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41505&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41506&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41507.endd
41508All other message types ignore the result string, and
41509no other use is made of it.
41510
41511For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41512then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41513the target system.
41514
41515For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41516chain element received on the connection.
41517For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41518loaded locally.
41519
41520. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41521. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41522
41523.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41524 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41525.cindex "adding drivers"
41526.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41527.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41528The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41529authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41530
41531.olist
41532Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41533existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41534.next
41535Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41536.display
41537<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41538.endd
41539where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41540code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41541should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41542.next
41543Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41544.code
41545#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41546.endd
41547.next
41548Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41549and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41550.next
41551Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41552near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41553Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41554As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41555simple form that most lookups have.
41556.next
41557Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41558&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41559driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41560.next
41561Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41562definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41563.next
41564Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41565&_src_&.
41566.next
41567Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41568as for other drivers and lookups.
41569.endlist
41570
41571Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41572proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41573occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41574options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41575searched using a binary chop procedure.
41576
41577There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41578the interface that is expected.
41579
41580
41581
41582
41583. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41584. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41585
41586. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41587. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41588. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41589. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41590. processors.
41591. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41592
41593.literal xml
41594<?sdop
41595 format="newpage"
41596 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41597 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41598?>
41599.literal off
41600
41601.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41602.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41603.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41604
41605
41606. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41607. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////